EPSON

EB-L1065UNL - Video projector EPSON - Free user manual and instructions

Find the device manual for free EB-L1065UNL EPSON in PDF.

📄 291 pages English EN Download 💬 AI Question
Notice EPSON EB-L1065UNL - page 2
Pick your language and provide your email: we'll send you a specifically translated version.

User questions about EB-L1065UNL EPSON

0 question about this device. Answer the ones you know or ask your own.

Ask a new question about this device

The email remains private: it is only used to notify you if someone responds to your question.

No questions yet. Be the first to ask one.

Download the instructions for your Video projector in PDF format for free! Find your manual EB-L1065UNL - EPSON and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. EB-L1065UNL by EPSON.

USER MANUAL EB-L1065UNL EPSON

Notations Used in This Guide

•Safety indications

The documentation and the projector use graphical symbols to show how to use the projector safely.

The indications and their meaning are as follows. Make sure you understand them properly before reading the guide.

WarningThis symbol indicates information that, if ignored, could possibly result in personal injury or even death due to incorrect handling.
CautionThis symbol indicates information that, if ignored, could possibly result in personal injury or physical damage due to incorrect handling.

•General information indications

AttentionIndicates procedures which may result in damage or injury if sufficient care is not taken.
Indicates additional information and points which may be useful to know regarding a topic.
Indicates a page where detailed information regarding a topic can be found.
[Name] Indicates the name of the buttons on the remote control or the control panel.Example: [Esc] button
Menu Name Indicates Configuration menu items.Example:Select Brightness from Image.Image - Brightness

Make sure you read the following before you use the projector.

Safety Instructions

Warning and Cautions on Installation

An optional ceiling mount is required when suspending the projector from a ceiling.

"Optional Accessories" p.233

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning and Cautions on Installation - 1

Warning

  • Do not use or install the projector where it may be subject to water or rain, or high humidity, such as outdoors, in a bathroom, or shower room, and so on. Otherwise, it could cause a fire or electric shock.
  • Do not install in locations where salt damage could occur, or in locations subject to corrosive gas such as sulphuric gas from hot springs. Otherwise, corrosion could cause the projector to fall. It could also cause the projector to malfunction.
  • A special method of installation is required when suspending the projector from a ceiling (ceiling mount). If installation work is not carried out correctly, the projector could fall down. This may result in injury or accidents. Contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.

Epson Projector Contact List

  • Failure to install the ceiling mount and projector may cause the projector to fall. After installing the specific Epson mount that supports your projector, make sure you secure the projector and the mount using wire that is strong enough to hold their weight.
  • If you use adhesives on the ceiling mount fixing points to prevent the screws from loosening, or if you use things such as lubricants or oils on the projector, the projector case may crack causing it to fall from its ceiling mount. This could cause an accident or injury to anyone under the ceiling mount.

When installing or adjusting the ceiling mount, do not use adhesives, lubricants, oils, and so on to prevent the screws from loosening.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 1

Warning

  • Do not install the projector in locations subject to high humidity or dust, or locations subject to oil or steam, such as kitchen counters, kitchens, or near humidifiers. Otherwise, electric shock or fire could occur. Also, oily particle in the air could cause the projector case to deteriorate causing the projector to fall from the mount if it is suspended from a ceiling.
  • Do not cover the projector's air intake vent or air exhaust vent. If either of the vents are covered, the internal temperature could rise and cause a fire.
  • Do not place flammable objects in front of the lens. If you set the schedule to turn on the projector automatically, any flammable objects placed in front of the lens could cause a fire.
  • Do not tie the power cord and other connection cables together. Otherwise, it could cause a fire.
  • Only use the specified power-supply voltage. Otherwise, it could cause a fire or electric shock.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 1

Warning

- Be careful when handling the power cord. Otherwise, it could cause a fire or electric shock. Note the following when handling the power cord.

- Do not plug multiple power cords in a single electric outlet.

- Do not plug in the power cord if there are any foreign substances, such as dust, stuck to it.

- Make sure you insert the power cord all the way in.

- Do not plug in or unplug the power cord with wet hands.

- Do not pull the cord when unplugging the power cord. Make sure you hold it by the plug.

- Do not use a damaged power cord. Otherwise, it could cause a fire or electric shock. Note the following when handling the power cord.

- Do not alter the power cord.

- Do not place any heavy objects on the power cord.

- Do not bend, twist, or pull the power cord forcibly.

- Do not layout the power cord near a heating device.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 1

Caution

Do not place the projector on an unstable surface, such as on an unstable table or tilted surface. When projecting vertically, install the projector appropriately to prevent the projector from falling.

Otherwise it may cause an injury.

Attention

  • Do not install the projector in a location that is subject to vibration or shock.
  • Do not install the projector near a high-voltage line or object that generates magnetism. Otherwise the projector may not work correctly.
  • Do not use or store the projector in a location that is subject to extreme temperatures. Also, avoid sudden temperature changes.

Make sure you maintain the operating or storage temperature ranges. “Projector General Specifications” p.279

  • When installing the projector in an environment in which a high-powered laser beam is being used, make sure it is installed so that the laser beam does not hit the surface of the projection lens.
  • When using at an altitude that exceeds 1,500 m, set High Altitude Mode to On.

Extended - Operation - High Altitude Mode p.146

- The projector can be installed at any angle. There is no vertical or horizontal limit to how the projector can be installed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

natural_image Circular arrangement of six identical mechanical components arranged in a ring, no text or symbols present.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

natural_image Circular diagram with six identical mechanical components arranged in a ring, no text or symbols present.
  • You may need dedicated installation mounts to tilt and install the projector. Contact a professional and prepare the mount.
  • Plan so that the mount does not fall.

Attention

- Make sure you secure the following space around the projector so as not to block the air exhaust vent and the air intake vent.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 3

- When setting up multiple projectors, make sure there is a gap of at least 70 cm between the projectors. Also, make sure that the heat from the air exhaust vent does not go into the air intake vent.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 4

- Secure the following space when placing a partition between projectors.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 5

text_image 30cm 30cm

Attention

- Do not stack projectors directly on top of each other.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

- When using the ceiling mount or the portrait mount, use commercially available M6 screws (up to a depth of 14 mm) to fix the projector's ceiling mount fixing points and the mount at four points.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

natural_image Pure technical line drawing of a mechanical assembly without any text, numbers, or symbols

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 3

- We recommend setting the focus, zoom, and lens shift at least 20 minutes after you start the projection, because images are not stable right after turning on the projector.

- When adjusting the image height with the vertical lens shift, adjust by moving the image from the bottom to the top. If it is adjusted from the top to the bottom, the image position may move down slightly after adjusting.

Warning and Cautions on Usage

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning and Cautions on Usage - 1

Warning

  • Do not cover the projector's air intake vent or air exhaust vent. If either of the vents is covered, the internal temperature could rise and cause a fire.
  • Do not look into the lens while projecting. The powerful light emitted could cause damage to eyesight. Take particular care when there are children present. When turning on the projector at a distance using the remote control, make sure there is no one looking into the lens.
  • During projection, do not block the light from the projector with the lens cover (removable) or a book and so on.
    If the light from the projector is blocked, the area on which the light shines becomes hot which could cause it to melt, burn, or start a fire. Also, the lens may get hot due to the reflected light which could cause the projector to malfunction. To stop projection, use the A/V Mute function, or turn off the projector.
  • Do not open the projector's case. Never disassemble or remodel the projector. There are high-voltage components inside the projector that could cause fire, electric shock, or an accident.
  • If an error occurs, disconnect the power cord from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List. If you continue using the projector as it is, it could cause an electric shock, fire, or even damage to eyesight.

Epson Projector Contact List

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 1

Caution

Do not place objects that may become warped or otherwise affected by heat near the air exhaust vent and do not put your face or hands near the vent while projection is in progress.

Attention

  • Only remove the lens unit when necessary. If dust or dirt enter the projector, projection quality deteriorates and it could cause a malfunction.
  • Try not to touch the lens section with your hand or fingers. If fingerprints or oils are left on the surface of the lens, projection quality deteriorates.
  • If you continue to project while the surface of the lens is dirty, projection quality deteriorates. Make sure you clean the lens. “Cleaning the Lens” p.204
  • Store the projector with the lens unit installed. If the projector is stored without the lens unit, dust and dirt may get inside the projector and cause malfunctions or lower the quality of projection.
  • When storing, make sure you remove the batteries from the remote control. If the batteries are left in the remote control for an extended period of time, they may leak.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

- About the LCD panel

  • The LCD panel may contain pixels that are missing or appear bright all the time. This is not a sign of an error.
  • When a high-powered laser beams through the surface of the projection lens even when it is not being used, it can cause a malfunction in the LCD panel. Attach the lens cover when storing the projector.

- About the light source

The projector uses a laser as the light source. The laser has the following characteristics.

  • Depending on the surroundings, the brightness of the light source may decline. The brightness declines a lot when the temperature gets too high.
  • The brightness of the light source declines the longer it is used. You can change the relationship between usage time and decline in brightness in Brightness Settings.

"Relationship between Brightness Level and light source operation time" p.78

- About Light Source Calibration

- When Run Periodically is set to On for Light Source Calibration, every time the usage time reaches 100 hours, calibration starts automatically for the light source when the projector is turned off. However, this does not start automatically when the projector is used continuously for more than 24 hours, or when direct shutdown is used regularly. Set Light Source Calibration in the scheduling function.

"Scheduling Function" p.112
- When performing Light Source Calibration, the difference between the white balance and the brightness level for the light source is corrected.
Reset - Light Source Calibration - Run Periodically p.162

Warning and Cautions on the Laser

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning and Cautions on the Laser - 1

Warning

- Laser warning labels are attached inside the projector and on the side of the projector.

Inside

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 1

text_image CAUTION / DANGER CAUTION DANGER: CLASS KURGER VARIATION WHEN OPEN AVEY AND/OR TO BE REPRODUCED TO PRINT YOUR COCONDUCTOR ATTENTION DANGER: IN CAR DOGUEFRE RIMMONATH LADERS OF CLASS A - ENTER DISPERSION DES VEULOS DE LA TRA AUX MAYONNEVEMENTS DIRECTS DU COMPLES PRECAUTION: FEUILAR FABRICAN ANDER DE CABLE CUANDO DATA ABORTO ENTRAL ENSPONDENCE LOGO PIEL AU PARANACION PRECITA DE SUPERFA ACORTHING: 2014-2016 SANTHAELI CLASSE CHINA'S OVERTAINMENT STRATEGICIA VOLTAGE ORCHINATE SURFACE ORCHINATE STRATEGICIA VENTURES ISLE FACTOR: 2014-2016 NOVALE GUSTAVES ENGLISH ITEMS ENGLISH ITEMS: 2014-2016 NOVALE GUSTAVES ENGLISH ITEMS ENGLISH ITEMS: 2014-2016 NOVALE GUSTAVES ENGLISH ITEMS ENGLISH ITEMS: 2014-2016 NOVALE GUSTAVES ENGLISH ITEMS

Side

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 2

text_image WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING WARNING

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 3

Warning

  • Do not open the projector's case. The projector contains a high-powered laser.
  • Do not look into the lazer beam being emitted from the projection lens while projecting. (Based on the RG2 IEC/EN 62471-5: 2015)
  • This projector may become RG3 when an interchangeable lens with a throw ratio greater than 3.5 is installed. See the manual for the lens list and hazardous distances before operation. Such combinations of projector and lens are intended for professional use only, and are not intended for consumer use.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 1

Caution

  • This projector is a Class 1 laser product that complies with the IEC/EN60825-1: 2014 international standard for lasers.
  • Do not disassemble the projector when disposing of it. Dispose according to your local or national laws and regulations.

Notes on Transporting

There are many glass parts and precision components inside the projector. To prevent damage due to impacts when transporting, handle the projector as follows.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Notes on Transporting - 1

Caution

The projector should not be carried by one person. At least two people are needed to unpack or carry the projector.

Attention

- Moving Nearby

  • Turn off the power to the projector and disconnect all cables.
  • Attach the cover to the lens.

- When Transporting

After checking the points in "Moving Nearby", prepare the following and then pack up the projector.

  • Remove the lens unit if an option lens is installed.
  • If the projector does not have a lens, attach the cover that was on the lens mount when you purchased the projector.
  • Attach the lens if the projector has a built-in lens. Upon purchase, attach the protective pad that is attached around the lens unit.
  • Move the lens position to the home position.

"Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34

- Enclose the projector securely in packaging material to protect it from shock, and place it into a strong container. Be sure to notify the carrier company that it is precision equipment and that it needs to be kept horizontally during transportation.

Contents

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Contents - 1

Notations Used in This Guide ...... 2

Introduction

Part Names and Functions

Front/Top....15
Rear....16
Connector Ports.
B a s e....18
Control Panel....
Remote Control....
Handy remote control operations
Replacing the remote control batteries
Remote control operating range
Connecting a cable to theremote control

ID Settings....42

Set the projector ID....

Checking the projector ID....

Setting theremote control ID......

Setting the Time 4

Other Settings....45

Settings related to basic operations....

Settings related to display....

Connecting Equipment 47

Connecting a Computer....

18Connecting Image Sources......

2 Connecting External Equipment......

Co.n.e.c2t1ng a L ANCable....

Connecting293an HDBaseT Transmitter....

Installing the Wireless LAN Unit......

Attaching2the Cable Cover ....

Attaching....55

Preparing the Projector

Installing the Project or 27

Removing and Attaching the Projector Lens Unit ...

Attaching....27 Home Screen....59

Lens Calibration....29. Turning Off the Projector

Removing....30 Turning On the Project Of .... 60

Installation Settings....

Changing the direction of the image (projection mode) Automatically Detecting Inhibits and Changing the Projected Image (Source

Screen Settings....3Search)....61

Adjusting the position of the image on the projected Switch to the Target Image by Remote Control....

Displaying the Test Pattern....A diu ^3 in a the Volume....

Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)....34

Adjusting the Image Size .... Adjusting the Projected Image s .... 64

Correcting the Focus ....C. Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image....

Correcting Distortion (Image Warping)....H./V.-Key.3t8one....65

Registering and Loading Lens Adjustment Values....Quick.Corner.3.9....66

Adjusting the Height of the Projected Image (for Normal Clums/teadl bmo efmate)....4.1....67

Adjusting the Horizontal Tilt (for Normal Installment). Corner Wall....4.2....71

Basic Usage

Turning On the Projector 58

Home Screen....59

^29 Turning Off the Projector 60

Projecting Images 61

Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source

3Search)....61

dSswitcenging to the Target Image by Remote Control.....

·A·diu ^3 ing the Volume.

s Shift Adjustment)....34

Adjusting the Projected Images 64

.C. Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image....

H./V.-Ke.y.3t80 n e 65

...Quick Corner 3.9....66

m a Clun s teadll 6 m e fnatc e . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1. 67

1) Co-r-n e-r. Wa-l-1, 4,2....7,1

Contents

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Contents - 1

Point Correction ....74nput Sources for Split Screen Projection
Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode) perating.procedZi6es
Setting the Brightness....Restrictions during splitscreen projection
Guideto Estimated Remains....H.id.i78g the lmage and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute)
Relationship between Brightness Level and light source operation freezing. The Image (Freeze).
Setting the Amount of Light of the Projected Image....En.l.arg.ing.P.a.r.t7Of the l image (E-Zoom)
Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image.....S.av.ing.a.U.s.er.'80 logo
Changing methods 80
Adjusting the Image
Hue, Saturation, and Brightness adjustment......Switching to Content Playback Mode
Gamma adjustment ......g ^1 aying a Playlist ...... 10
Adjusting Image Resolution (Image Enhancement)
4K Enhancement (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U
only) 83
Image Preset Mode
Frame Interpolation
Noise Reduction
MPEG Noise Reduction
Super-resolution
Detail Enhancement
Projecting 3D Images
80
Content Playback Feature .... To
Switching to Content Playback Mode
8 Playing a Playlist....10
Adding Effectsgol m ages (Effect Feature)
Restrictions on Content Playback Mode
Memory Function 110
S,8v5ing/Loading/Erasing/Resetting the Memory
Scheduling Function 112
Saving an Event 112
Setting an Event....11
Checking an Event 11
Editing an Event....11

Useful Functions

Multi-Projection Function 90

Adjustment Procedure

Advance preparation

Adjusting the projected position

Adjusting the projected images

Security Functions 115

Managing Users (Password Protection)

KindsofPasswordProtection

Setting Password Protection

@ Atering the password

-Restricting Operation

Contr ^0 PanelLock....11

L e·n s9L0 c k 118

Remote control button lock

^1 Anti Theft/Fall Prevention

[Non-Text]

[Non-Text]

6

[Non-Text]

...97

Edge Blending

Black Level

Color Matching

Displaying a Scaled Image

Projection Functions 99

Projecting Two Images Simultaneously (Split Screen)....99

Using the Projector on a Network

Others menu 159

Reset menu 160

Wired Network Projection

Info Menu (Display Only)

121 Reset Menu....162

Selecting Wired Network Settings

1 2 1

Wireless Network Projection

Batch Setup 164

Setup Using a USB Flash Drive....

Saving settings to the USB flash drive

Reflecting saved settings to other projectors

Setup by Connecting the Computer and Projector with a USB Cable ..... 168

Saving ^1 settings to a computer

Reflecting saved settings to other projectors

-When Set J^3 Pails 17

Using a USB Key to Connect a Windows Computer....131

Secure HTTP

132

Troubleshooting

Importing a Web Server Certificate Using the Menus

1 3 3

Using the Help 173

Supported Web Server Certificates

Reading the Indicators 175

Setting a certificate using a Web browser

Reading the Status Display 182

Explanations of the Display Content

Problem Solving 190

Configuration Menu

Configuration Menu Operations

137 Problems Relating to Images

Configuration Menu Table

No images appear.... 19

Network menu

138 Moving images are not displayed

Image Menu....

40 Projection stops automatically

Signal Menu

42 Not supported is displayed

Settings Menu

.143 No Signal is displayed

Extended Menu

146 Images are fuzzy, out of focus, or distorted

Network Menu

151 Interference or distortion appear in images

Notes on operating the Network menu

The image is truncated (large) or small, the aspect is not suitable, or the image has

Soft keyboard operations

b e s n reversed....194

Basic menu.

53 Image colors are not right

Wireless LAN menu

.. 1 5 _4 m a g e s a p p e a r d a r k

Wired LAN menu

157 Problems when Projection Starts

Notifications menu

1 The projector does not turn on

Contents

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Contents - 1

Problems with Content Playback Mode ......Dis.play98g the Epson Web Control Screen......

Cannot play the playlist....Bla97c Control Screen....

Other Problems 1970 SD Control Pad Screen

There are afterimages (screen burn-in) in the projected image ..... Loans Control Screen ..... 2

No sound can be heard or the sound is faint....Status. In 1908mation Screen....

Theremote control does not work....Ch.a.ngi9n8g Settings Using a Web Browser (Content Playb

Nothing appears on the external monitor....R.em o.t.e.1.9.9....222

I want to changethe language for messages and menus .P.lay.lists.....1.9.9....223

Email is not received even if a problem occurs in the proU 6 B tM e m.o.r.y .De.vi @ 0. 22

The battery that saves your clock settings is running loTwi mie Tab phey.ed....2.0 0....2 24

About Event ID 201 USD Control Rate 274 Using the Mail Notification Function to Report Problem

Maintenance

Cleaning the Parts 204 Cable layouts 226

Cleaning the Projector....A204t PJLink....227

Cleaning the Lens .... 2 About Crestron Connected® .... 2 2 8

Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent....O.p.e.r.ati.n2g0a4 projector from your computer....

Cleaning the air filter ....A b205t Web API .... 232

Cleaning the air intake vent....2.0.6

Replacing Consumables 208 Optional Accessories

Replacing the Air Filter....Consumables .... 233

Air filter replacement period....208

Replacing the air filter .... Screen Size and Projection Distance .... 234

Image Maintenance 210EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W 234

Panel Alignment 210ELPLM08 234

Color Uniformity 21 ^b LPLX01/ELPLX01W

ELPLU03 236

ELPLU04/ELPLU02 2

ELPLW05 238

ELPLW06/ELPLW04 2

ELPLW08 240

ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04......

ELPLM10/ELPLM06 2

Appendix

Monitoring and Controlling 215 E L P L W 08 240 E L P L M 15 / E L P L H 09 / E L P L S 04

Epson Projector Management....21540/51986

Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Cont F(b)_I:M1:T/F:I:P:I,Mn^L,M1:T/F:I:P:I,Mn2,1,5.

Contents

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Contents - 1

ELPLLO8/ELPLLO7 2744ademarks and Copyrights ELPLRO4 245 Pariation Distances for EB-1 1070 247 List of Safety Symbols 287

ELPLM08 247 ELPLX01/ELPLX01W 248 ELPLU03 249 ELPLU04/ELPLU02 250 ELPLW05 251 ELPLW06/ELPLW04 252 ELPLW08 253 ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04 254 ELPLM10/ELPLM06 255 ELPLM11/ELPLM07 256 ELPLL08/ELPLL07 257 ELPLR04 258

Polarizer (ELPPL01) Installation Distance 259 EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U 259 EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W 259 EB-L1070 259

Adjustment Range for Projected Images 261

H/V-Keystone....261 Curved Surface....261 Corner Wall....268

Supported Monitor Displays 274

Supported Monitor Displays 274 PC 274 SD 276 HD 276 4K (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only) 277

Specifications 279

Projector General Specifications....279

Appearance 284

General Notes 285

About Notations 285

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - General Notes 285 - 1

Introduction

This chapter explains the names for each part.

The illustrations in this guide show the lens unit attached to the projector.

Front/Top
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Introduction - 1

text_image Technical diagram of a projector with numbered parts and exploded view annotations
Name Function
1Air intake ventTakes in air to cool the projector internally.
Name Function
2Projection lensImages are projected through here.WarningDo not look into the lens while projecting. This could cause damage to eyesight due to the powerful light emitted.CautionWhen shifting the lens, do not put your hands near the lens unit. Your fingers may get caught between the lens unit and the projector, and cause an injury.
3Remote ReceiverReceives signals from the remote control.
4Status indicatorsThe color of the indicators and whether they are flashing or lit indicate the status of the projector."Reading the Indicators" p.175
5Air intake vent (air filter)Takes in air to cool the projector internally."Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent" p.204
6USB-A portAllows you to install the optional wireless LAN unit and connect the projector to the network.Allows you to connect a commercially available USB flash drive and play the playlist in Content Playback mode.
7Wireless LAN indicatorIndicates the access status to the optional wireless LAN unit."Optional Accessories and Consumables" p.233
8Cable coverCover for the port connectors section at the rear to protect connected cables."Attaching the Cable Cover" p.55
9Lens replacement coverRemove when attaching or removing the lens.➤ "Removing and Attaching the Projector Lens Unit"p.27[73X0]CautionWhen moving the projector, do not hold the lens replacement cover. The lens replacement cover may be removed and the projector may fall, which could cause an injury.
10Air exhaust ventExhaust vent for air used to cool the projector internally.[23X8]CautionWhile projecting, do not put your face or hands near the air exhaust vent, and do not place objects that may become warped or damaged by heat near the vent. Hot air from the air exhaust vent could cause burns, warping, or accidents to occur.

Caution

Caution

Rear
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 1

text_image Diagram of a device rear panel with labeled ports and control panels, showing numbered annotations for identification.
Name Function
1Power inletConnects the power cord to the projector.
2Control panel“Control Panel” p.18
3Security slotThe security slot is compatible with the Microsaver Security System manufactured by Kensington.“Anti Theft/Fall Prevention” p.119
4Connector Ports“Connector Ports” p.17

Connector Ports
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 2

text_image 15 14 13 12 11 LAN HDMI HDXP2.20 一验器图 DV-D HDMI HDXP2.2 Service HDMI HDBT Remote Rs-232C Audio2 Audio1 Audio3 Monitor Out Computer Audio1 Audio Out 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Name Function
1BNC portFor analog RGB signals from a computer and component video signals from other video sources.
2Computer PortFor analog RGB signals from a computer and component video signals from other video sources.
3Audio3 portInputs audio from equipment connected to the HDMI port or the DVI-D port.
4Audio1 portInputs audio from equipment connected to the Computer port.
5Monitor Out portOutputs to an external monitor the analog signal from the computer connected to the Computer port or the BNC port. You cannot output signals input from other ports or component video signals.
6Audio Out portOutputs audio from the currently projected image to an external speaker.
7Audio2 portInputs audio from equipment connected to the BNC port.
Name Function
8Cable holderRun a commercially available cable tie to secure cables.
9RS-232C portWhen controlling the projector from a computer, connect it to the computer with an RS-232C cable. This port is for control use and should not normally be used.➤ "ESC/VP21 Commands" p.226
10Remote portConnects the optional remote control cable set and inputs signals from the remote control. When the remote control cable is plugged into the Remote port, the remote receiver on the projector is disabled.➤ "Optional Accessories and Consumables" p.233
11Service portThis is used for batch settings. This port is for control use and should not normally be used.➤ "Batch Setup" p.164
12HDMI portInputs video signals from HDMI compatible video equipment and computers.
13DVI-D portInputs the computer DVI-D signals.
14HDBaseT portConnects a LAN cable to the optional HDBaseT Transmitter.➤ "Connecting an HDBaseT Transmitter" p.53➤ "Optional Accessories and Consumables" p.233
15LAN portConnects a LAN cable to connect to a network.

Base
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 3

text_image Technical diagram of a device casing with numbered components and connecting lines indicating assembly or connection points.
Name Function
1Front feetWhen setup on a surface such as a desk, extend and retract the feet to adjust the height or tilt of the image."Adjusting the Height of the Projected Image (for Normal Installment)" p.41"Adjusting the Horizontal Tilt (for Normal Installment)" p.42
2Rear feet
3Security cable Installation pointPass a commercially available anti-theft wire lock or a wire to prevent the projector from falling through here and lock it in place."Anti Theft/Fall Prevention" p.119

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 4

flowchart
graph TD
    A["On"] --> B["Standby"]
    C["Menu"] --> D["Exc"]
    E["Enter"] --> F["Lens"]
    G["A/V Mute"] --> H["Home Position (Base)"]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
    style E fill:#cff,stroke:#333
    style F fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style G fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
    style H fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
Name Function
4Screw holes to fix the cable coverScrew holes to fix the cable cover in place.◆ "Attaching the Cable Cover" p.55
5Air filter cover fixing screwScrews to fix the air filter cover in place.
6Ceiling mount fixing points (ELPMB47/ELPMB48, 4 points)Attach the optional ceiling mount here when suspending the projector from a ceiling.◆ "Installing the Projector" p.27◆ "Optional Accessories and Consumables" p.233
7Ceiling mount fixing points (ELPMB22, 4 points)

Control Panel

Name Function
1[button]Turns the projector on.
2[Source Search] buttonChanges to the next input source that is sending an image."Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search)" p.61
3[Menu] buttonDisplays and closes the Configuration menu."Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
4[ ]Button·When the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, it accepts and enters the current selection and moves to the next level.·If pressed while projecting analog RGB signals from the Computer port or the BNC port, you can automatically optimize Tracking, Sync., and Position.
5[ ] Buttons·Displays the Control Panel Lock screen allowing you to make settings to lock the control panel buttons. "Restricting Operation" p.117·If pressed when the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, this button selects menu items and setting values. "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136 "Using the Help" p.173
6[ ] Buttons·Displays a test pattern. "Displaying the Test Pattern" p.33·If pressed when the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, this button selects menu items and setting values. "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136 "Using the Help" p.173
7[A/V Mute] buttonTurns the video and audio on or off. "Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute)" p.102
8[Lens] buttonDisplays the adjustment screens for lens shift, zoom, focus, and distortion in that order each time the button is pressed.If pressed for more than three seconds, the lens position moves to the home position.
Name Function
9[] buttonsDisplays the Info menu from the Configuration menu."Info Menu (Display Only)" p.161If pressed when the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, this button selects menu items and setting values."Configuration Menu Operations" p.136"Using the Help" p.173
10[] buttonsPerforms screen adjustments using the settings in Geometry Correction from the Configuration menu.Settings - Geometry Correction p.143If pressed when the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, this button selects menu items and setting values."Configuration Menu Operations" p.136"Using the Help" p.173
11[Esc] buttonStops the current function.If pressed when the Configuration menu is displayed, it moves to the previous menu level."Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
12[∅] buttonTurns the projector off.

Remote Control
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 5

text_image On Standby Search HDMI HDBase DVI-D Computer BNC LAN SDI Auto Aspect Lab Note Rest Pattern Freeze Split Lens Shift Zoom Focus Menu Distortion Esc /S uV Mode Default Page Volume E-Zoom i Geometry Memory Word 1 Name: Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ID 0 Num ID ON O/F Home EPSON Projector
Name Function
1[1] buttonTurns the projector on.
2[0] buttonTurns the projector off.
3Change input buttonsChanges to images from each input port."Switching to the Target Image by Remote Control" p.62The [SDI] button is unavailable.
4[Aspect] buttonEach time the button is pressed, the aspect mode changes."Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image" p.80
5[Auto] buttonIf pressed while projecting analog RGB signals from the Computer port or the BNC port, you can automatically optimize Tracking, Sync., and Position.
6[Freeze] buttonImages are paused or unpaused."Freezing the Image (Freeze)" p.103
7[Test Pattern] buttonDisplays a test pattern."Displaying the Test Pattern" p.33
8[Lens Shift] buttonPress to adjust the lens shift."Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34If pressed for more than three seconds, the lens position moves to the home position.
9[Zoom] buttonPress to adjust the zoom."Adjusting the Image Size" p.37
10[Menu] buttonDisplays and closes the Configuration menu."Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
11[ ] [ ] ▶buttons•Press to adjust focus, zoom, distortion, and lens shift. ◆ "Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34 ◆ "Adjusting the Image Size" p.37 ◆ "Correcting the Focus" p.38 •When the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, pressing these buttons selects menu items and setting values. ◆ "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
12[ ] buttonWhen the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, it accepts and enters the current selection and moves to the next level. ◆ "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
13[A/V Mute] buttonTurns the video and audio on or off. ◆ "Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute)" p.102
14[Page] buttons [+] [+]•Press to change the test pattern while a test pattern is displayed. •Moves to the previous or next image file when projecting images from a computer connected via a network.
15[Volume] buttons [+] [<0][+] decreases the volume. [+] increases the volume. ◆ "Adjusting the Volume" p.63
16[ ] buttonDisplays the Info menu from the Configuration menu. ◆ "Info Menu (Display Only)" p.161
17[User1] button [User2] button [User3] buttonSelect any frequently used item from the Configuration menu items, and assign it to any of these buttons. By pressing the button, the assigned menu item selection/adjustment screen is displayed, allowing you to make one-touch settings/adjustments. ◆ "Settings Menu" p.143
Name Function
18Numeric buttons●Enter the Password.⇨"Setting Password Protection" p.115●Use this button to enter numbers in Network settings from the Configuration menu.
19[ID] buttonHold down this button and press the numeric buttons to select the ID for the projector you want to operate using the remote control.⇨"ID Settings" p.42
20[ID] switchUse this switch to enable (On)/disable (Off) ID settings for the remote control.⇨"ID Settings" p.42
21Remote portConnects the optional remote control cable set and outputs signals from the remote control.⇨"Optional Accessories" p.233When the remote control cable is plugged into this remote port, the remote control light-emitting is disabled.
22[→buttonDisplays and closes the Home screen.⇨"Home Screen" p.59
23[Num] buttonHold down this button and press the numeric buttons to enter passwords and numbers.⇨"Setting Password Protection" p.115
24[Geometry] buttonCorrects distortion in the projected image.⇨"Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image" p.64
25[Memory] buttonPerforms operations and makes settings for the memory function.⇨"Memory Function" p.110
26[E-Zoom] buttons [⊕][⊖]Enlarges or reduces the image without changing the projection size.⇨"Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom)" p.104
27[Default] buttonEnabled when [Default]: Reset is displayed on the configuration menu guide. The settings being adjusted are returned to their default values.➤ "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
28[Esc] button●Stops the current function.●If pressed when the Configuration menu is displayed, it moves to the previous level.➤ "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
29[Focus] buttonEach time the button is pressed, the adjustment screens for focus and distortion are displayed in that order.➤ "Correcting the Focus" p.38
30[Split] buttonEach time the button is pressed, the image changes between projecting two images simultaneously by splitting the projected screen, or projecting one image as normal.➤ "Projecting Two Images Simultaneously (Split Screen)" p.99
31[Color Mode] buttonEach time the button is pressed, the Color Mode changes.➤ "Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode)" p.76
32[Search] buttonChanges to the next input source that is sending an image.➤ "Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search)" p.61
33[ ]buttonIlluminates the buttons on the remote control for approximately 15 seconds. This is useful when using the remote control in the dark.
34IndicatorA light is emitted when outputting remote control signals.
35Remote control light-emitting areaOutputs remote control signals.

Handy remote control operations

You can perform the following operations by simply pressing one of the buttons on the remote control.

Operation Set
Reverse the projected image vertically.(Switch the Projection between Front and Front/Ceiling)◆ "Changing the direction of the image(projection mode)" p.31Hold down the [A/V Mute] button for more than five seconds.
Selecting the password security settings.◆ "Managing Users (Password Protection)" p.115Hold down the [Freeze] button for more than five seconds. The Password Protection screen is displayed, and you can select various settings.
Locking or unlocking some of the operation of the buttons on the remote control.◆ "Remote control button lock" p.118Hold down the [▲] button for more than five seconds.
Initializing the settings for the Remote Receiver in the Configuration menu.(Enables all Remote receivers for this projector.)Hold down the [Menu] button for more than 15 seconds.

Part Names and Functions

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Part Names and Functions - 1

Operation Set
Displaying frequently used Configuration menu items.Press the [User1], [User2], or [User3] button. You can set the menu item you want to assign to each button in User Button. ⚪ Settings - User Button p.143The following items can be assigned.Light Source Mode, Multi-Projection, Resolution, On-Screen Display, Display the QR Code, Image Enhancement, Frame Interpolation, Link Menu, Content Playback, USBWhen you press the button for which On-Screen Display is assigned, menus or messages are not displayed on the screen. When the same button is pressed, they are displayed again. If On-Screen Display is enabled, you cannot operate the Configuration menu (except to switch the color mode and input source).

Replacing the remote control batteries

If delays in the responsiveness of the remote control occur or if it does not operate after it has been used for some time, it probably means that the batteries are becoming flat. When this happens, replace them with new batteries. Have two AA size alkaline or manganese batteries ready. You cannot use other batteries except for the AA size alkaline or manganese.

Attention

Make sure you read the following manual before handling the batteries.

Safety Instructions

1 Remove the battery cover.

While pushing the battery compartment cover catch, lift the cover up.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

natural_image Illustration of a remote control device with a blue scroll and arrow indicating action (no text or symbols)

2 Replace the old batteries with new batteries.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

natural_image Line drawing of a remote control casing with battery terminals and internal components (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 3

Caution

Check the positions of the (+) and (-) marks inside the battery holder to ensure the batteries are inserted the correct way.

If the batteries are not used correctly, they could explode or leak causing a fire, injury, or damage to the product.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 1

Replace the battery cover.

Press the battery compartment cover until it clicks into place.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 2

natural_image Line drawing of a remote control device with a blue internal component and a blue scroll wheel (no text or symbols)

Remote control operating range
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 3

text_image 30m 15m 60° 60° 15m 30m 15m 30° 30° 15m 30m 20° 30° 20m 30m 20m 10° 20° 20m 30m

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 4

To restrict reception of the operation signals from the remote control, set Remote Receiver.

Settings - Remote Receiver p.143

Connecting a cable to the remote control

You can make operations securely with the optional remote control cable set when you use multiple units of this projector in the same place or when there are obstacles around the remote receiver.

"Optional Accessories" p.233

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a cable to the remote control - 1

text_image HDMI 4NDBT Spike B2C M3/MP HD Type V1Type Audio Audio OUT Remote Remote

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a cable to the remote control - 2

- When the remote control cable is plugged into the Remote port, the remote receiver on the projector is disabled.

- You can also connect the optional HDBaseT transmitter and remote control with the cable to control the projector.

"Connecting an HDBaseT Transmitter" p.53

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a cable to the remote control - 3

Preparing the Projector

This chapter explains how to install the projector and connect projection sources.

Removing and Attaching the Projector Lens Unit

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Removing and Attaching the Projector Lens Unit - 1

Warning

Make sure you disconnect the power cord from the projector before removing or attaching the lens unit to the projector. Otherwise, it could cause an electric shock.

Attaching

Attention

  • Do not attach the lens unit when the projector's lens insertion section is facing up. Dust or dirt could enter the projector.
  • Try not to touch the lens section with your hand or fingers. If fingerprints or oils are left on the surface of the lens, projection quality deteriorates.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

•The projector supports lens with the following model numbers. ELPLX01, ELPLX01W, ELPLU03, ELPLU04, ELPLW05, ELPLW06, ELPLW08, ELPLM08, ELPLM09, ELPLM10, ELPLM11, ELPLM15, ELPLL08, ELPLS04, ELPLU02, ELPLR04, ELPLW04, ELPLM06, ELPLM07, ELPLL07
When using the following lens, set the Lens Type in the Configuration menu according to the lens you are using so that distortion correction is performed correctly.
ELPLS04, ELPLU02, ELPLR04, ELPLW04, ELPLM06, ELPLM07, ELPLL07
Extended - Operation - Advanced - Lens Type p.146
- In a normal installation, the image may be tilted depending on your lens. Adjust the tilt of the image using the front and rear feet. - "Adjusting the Horizontal Tilt (for Normal Installment)" p.42
- For information on installing ELPLX01/ELPLX01W, see the User's Guide supplied with ELPLX01/ELPLX01W.

1 Pull the lens replacement cover straight out.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

natural_image Illustration of a hand inserting a blue plastic component into a rectangular device (no text or symbols visible)

2 Release the lock lever if it is locked.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 3

text_image ASO Lock

3 Pinch the lever, and then move it counter-clockwise.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 4

text_image Release Lock

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 5

When using the following lens, attach the supplied lens connector cap to protect the port.

ELPLS04, ELPLU02, ELPLR04, ELPLW04, ELPLM06, ELPLM07, ELPLL07

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 6

natural_image Technical line drawing of a mechanical component with no visible text or symbols

4 Insert the lens unit straight into the lens insertion section with the white circle on the lens on top.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 7

text_image Diagram showing a device with a magnified inset of its internal structure, labeled in Chinese.

5 While holding the lens unit firmly, pinch the lever and turn it clockwise to lock the lens unit.

Check that the lens cannot be detached.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 8

text_image Release Lock

6 Secure the lever with the lever lock to make sure it does not come loose.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 9

text_image Diagram illustrating a projector setup with labeled components and process flow, showing mechanical assembly and component positioning.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 10

The lever is secured even without using the lever lock, but this adds an additional measure of safety.

7 Attach the lens replacement cover.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 11

natural_image Illustration of a projector with a blue cover and cable, no text or symbols present

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 12

When projecting down, we recommend securing the front cover with commercially available screws (M3 x 8 mm).

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 13

text_image Technical diagram showing front and side views of a projector with labeled components and cable connections

Lens Calibration

After replacing the lens unit, calibrate the lens so that the projector can correctly acquire the lens position and adjustment range.

After attaching a different lens unit from the previous one, a message is displayed when the projector is turned on.

Select Yes to calibrate the lens.

Lens calibration takes up to about 100 seconds until it is complete. When it is complete, the lens position returns to the position before calibration (ELPLX01/ELPLX01W returns to the standard position).

Attention

If the message "Lens Calibration failed." is displayed, remove the lens unit and then reinstall it. If the message continues to be displayed, stop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.

Epson Projector Contact List

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

- You can perform lens calibration using one of the following methods.

- Press the [Default] button on the remote control for three seconds or more.

- Configuration Menu

Extended - Operation - Lens Calibration p.146

- If no message is displayed after attaching the lens unit, perform lens calibration from the Configuration menu.

- If you do not calibrate the lens, the following functions may not operate correctly.

Focus, Distortion, Zoom, Lens Shift, Memory (Lens Position)

Removing

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Removing - 1

Caution

Wait for a while after turning off the projector before removing the lens unit (Approx. 30 mins.). Touching the lens unit immediately after projecting or turning off may cause burns.

Attention

If the lens shift has been done, move the lens position to the home position before replacing the lens unit.

"Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

The projector uses a laser as the light source. As a safety measure, the light source turns off when the lens is removed. Attach the lens, and then press the ⑪ button to turn it back on.

1 Pull the lens replacement cover straight out.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

natural_image Diagram of a device with a blue component inserted into a housing, connected to wires (no text or symbols visible)

2 If the lock lever has been secured with a stopper, remove the stopper.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 3

text_image ase Lock

3 While holding the lens unit firmly, hold the lock lever and turn it counterclockwise to unlock the lens unit. Pull the lens unit straight out as it is released.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 4

text_image Release Part Lock ① ②

Installation Settings

Changing the direction of the image (projection mode)

You can change the direction of the image using Projection mode from the Configuration menu.

Extended - Projection p.146

When Front is the standard, the image directions for each projection mode are as follows.

Front (default) Front/Ceiling
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing the direction of the image (projection mode) - 1

natural_image City skyline with modern skyscrapers under a clear blue sky, no visible text or signage

Rear Rear/Ceiling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing the direction of the image (projection mode) - 2

natural_image City skyline with modern high-rise buildings reflected in a clear blue sky (no text or symbols visible)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing the direction of the image (projection mode) - 3

natural_image City skyline with modern skyscrapers under a clear blue sky (no visible text or signage)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing the direction of the image (projection mode) - 4

natural_image Cityscape with modern high-rise buildings reflected in a clear blue sky (no visible text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing the direction of the image (projection mode) - 5

- You can change the setting as follows by pressing down the [A/V Mute] button on the remote control for about five seconds.

Front ↔ Front/Ceiling

Rear Rear/Ceiling

- To rotate the menu display, set OSD Rotation in the Configuration menu.

Extended - Display - OSD Rotation p.146

Screen Settings

Set the Screen Type according to the aspect ratio of the screen being used. The area where the image is displayed matches the shape of the screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Screen Settings - 1

The settings for the Screen Type at the time of purchase are as follows:

•WUXGA/WXGA projector: 16:10

•XGA projector: 4:3

1 Press the Menu button while projecting. ◆ "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136

2 Select Display from Extended.

3 Select Screen Type from Screen.

4 Select the screen's aspect ratio. The shape of the background test pattern changes depending on the setting.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Screen Settings - 2

text_image [Screen Type] 4:3 16:9 16:10 Return [Esc] / [◆]: Return [◆]: Select [Menu]: Exit

5 Press the Menu button to finish making settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Screen Settings - 3

- When you change the Screen Type, adjust the aspect ratio for the projected image as well.

"Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image" p.80

- The Message Broadcasting function for Epson Projector Management does not support this function.

Adjusting the position of the image on the projected screen

You can adjust the position of the image if there are margins between the edge of the image and the projected screen frame due to the Screen Type setting.

Example: When the Screen Type is set to 4:3 for the WUXGA/WXGA projector

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the position of the image on the projected screen - 1

natural_image Blue square with two white arrows pointing left and right, no text or symbols present

You can move the image to the left and right.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

"Configuration Menu Operations" p.136

2 Select Display from Extended.

3 Select Screen Position from Screen.

4 Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to adjust the position of the image.

You can check the current display position by using the background test pattern.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the position of the image on the projected screen - 2

text_image [Screen Position] Shift Direction: Top 0

Esc:Return [◀◆▶]:Move Menu:Exit

5 Press the Menu button to finish making settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the position of the image on the projected screen - 3

The Screen Position cannot be adjusted in the following situations.

- If you are using a WUXGA/WXGA projector and the Screen Type is set to 16:10

- If you are using an XGA projector and the Screen Type is set to 4:3

Displaying the Test Pattern

A test pattern can be displayed to adjust the projection status without connecting video equipment.

The shape of a test pattern is according to the setting of Screen Type. Set Screen Type first.

"Screen Settings" p.32

1 Press the [Test Pattern] button of the remote control or the 📄 button on the control panel while projecting.

2 Press the [◀][▶] buttons on the remote control or the [◀] button on the control panel to change the test pattern.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Test Pattern - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Test Pattern - 2

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Test Pattern - 3

text_image Standard Cross-hatching Cross-hatching B Color Bars V Color Bars H Grayscale Gray Bars V Gray Bars H White Black 4:3 Aspect Frame Cross-hatching R Cross-hatching G Checkerboard 1 Checkerboard 2 16:10 Aspect Frame 16:9 Aspect Frame

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Test Pattern - 4

  • To set menu items that cannot be set while the test pattern is being displayed or to fine-tune the projected image, project an image from the connected device.
  • During image adjustment, press the [Page] buttons [↑] [↓] on the remote control to change the test pattern.
  • You can also select a test pattern from the Configuration menu.
    Settings - Test Pattern p.143

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Test Pattern - 5

Press the Esc button to close the test pattern.

Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)

The lens can be shifted to adjust the position of the projected image, for example, when the projector cannot be installed directly in front of the screen.

The ranges within which the image can be moved are shown below. The position of the projected image cannot be moved to both the horizontal and vertical maximum values.

EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U/EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment) - 1

text_image V 1/2H H × 30% H H × 30% 1/2V 4 3 ① ② ③ ④

1 Center of lens
② Projected image when the lens position is moved to the home position
③ Maximum motion range: V x 67%
4 When the horizontal direction is at the maximum value: V x 19%

EB-L1070

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment) - 2

text_image V 1/2V 1/2H H × 30% H H × 30% ① ② ③ ④

① Center of lens
② Projected image when the lens position is moved to the home position
③ Maximum motion range: V x 57%
4 When the horizontal direction is at the maximum value: V x 16%

When using ultra-short focus lens ELPLX01/ELPLX01W

EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U/EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment) - 3

text_image V 1/2H H × 10% H H × 10% ① ② ③

① Center of lens
② Projected image for positional reference
③ Maximum motion range: V x 17%
* When the horizontal direction is at the maximum value, the image cannot be moved up.

EB-L1070

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment) - 4

text_image V 1/2H H × 8% H H × 8% ① ② ③

① Center of lens
② Projected image for positional reference
③ Maximum motion range: V x 7%
* When the horizontal direction is at the maximum value, the image cannot be moved up.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment) - 5

  • When adjusting the image height with the vertical lens shift, adjust by moving the image from the bottom to the top. If it is adjusted from the top to the bottom, the image position may move down slightly after adjusting.
  • We recommend setting the focus, zoom, and lens shift at least 20 minutes after you start the projection. After projecting videos, we recommend waiting for more than 20 minutes to make settings for the Focus/Zoom/Lens Shift.
    •The image will be clearest when the lens position is moved to the home position.
  • If you hold down the [Lens Shift] button on the remote control or the [Lens] button on the control panel for at least three seconds, the lens position moves to the home position.
  • If you set A/V Output to Always On, you can move the lens position to the home position even if the projector is in standby mode.

Extended - A/V Settings - A/V Output p.146

- ELPLR04 does not support lens shift.

1 Press the [Lens Shift] button on the remote control or the [Lens] button on the control panel.

Repeatedly press the |Lens| button on the control panel until the lens shift adjustment screen is displayed.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment) - 6

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Auto"] --> B["Aspect"]
    B --> C["Car Mass"]
    D["Text Pattern"] --> E["Freeze"]
    E --> F["Split"]
    G["Lens Shift"] --> H["Zoom"]
    H --> I["Focus"]
    J["EU"] --> K["Distortion"]
    K --> L["Esc /"]
    M["A/V Mute"] --> N["Lens"]
    N --> O["Home Post"]
    N --> P["3secs"]

Installing the Projector

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Projector - 1

2 Press the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons to adjust the position of the projected image.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Projector - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    subgraph LeftPanel
        A["Menu"] --> B["Distortion"]
        B --> C["Esc /"]
        D["A/V Mute"] --> E["Default"]
    end
    subgraph RightPanel
        F["A/V Mute"] --> G["Lens"]
        G --> H["Position (3secs)"]
    end
    I["Video Display"] --> J["0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0"]
    end

The displayed screen may differ depending on your lens.

3 Press the Esc button to finish the adjustment.

Adjusting the Image Size

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Image Size - 1

This is not available for ELPLX01, ELPLX01W, and ELPLR04.

1 Press the [Zoom] button on the remote control or the [Lens] button on the control panel.

Repeatedly press the [Lens] button on the control panel until the zoom adjustment screen is displayed.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Image Size - 2

text_image Auto Aspect Color Test Pattern Freeze Split Lens Shift Lens Focus Menu Distribution Esc / A/V Mute Home Page (4+ 2secs)

2 Press the [ ][ ] buttons to adjust.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Image Size - 3

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Menu"] --> B["Distortion"]
    B --> C["Esc"]
    C --> D["AV"]
    D --> E["Mute"]
    E --> F["Default"]
    G["Enter"] --> H["i"]
    H --> I["Esc"]

The displayed screen may differ depending on your lens.

3 Press the Esc button to finish the adjustment.

Correcting the Focus

1 Press the [Focus] button on the remote control or the [Lens] button on the control panel.

Repeatedly press the [Lens] button on the control panel until the focus adjustment screen is displayed.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting the Focus - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Auto"] --> B["Aspect"]
    B --> C["ColorMode"]
    D["Info Pattern"] --> E["Freeze"]
    E --> F["Lens"]
    G["Lens Shift"] --> H["Zoom"]
    I["Menu"] --> J["Distortion"]
    K["Focus"] --> L["Link"]
    M["A/V Mute"] --> N["Home Pull-A+ 2secs"]
    O["Lens"] --> P["Home Pull-A+ 2secs"]

2 Press the [◀][▶]buttons to adjust.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting the Focus - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Menu"] --> B["Distortion"]
    B --> C["Esc/✓"]
    C --> D["A/V Paste"]
    D --> E["Default"]
    F["(menu)"] --> G["Enter"]
    G --> H["i"]
    H --> I["Play Button"]

The displayed screen may differ depending on your lens.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting the Focus - 3

When using the following lens, a message prompting you to adjust the distortion (image warping) is displayed. After adjusting the focus, adjust the distortion.

ELPLX01, ELPLX01W, ELPLU03, ELPLU04, ELPLW05, ELPLW08, ELPLU02

"Correcting Distortion (Image Warping)" p.38

3 Press the Esc button to finish the adjustment.

Correcting Distortion (Image Warping)

When using a short throw zoom lens and focusing at the center of the screen, the surrounding image may warp and be out of focus. Follow the steps below to correct the warping.

1 Press the [Focus] button on the remote control or the [Lens] button on the control panel.

Repeatedly press the [Lens] button on the control panel until the focus adjustment screen is displayed.

2 Press the [◀][▶] buttons to focus the image around the center of the lens.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion (Image Warping) - 1

natural_image Diagram showing a grid pattern with a blue dot and dashed lines, connected to an air conditioner unit (no text or symbols present)

3 Press the [Focus] button on the remote control or the [Lens] button on the control panel again. Repeatedly press the [Lens] button on the control panel until the distortion adjustment screen is displayed.

4 Press the [◀][▶] button to adjust the focus of the surrounding area.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion (Image Warping) - 2

natural_image Diagram showing a grid plane with a blue dot and a connected air conditioner unit (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion (Image Warping) - 3

text_image When using the ELPLU02, a message prompting you to manually adjust the distortion is displayed. Turn the distortion ring counterclockwise, and then adjust the focus. After adjusting the focus, manually turn the distortion ring to correct the image warping.

Registering and Loading Lens Adjustment Values

You can register a lens position whose lens shift, zoom, focus, and distortion was adjusted in memory, and load it when necessary. You can register up to 10 values.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Registering and Loading Lens Adjustment Values - 1

- This feature cannot be used if the following lenses are attached. ELPLS04, ELPLU02, ELPLR04, ELPLW04, ELPLM06, ELPLM07, ELPLI07 - If you did not calibrate your lens, a message is displayed when you save a memory. Select Yes to calibrate the lens. - The lens position when a memory is loaded may not completely match the lens position when the memory was saved. - If there is a large discrepancy between the lens position when a memory is loaded and the lens position when the memory was saved, calibrate the lens.

Extended - Operation - Lens Calibration p.146

1 Press the [Memory] button while projecting.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Registering and Loading Lens Adjustment Values - 2

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Registering and Loading Lens Adjustment Values - 3

You can also operate from the Configuration menu.

Settings - Memory p.143

2 Select Lens Position, and then press the [←] button.

Installing the Projector

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Projector - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Projector - 2

text_image [Memory] Return Signal Settings Lens Position Geometry Correction Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

3 Select the function you want to perform, then press the [] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Projector - 3

text_image [Memory] Return Load Memory Save Memory Erase Memory Rename Memory Reset Memory Settings Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] / [●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit
Function Explanation
Load MemoryLoads the saved memory. When you select a memory name and press the [←] button, the lens is automatically adjusted according to the settings of the selected memory.
Save MemoryRegisters current settings in the memory. When you select a memory name and press the [←] button, the settings are saved.
Erase MemoryErases the registered memory. When you select a memory name and press the [←] button, a message is displayed. Select Yes, and then press the [←] button to erase the selected memory.
Rename MemoryChanges the memory name. Select the memory name you want to change, and then press the [←] button. Enter the memory name using the soft keyboard. "Soft keyboard operations" p.152When you have finished, move the cursor over Finish, and then press the [←] button.

Function Explanation

Reset Memory

Resets the name and settings of a saved memory.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Function Explanation - 1

If the mark on the left of the memory name is turned blue, it means the memory has already been registered. When you select a registered memory, a message is displayed asking you to confirm that you want to overwrite the memory. If you select Yes, the previous settings are deleted and the current settings are registered.

Adjusting the Height of the Projected Image (for Normal Installment)

Extend or retract the front feet to make adjustments. You can adjust the position of the image by tilting the projector up to 10 degrees.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Height of the Projected Image (for Normal Installment) - 1

text_image Diagram illustrating light refraction and reflection with labeled components and directional arrows

① Extend the front feet.
② Retract the front feet.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Height of the Projected Image (for Normal Installment) - 2

The larger the angle of tilt, the harder it becomes to focus. Install the projector so that it only needs to be tilted at a small angle.

Adjusting the Horizontal Tilt (for Normal Installment)

Extend and retract the front and rear feet to adjust the projector's horizontal tilt. You can adjust the tilt within a range of ±1.5^ .

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Horizontal Tilt (for Normal Installment) - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Input"] --> B["Data Input"]
    B --> C["Project Unit"]
    C --> D["Control Unit"]
    D --> E["Output"]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
    style E fill:#ffc,stroke:#333

① Extend the front and rear feet.
② Retract the front and rear feet.

Attention

The rear feet are detachable. You can extend the feet by approximately 12 mm before they detach.

ID Settings

When an ID is set for the projector and the remote control, you can use the remote control to operate only the projector with a matching ID. This is very useful when managing multiple projectors. You can set up to 30 IDs.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - ID Settings - 1

  • Operation using the remote control is possible only for projectors that are within the operating range of the remote control.
    "Remote control operating range" p.24
  • IDs are ignored when the projector ID is set to Off or the remote control ID is set to 0.
  • If you use Epson Web Control, you can operate a specific projector from a mobile device.
    "Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215

Set the projector ID

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
"Configuration Menu Operations" p.136
2 Select Multi-Projection from Extended.
3 Select Projector ID, and then press the [◀] button.
4 Press the [][]buttons to select an ID number.

Installing the Projector

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Projector - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Projector - 2

text_image [Multi-Projection] Projector ID 01 Set [Esc] :Return [◆◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

5 Select Set, and then press the [←] button.
6 Press the Menu button to close the Configuration menu.

Checking the projector ID

During projection, press the [▲ button while holding down the [ID] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Checking the projector ID - 1

text_image Remote control 7 8 9 ID 0 Num 0 Off Home EPSON Projector ID: D2

When you press the buttons, the current Projector ID is displayed on the projection screen. It disappears in about three seconds.

Setting the remote control ID

1 Set the remote control [ID] switch to On.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the remote control ID - 1

text_image 4 5 6 7 8 9 ID 0 On Off On Off ID On Off

2 While holding the [ID] button, press a number button to select a number to match the ID of the projector you want to operate.

"Checking the projector ID" p.43 Enter a two digit number (Example: 01 when the ID is 1).

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the remote control ID - 2

Once this setting has been made, the projector that can be operated by the remote control is limited.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the remote control ID - 3

The remote control ID setting is saved in the remote control. Even if the remote control batteries are removed to replace them and so on, the stored ID setting is retained. However, if the batteries are left out for a long time, it is reset to the default value (ID0).

Setting the Time

You can set the time for the projector. The set time is used for the schedule function.

s "Scheduling Function" p.112

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the Time - 1

- When you turn on the projector for the first time, the message "Do you want to set the time?" is displayed. When you select Yes, the screen from step 4 is displayed.

- When Schedule Protection is set to On in Password Protection, settings related to the date and time cannot be changed. You can make changes after setting Schedule Protection to Off.

s "Managing Users (Password Protection)" p.115

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

s "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136

2 Select Operation from Extended.

3 Select Date & Time, and then press the [←] button.

4 Make settings for the date and time.

Use the soft keyboard to enter the date and time.

s "Soft keyboard operations" p.152

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the Time - 2

text_image [Date & Time] Return Date & Time Daylight Saving Time Daylight Saving Time Off DST Start DST End DST Adjustment (min) 0 Internet Time

Date & Time

Submenu Function
DateSet today's date.
TimeSet the current time.
Time Difference (UTC)Set the time difference from Coordinated Universal Time.
SetThe settings made in Date & Time are applied.

Daylight Saving Time

Submenu Function
Daylight Saving TimeSet whether or not (On/Off) to activate the daylight saving time. DST Adjustment (min) adjusts the time difference between the standard time and daylight saving time.
DST StartSet the date and time to start the daylight saving time.
DST EndSet the date and time to end the daylight saving time.
SetThe settings made in Daylight Saving Time are applied.

Internet Time

Submenu Function
Internet TimeSet to On to update the time automatically through an Internet time server.
Internet Time ServerInput the IP address for an Internet time server.
SetThe settings made in Internet 'Time are applied.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the Time - 3

When changing settings, make sure you select Settings, and then press the ↻ button.

5 Press the Menu button to finish making settings.

Other Settings

Settings related to basic operations

Purpose Setting Methods
To start/stop projection by turning on/off the main power or plugging in or unplugging the power plug of the projector.Set Direct Power On to On. (Default value: Off)Extended - Operation - Direct Power On p.146The projector can be powered off directly by the breaker because it supports the direct shutdown function.
To disable the automatic shutdown function.Set Sleep Mode to Off. (Default value: On)Extended - Operation - Sleep Mode p.146Set A/V Mute Timer to Off.Extended - Operation - A/V Mute Settings - A/V Mute Timer p.146
To disable buzzer beeps generated when the projector is powered on/off.Set Beep to Off. (Default value: On)Extended - Operation - Advanced - Beep p.146
To operate the projector by communication command even when the power of the projector is off.Set Standby Mode to Communication On. (Default value: Communication Off)Extended - Standby Modc p.146
To operate the projector by communication command while executing A/V Mute.Set A/V Mute Release to A/V Mute.Extended - Operation - A/V Mute Settings - A/V Mute Release p.146The default value is Any Button. If you operate the projector while A/V Mute is on, A/V Mute is released.
Turn off the power by pressing the [⏻] button once.Set Standby Confirmation to Off. (Default value: On)Extended - Display - Standby Confirmation p.146

Settings related to display

Purpose Setting Methods
To change the menu position.Change the settings of Menu Position.➤ Extended - Display - Menu Position p.146
To change the menu direction.Change the settings of OSD Rotation.➤ Extended - Display - OSD Rotation p.146
To prevent the display of menus, messages, or warnings on the screen.Use User Button to set On-Screen Display to User Button 1, User Button 2, or User Button 3.➤ Settings - Uscr Button p.143When you press the button for which On-Screen Display is assigned, menus or messages are not displayed on the screen. When the same button is pressed, they are displayed again. If On-Screen Display is enabled, you cannot operate the Configuration menu (except to switch the color mode and input source).
To disable the display of the message on the projection screen when switching the source.Set Messages to Off. (Default value: On)➤ Extended - Display - Messages p.146You can confirm warning by the display of the indicator.➤ "Reading the Indicators" p.175Dialogs related to operations and behaviors, laser warnings, termination of Message Broadcasting for Epson Projector Management, and projector ID are displayed.
Purpose Setting Methods
To register and save the settings of the projected image.Set Memory."Memory Function" p.110You can save the following settings.Memory: Some settings in the Configuration menuLens Position: Adjustment values of the lens shift, zoom, focus, and distortionGeometry Correction: Adjustment value of the geometry correction
To change the screen displayed on the background.Change from Display. You can select from blue, black, and logo. If no logo is registered, the EPSON logo is displayed.Display Background: Set the screen display with no image signal input. (Default value: Blue)Extended - Display - DisplayBackground p.146Startup Screen: Set whether or not (On/Off) to display the user logo when the projector is turned on. (Default value: On)Extended - Display - Startup Screen p.146

The port name, location, and connector orientation differ depending on the source being connected.

Connecting a Computer

To project images from a computer, connect the computer using one of the following methods.

When using a commercially available computer cable

Connect the computer's display output port to the projector's Computer port.

You can output audio from the Audio Out port on the projector by connecting the audio output port on the computer to the projector's Audio1 port using a commercially available audio cable.

② When using a commercially available 5BNC cable

Connect the computer's display output port to the projector's BNC port.

You can output audio from the Audio Out port on the projector by connecting the audio output port on the computer to the projector's Audio2 port using a commercially available audio cable.

③ When using a commercially available HDMI cable

Connect the HDMI port on the computer to the projector's HDMI port.

You can send the computer's audio with the projected image.

4 When using a commercially available DVI-D cable

Connect the DVI-D port on the computer to the projector's DVI-D port.

You can output audio from the Audio Out port on the projector by connecting the audio output port on the computer to the projector's Audio3 port using a commercially available audio cable.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a Computer - 1

text_image LAN HDMI-3 (HDC 2.2) DVI-3 HDMI (HDCPU.2) BNC R/CuPR G/Y BCuPo HC Sync V Sync Service HDMI HDBT Remote Computer Monitor Out Audio1 Audio2 RS-232C Audio3 Audio Out


EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a Computer - 2

text_image Computer Audio 1


EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a Computer - 3

flowchart
graph LR
    A["BNC"] --> B["Switch"]
    C["Audio2"] --> D["Switch"]
    B --> E["External Connector"]
    D --> E
    E --> F["Laptop with Wave Graph"]

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a Computer - 4

flowchart
graph LR
    A["HDMI"] <--> B["HD/UX"]
    B --> C["HDMI OUT"]
    D["DVI-D"] <--> E["HD/UX"]
    E --> F["DVI-D OUT"]
    G["Audio3"] <--> H["HD/UX"]
    H --> I["DVI-D OUT"]

4

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a Computer - 5

  • Change the audio output from Audio Settings.
    Extended - A/V Settings - Audio Settings p.146
  • If audio is not sent using an HDMI cable, connect a commercially available audio cable to the Audio3 port to send the audio. Set HDMI Audio Output to Audio3.
    Extended - A/V Settings - Audio Settings - HDMI Audio Output p.146

Connecting Image Sources

To project video images, connect to the projector using one of the following methods.

When using a commercially available component video cable (D-sub/component converter)

Connect the component output port on the image source to the projector's Computer port.

You can output audio from the Audio Out port on the projector by connecting the audio output port on the video equipment to the projector's Audio1 port using a commercially available audio cable.

② When using a commercially available component video cable (RCA) and a BNC/RCA adapter

Connect the component output port on the video equipment to the projector's BNC port (R/Cr/Pr, G/Y, B/Cb/Pb).

You can output audio from the Audio Out port on the projector by connecting the audio output port on the video equipment to the projector's Audio2 port using a commercially available audio cable.

③ When using a commercially available HDMI cable

Connect the HDMI port on the image source to the projector's HDMI port.

You can send the image source's audio with the projected image.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting Image Sources - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["1: LAN"] --> B["2: HDMI"]
    B --> C["3: HDMI"]
    subgraph Top
        D["1: LAN"] --> E["2: Computer"]
        E --> F["3: Monitor Out"]
        F --> G["4: Audio1"]
        G --> H["5: Audio2"]
        H --> I["6: Audio3"]
        I --> J["7: Audio4"]
        J --> K["8: Audio5"]
        K --> L["9: Audio6"]
        L --> M["10: Audio7"]
        M --> N["11: Audio8"]
        N --> O["12: Audio9"]
        O --> P["13: Audio10"]
        P --> Q["14: Audio11"]
        Q --> R["15: Audio12"]
        R --> S["16: Audio13"]
        S --> T["17: Audio14"]
        T --> U["18: Audio15"]
        U --> V["19: Audio16"]
        V --> W["20: Audio17"]
        W --> X["21: Audio18"]
        X --> Y["22: Audio19"]
        Y --> Z["23: Audio20"]
        Z --> AA["24: Audio21"]
        AA --> AB["25: Audio22"]
        AB --> AC["26: Audio23"]
        AC --> AD["27: Audio24"]
        AD --> AE["28: Audio25"]
        AE --> AF["29: Audio26"]
        AF --> AG["30: Audio27"]
        AG --> AH["31: Audio28"]
        AH --> AI["32: Audio29"]
        AI --> AJ["33: Audio30"]
        AJ --> AK["34: Audio31"]
        AK --> AL["35: Audio32"]
        AL --> AM["36: Audio33"]
        AM --> AN["37: Audio34"]
        AN --> AO["38: Audio35"]
        AO --> AP["39: Audio36"]
        AP --> AQ["40: Audio37"]
        AQ --> AR["41: Audio38"]
        AR --> AS["42: Audio39"]
        AS --> AT["43: Audio40"]
        AT --> AU["44: Audio41"]
        AU --> AV["45: Audio42"]
        AV --> AW["46: Audio43"]
        AW --> AX["47: Audio44"]
        AX --> AY["48: Audio45"]
        AY --> AZ["49: Audio46"]
        AZ --> BA["50: Audio47"]
        BA --> BB["51: Audio48"]
        BB --> BC["52: Audio49"]
        BC --> BD["53: Audio50"]
        BD --> BE["54: Audio51"]
        BE --> BF["55: Audio52"]
        BF --> BG["56: Audio53"]
        BG --> BH["57: Audio54"]
        BH --> BI["58: Audio55"]
        BI --> BJ["59: Audio56"]
        BJ --> BK["60: Audio57"]
        BK --> BL["61: Audio58"]
        BL --> BM["62: Audio59"]
        BM --> BN["63: Audio60"]
        BN --> BO["64: Audio61"]
        BO --> BP["65: Audio62"]
        BP --> BQ["66: Audio63"]
        BQ --> BR["67: Audio64"]
        BR --> BS["68: Audio65"]
        BS --> BT["69: Audio66"]
        BT --> BU["70: Audio67"]
        BU --> BV["71: Audio68"]
        BV --> BW["72: Audio69"]
        BW --> BX["73: Audio70"]
        BX --> BY["74: Audio71"]
        BY --> BZ["HDMI OUT"]

Attention

  • If the input source is on when you connect it to the projector, it could cause a malfunction.
  • If the orientation or shape of the plug differs, do not try to force it in. The device could be damaged or could malfunction.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

- Change the audio output from Audio Settings.

Extended - A/V Settings - Audio Settings p.146
- If audio is not sent using an HDMI cable, connect a commercially available audio cable to the Audio3 port to send the audio. Set HDMI Audio Output to Audio3.
Extended - A/V Settings - Audio Settings - HDMI Audio Output p.146
- If the source you want to connect to has an unusually shaped port, use the cable supplied with the device or an optional cable to connect to the projector.

Connecting External Equipment

You can output images and audio by connecting an external monitor or speaker.

When outputting images to an external monitor
Connect the external monitor to the projector's Monitor Out port using the cable supplied with the external monitor.

② When outputting audio to an external speaker

Connect the external speaker to the projector's Audio Out port using a commercially available audio cable.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting External Equipment - 1

text_image LAN HDBusT HDCP2.2 DX-0 HDMI HXP2.2 Service HDMI HDBT® Connected 3NC 800/91 G/Y B/C/B/Pb H/C Sync V Sync Remote Computer Monitor Out Audio2 RS-232C Audio1 AudioOUT ① Monitor Out D-Sub ② Audio Out Audio IN

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting External Equipment - 2

  • Set A/V Output to Always On to output image even when the projector is in standby mode.
    Extended - A/V Settings - A/V Output p.146
  • Only analog RGB signals from the Computer port or BNC port can be output to an external monitor. You can set which signals to output in Monitor Out.
    Extended - A/V Settings - Monitor Out p.146

Connecting a LAN Cable

Connect a LAN port on network hubs or other equipment to the projector's LAN port with a commercially available 100BASE-TX or 10BASE-T LAN cable.

By connecting a computer to the projector over a network, you can project images and check the status of the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a LAN Cable - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    subgraph LAN
        A["LAN"] --> B["HDBT HDCF2.2"]
        B --> C["DM-D"]
        C --> D["HDMI HDCF2.2"]
        D --> E["Service"]
        E --> F["HDBT"]
        F --> G["Remote"]
        G --> H["Monitor Out"]
        H --> I["Audio1"]
        H --> J["Audio2"]
        H --> K["Audio3"]
        H --> L["Audio4"]
    end
    subgraph Ethernet
        M["LAN"] <--> N["Internet"]
    end

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting a LAN Cable - 2

To prevent malfunctions, use a category 5 or higher shielded LAN cable.

Connecting an HDBaseT Transmitter

Connect the optional HDBaseT Transmitter with a commercially available 100BASE-TX LAN cable.

"Optional Accessories" p.233

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting an HDBaseT Transmitter - 1

text_image LAN HD/Base (HDCP2.2) DV-0 HDMI (HDCP2.2) Service HDMI HDBT BNC RVPhi GIV B/CPhi HIC Sync V Sync Computer Monitor Out Audio2 Audio1 Audio1 RS-732K Remote Audio1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting an HDBaseT Transmitter - 2

text_image HDBaseT

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting an HDBaseT Transmitter - 3

  • Make sure you read the User's Guide supplied with the HIDBaseT Transmitter carefully before use.
  • For the LAN cable, use an HDBaseT' Alliance-recommended STP cable (straight) of category 5c or higher. However, operation is not guaranteed for all input/output devices and environments.
  • When connecting or disconnecting the LAN cable, make sure you turn off the power for the projector and the HIDBaseT Transmitter.
  • When performing Ethernet communication or serial communication, or when using the wired remote control via HDBaseT port, set Control Communications to On from the Configuration menu.

Extended - HDBaseT - Control Communications p.146

Note that when Control Communications is set to On, the projector's LAN port, RS-232C port, and Remote port are disabled.

  • When using the Extron XTP transmitter or switcher, connect to the projector's HDBaseT port. Set Extron XTP to On (Standby Mode and Control Communications are automatically set to On).
    Extended - HDBaseT - Extron XTP p.146
  • You can check the status of the signal being input to the HDBaseT port in HDBaseT Signal Level.
    Info - Projector Info - HDBaseT Signal Level p.161

Installing the Wireless LAN Unit

1 Loosen the fixing screws and open the air filter cover. (You can loosen the screws with your fingers.)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Wireless LAN Unit - 1

text_image Diagram showing airflow or ventilation process on a laptop with labeled components and directional arrows

2 Use a plus-head screwdriver to loosen and remove the screw from the stopper for the Wireless LAN unit.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Wireless LAN Unit - 2

text_image Diagram illustrating a mechanical assembly with labeled parts, showing a component being inserted into a housing and then placed on a platform.

3 Install the Wireless LAN unit.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Wireless LAN Unit - 3

natural_image Diagram of a refrigerator interior with a blue plastic component inserted, showing no text or symbols

4 Secure the stopper with a screw.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Wireless LAN Unit - 4

natural_image Diagram showing a computer monitor with an open screen and a magnified view of the screen (no text or symbols present)

5 Close the air filter cover and tighten the fixing screws.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Installing the Wireless LAN Unit - 5

text_image Diagram showing airflow or ventilation process on a device with numbered annotations indicating steps ① and ②.

Attaching the Cable Cover

By attaching the cable cover, you can hide the connected cables giving a nice, clean finish to the projector installation. (The illustrations are of a projector installed on a ceiling.)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attaching the Cable Cover - 1

Warning

Do not tie the power cord and other connection cables together. Otherwise, it could cause a fire.

Attaching

1 Run a commercially available cable tie through the cable hold and tie the cables together.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attaching - 1

natural_image Line drawing of an electronic device rear panel with visible ports and wiring (no text or symbols)

2 Attach the cable cover to the projector by routing the cables through the grooves in the cable cover.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attaching - 2

natural_image Diagram of a device interior with internal components and directional arrows indicating movement or flow (no text or symbols present)

Connecting Equipment

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting Equipment - 1

3 Tighten the two screws on the cable cover. (You can tighten the screws with your fingers.)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting Equipment - 2

natural_image Diagram showing a mechanical assembly with a blue component and a magnified view of the component (no text or symbols present)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Connecting Equipment - 3

Basic Usage

This chapter explains how to project and adjust images.

Turning On the Projector

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Turning On the Projector - 1

58

Before turning on the projector, connect your computer or video equipment to the projector.

"Connecting Equipment" p.47

1 Connect the projector to an electrical outlet with the power cord.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Turning On the Projector - 2

natural_image Diagram showing a cable being inserted into a device with a blue connector (no text or symbols present)

The projector's power indicator turns blue (it is in standby mode). This indicates that the projector is receiving power, but is not yet turned on.

2 Press the Ⓐ button on the control panel or remote control to turn on the projector.

The confirmation buzzer beeps and the status indicator flashes blue as the projector warms up. Once the projector is warmed up, the status indicator stops flashing and turns blue.

If the image is not projected, try the following.

- Turn on the connected computer or video equipment.

- When using a laptop computer, change the screen output of the computer.

- Insert media such as a DVD and play it back.

- Press the [Search] button on the control panel or the remote control to detect the input source.

- Press the button for the input source that you want to project by using the remote control.

- If the Home screen is displayed, select the input source that you want to project.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Turning On the Projector - 3

Warning

  • Do not look into the projector's lens during projection. Doing so may damage your eyes. Be especially careful if children are present.
  • During projection, do not block the light from the projector with a book and so on. If the light from the projector is blocked, the area on which the light shines becomes hot which could cause it to melt, burn, or start a fire. Also, the lens may get hot due to the reflected light which could cause the projector to malfunction. To stop projection, use the A/V Mute function or turn off the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Warning - 1

- If Direct Power On is set to On in the Extended menu, the projector automatically turns on when the power cord is connected to it. When the power cord is plugged in, note that the projector turns on automatically in cases such as recovery from a power outage.

Extended - Operation - Direct Power On p.146
- If an image signal from the source selected in Auto Power On is input, the projector automatically turns on.
Extended - Operation - Auto Power On p.146

Home Screen

You can use the Home screen to easily select input sources or frequently used functions. The Home screen is displayed in the following situations.

- When the [↑] button on the remote control is pressed

- When the projector is turned on while Home Screen Auto Disp. is set to On

Extended - Home Screen - Home Screen Auto Disp. p.146

- When there is no signal from the selected input source when the projector is turned on

When the Home screen is displayed, use the | ▲ || | | | buttons on the control panel or remote control to select an item, and then press the [◀] button.

To hide the Home screen, press the [ ] button on the remote control again.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Home Screen - 1

text_image EPSON Source : searching at source... HDMI HDBase1 DVI-6 Computer BNC USB LAN Userful Hierarchy Color Mode Light Source Mode Image Enhancement Frame Interpolation Menu Help Content Playback : On Projector Name: XXXXXXXX Keyword: XXXXX SSB: XXXXXXXX-XXXXXXXXXXXXX TF IP: XXXXXXXX ↓TF: XXXXXXXXX.XXX Connection Guide Switch the source. [Note]: Exit

1 Select the input source that you want to project.

2Displays the Connection Guide. You can check which wireless connection method to use for your device.
3Indicates that the projector is in Content Playback mode.
4Displays the Help screen.● "Using the Help" p.173
5Displays the Configuration menu.
6Executes the function assigned to Custom Function 1 or Custom Function 2 in the Extended menu.● Extended - Home Screen - Custom Function 1, Custom Function 2 p.146
7Select Light Source Mode.● "Setting the Brightness" p.77
8Select Color Mode.● "Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode)" p.76

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Home Screen - 2

The Home screen disappears after 10 minutes of inactivity.

Turning Off the Projector

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Turning Off the Projector - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Turning Off the Projector - 2

  • To ensure a long projector service life, turn off the projector when you are not using it. The light source's operating life varies depending on the Configuration menu settings, environmental conditions, and usage conditions. The brightness of the projected image drops as projection time elapses.
  • The projector can be powered off directly by the breaker because it supports the direct shutdown function.
  • When the projector is used continuously for more than 24 hours, or when direct shutdown is used regularly, set Light Source Calibration using the scheduling function to adjust the light source periodically. You can also make settings from the Configuration menu.

"Scheduling Function" p.112
Reset - Light Source Calibration p.162

1 Press the [①] button on the control panel or the remote control. The shutdown confirmation screen is displayed.

Power Off?

Yes: Press ⏻ button No : Press any other button

2 Press the [☐] button again. (To cancel, press any other button.) After the buzzer beeps twice, the projected image disappears, and the status indicator turns off.
3 Disconnect the power cord.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Turning Off the Projector - 3

natural_image Diagram showing a device connected to a cable with blue connectors, no text or symbols present

Press the [Search] button to project images from the port currently receiving an image.

Using the remote control Using the control panel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search) - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search) - 2

When two or more image sources are connected, repeatedly press the [Search] button until the target image is projected.

When your video equipment is connected, start playback before beginning this operation.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search) - 3

  • You can set up the projector so that it automatically detects an image signal from another input source and projects the image when there is no image signal from the current input source.
    Extended - Operation - Auto Source Search p.146
    •The following screen is displayed while no image signals are input.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search) - 4

text_image [Source Search] HDMI Signal Status Off HDBaseT Off DVI-D Off Computer Off BNC Off LAN Off Input an image signal. Press to select the source.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search) - 5

Switching to the Target Image by Remote Control

- Press the button of the input source that you want to project. The input ports for the buttons are shown below.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Switching to the Target Image by Remote Control - 1

text_image Remote control On Standby 0 Search HDMI HDBaseT DVI-D Computer BNC LAN SDI Input Port LAN HDBaseT HDCPZ.20 DV-D DVI-D HDMI HDCPZ.20 Service RxCnPf G/V B/Cb/Pb HCI Sync V/Sync Computer Monitor Out Audio2 RS-232C Audio1 Audio1 Audio2 Remote HDMI HDBT™

Changes to images from a computer connected via the network.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Switching to the Target Image by Remote Control - 2

When using Content Playback mode, you can switch to the USB source by pressing the User Button assigned to USB.

- Press the [▲ button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Switching to the Target Image by Remote Control - 3

text_image Remote control 4 5 6 7 8 9 ID 0 Num On Off Home

Select the input source to be projected, and then press the ↕] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Switching to the Target Image by Remote Control - 4

text_image EPSON Sources : Searching all sources... HDN1 HIDaserT DVIL-0 Character BNC USB LAN Useful Functions: Color Mode Light Source Mode Image Enhancement Frame Interpretation Menu Help Content Playback : Or Projector Name: XXXXXXXX Keyword: XXXXX 3510 : XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXX IP : XXXXXXXX IP : XXXXXXXX.XXX Network Guide Switch the source. [Down] Exit

Adjusting the Volume

You can adjust the volume of the audio from the Audio Out port using one of the following methods.

- Press the [Volume] buttons on the remote control to adjust the volume.

[<0] increases the volume.
[◇] decreases the volume.

Remote control
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Volume - 1

- Adjust the volume from the Configuration menu.

Settings - Volume p.143

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Volume - 2

Caution

Do not start at high volume.

A sudden excessive volume may cause loss of hearing. Always lower the volume before powering off, so that you can power on and then gradually increase the volume.

Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image

You can correct keystone distortion in projected images using one of the following methods.

•H/V-Keystone

This allows you to correct distortion in the horizontal and vertical directions independently.

"H/V-Keystone" p.65

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image - 1

Correct the four corners independently.

"Quick Corner" p.66

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Computer monitor with left-pointing arrow"] --> B["Computer monitor with right-pointing arrow"]

•Curved Surface

Correct distortion that occurs when projecting on a curved surface, and adjust the amount of expansion and contraction.

"Curved Surface" p.67

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image - 3

natural_image Diagram showing a blue rectangular block on the left of a gray cylinder, transitioning to a larger blue rectangle on the right (no text or symbols)

•Corner Wall

This allows you to correct distortion that occurs when projecting on a surface with right angles, such as a square pillar or the corner of a room, and adjust the amount of expansion and contraction.

"Corner Wall" p.71

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image - 4

natural_image Two-step diagram showing a 3D geometric shape transforming into a 2D rectangular prism, with no text or symbols present.

- Point Correction

Corrects slight distortion which occurs partially, or adjusts the image position in an overlapping area when projecting from multiple projectors.

"Point Correction" p.74

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image - 5

natural_image Diagram showing a 3D coordinate system with arrows and grid lines, before and after transformation (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image - 6

  • By pressing the [Geometry] button on the remote control or the [☐] button on the control panel, a screen for selecting the adjustment method is displayed.
  • When you want to re-adjust the projection position and so on, if you want to release the correction status temporarily, set the Geometry Correction to Off. Even when it is set to Off, the correction values are saved.
    Settings - Geometry Correction p.143
  • You can save the geometry correction settings using Memory in Geometry Correction, and load them when needed.
    "Memory Function" p.110

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image - 7

text_image [H/V-Keystone] V-Keystone 0 V-Balance 0 H-Keystone 0 H-Balance 0 Return

Esc:Return :Select :Adjust Menu:Exit [Default]:Reset

H/V-Keystone

This allows you to correct distortion in the horizontal and vertical directions independently.

Use the following to check the adjustment range for the image.

"H/V-Keystone" p.261

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Geometry Correction from Settings.
3 Select H/V-Keystone, and then press the [◀] button. "If this setting is changed, the image may be distorted." is displayed, press the [◀] button.
4 Use the [▲][▼] buttons to select the correction method, and then use the ▶[]▶ buttons to make the corrections.

Correct the keystone distortion by using V-Keystone and H-Keystone.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - H/V-Keystone - 1

flowchart
graph LR
    A["Rectangular Shape"] --> B["Rectangular Frame"]
    B --> C["Rectangular Frame"]
    D["V-Keystone"] --> E["Rectangular Frame"]
    F["H-Keystone"] --> G["Rectangular Frame"]
    G --> H["Rectangular Frame"]

If the image aspect is incorrect, adjust the image balance by using V-Balance and H-Balance.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - H/V-Keystone - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Square Block 1"] <--> B["Square Block 2"]
    C["Square Block 3"] <--> D["Square Block 4"]
    style A fill:#fff,stroke:#000
    style B fill:#fff,stroke:#000
    style C fill:#fff,stroke:#000
    style D fill:#fff,stroke:#000

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - H/V-Keystone - 3

When you correct keystone distortion, the projected image may be reduced.

5 To complete the corrections, press the Menu button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - H/V-Keystone - 4

You cannot combine with other correction methods.

Quick Corner

This allows you to correct each of the four corners of the projected image independently.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

2 Select Geometry Correction from Settings.

3 Select Quick Corner, and then press the [◀] button. "If this setting is changed, the image may be distorted." is displayed, press the [◀] button again.

4 Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to select the corner you want to adjust, and then press the J button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Quick Corner - 1

text_image [Quick Corner] Select the area.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Quick Corner - 2

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Quick Corner - 3

If the Esc button is pressed for approximately two seconds, the confirm default reset screen is displayed.

Select Yes to reset the result of Quick Corner corrections.

5 Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to correct the position of the corner.

When you press the 📄 button, the screen shown in step 4 that allows you to select the area to be corrected is displayed.

If the message "Cannot adjust any further." is displayed while adjusting, you cannot adjust the shape any further in the direction indicated by the gray triangle.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Quick Corner - 4

text_image [Quick Corner] Cannot adjust any further.

Esc /:Return

6 Repeat steps 4 and 5 as needed to adjust any remaining corners.

7 To complete the corrections, press the Menu button.

Curved Surface

This allows you to correct distortion that occurs when projecting on curved surface, and adjust the amount of expansion and contraction.

Face the projector directly opposing the screen with the lens position moved to the home position.

"Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Curved Surface - 1

- Project onto an arc surface with the same radius.

- If a large amount of adjustment is performed, the focus may not be uniform even after making adjustments.

- If 4K Enhancement is enabled, a message is displayed. Select Yes to disable 4K Enhancement. (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only)

Image - Image Enhancement - 4K Enhancement p.140

Use the following to check the adjustment range for the image.

"Curved Surface" p.261

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

2 Select Geometry Correction from Settings.

3 Select Curved Surface, and then press the [←] button.

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

text_image [Geometric Correction] Return Off H/V-Keystone Quick Corner Curved Surface Corner Wall Point Correction Memory [Esc]:Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

"If this setting is changed, the image may be distorted." is displayed, press the |◀| button.

4 Select Curved Surface, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select Curved Surface, and then press the [←] button. - 1

text_image [Curved Surface] Return Quick Corner Curved Surface Point Correction Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

5 Select Correct Shape, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select Correct Shape, and then press the [←] button. - 1

text_image [Curved Surface] Return Correct Shape Horizontal Linearity Vertical Linearity Maintain Aspect Ratio Off [Esc]:Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

69

6 Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to select the area you want to adjust, and then press the ▶I button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

text_image [Correct Shape] Select the area.

When selecting a corner, you can adjust the two sides next to the corner.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

If the Esc button is pressed for approximately two seconds, the confirm default reset screen is displayed.

Select Yes to reset the result of Curved Surface.

7 Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to adjust the shape.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 4

natural_image Simple diagram showing a dashed arc and a rectangular box with an arrow pointing to it (no text or symbols)

If the triangle in the direction you are adjusting the shape turns gray as shown in the screenshot below, you cannot adjust the shape any further in that direction.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 5

natural_image Simple diagram with a black rectangle and an orange arrow pointing to a white rectangular area (no text or symbols)

8 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

9 Repeat steps from 6 to 8 as needed to adjust any remaining parts.

If the image expands or contracts, go to the next step and adjust the linearity.

10 Press the Esc button to display the screen from step 5. Select Horizontal Linearity or Vertical Linearity, and then press the [◀] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 6

text_image [Curved Surface] Return Correct Shape Horizontal Linearity Vertical Linearity Maintain Aspect Ratio Off [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

Select Horizontal Linearity to adjust the horizontal expansion or contraction, and select Vertical Linearity to adjust the vertical expansion or contraction.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 7

To compensate for expansion or contraction while maintaining the aspect ratio, set Maintain Aspect Ratio to On. You may not be able to perform corrections if you set this to On after correction. In this situation, return the corrections to their initial values, or reduce the amount of correction, and then try again.

11 Select the standard line for the adjustments, and then press the [←] button.

Press the [◀][▶] buttons when selecting Horizontal Linearity, and the [▲][▼] buttons when selecting Vertical Linearity, and then press [◀].

The selected standard line is displayed in flashing orange and white.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 8

Changing the standard line resets the previous settings.

12 Adjust the linearity.

Correct it so that the distance between lines is equal.

When pressing the ▶] button

When Horizontal Linearity is selected When Vertical Linearity is selected

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 9

natural_image Pure diagram of two white arrows pointing inward toward a vertical orange line on a light blue background (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 10

natural_image Simple diagram with two white triangles above a horizontal orange line, no text or symbols present

When pressing the ▶] button

When Horizontal Linearity is selected When Vertical Linearity is selected

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 11

natural_image Pure geometric diagram with vertical stripes and a central orange line, no text or symbols present

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 12

natural_image Abstract diagram with horizontal lines and two opposing triangles, no text or symbols present

13 To complete the corrections, press the Menu button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 13

You can fine tune the corrected results. Use Quick Corner to adjust the tilt of the image, and then use Point Correction for fine tuning. Select Quick Corner or Point Correction on the screen from step 4.

"Quick Corner" p.66
"Point Correction" p.74

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

Corner Wall

This allows you to correct distortion that occurs when projecting on a surface with right angles, such as a square pillar or the corner of a room, and adjust the amount of expansion and contraction.

Face the projector directly opposing the screen with the lens position moved to the home position.

"Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Corner Wall - 1

- Project onto a surface with a right angle.

- If a large amount of adjustment is performed, the focus may not be uniform even after making adjustments.

- If 4K Enhancement is enabled, a message is displayed. Select Yes to disable 4K Enhancement. (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only)

Image - Image Enhancement - 4K Enhancement p.140

- This is not available for ELPLX01/ELPLX01W.

Use the following to check the adjustment range for the image.

"Corner Wall" p.268

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

2 Select Geometry Correction from Settings.

3 Select Corner Wall, and then press the [◀] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Corner Wall - 2

text_image [Geometric Correction] Return Off H/V-Keystone Quick Corner Curved Surface Corner Wall Point Correction Memory

Esc:Return :Select [●]:Enter Menu:Exit

"If this setting is changed, the image may be distorted." is displayed, press the [◀] button again.

4 Select Corner Wall, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Corner Wall - 3

text_image [Corner Wall] Return Quick Corner Corner Wall Point Correction Reset

Esc:Return :Select [●]:Enter Menu:Exit

5 Select Corner Type, and then press the [◀] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Corner Wall - 4

text_image [Corner Wall] Return Corner Type ●Horizontal Corner Correct Shape Linearity

Esc:Return :Select [●]:Enter Menu:Exit

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

6 According to the projection area, select Horizontal Corner or Vertical Corner, and then press the button.

When the surfaces line up horizontally:

Select Horizontal Corner.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

natural_image Abstract geometric shape with a vertical dashed line dividing it into two blue rectangles (no text or symbols)

When the surfaces line up vertically:

Select Vertical Corner.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

natural_image Simple geometric shape with a blue hexagon and dashed line, no text or symbols present

From here on, steps are explained using Horizontal Corner as an example.

7 Press the Esc button to display the screen from step 5. Select Correct Shape, and then press the button.

8 Adjust the position of the projector and the lens shift so that the line in the center of the screen matches the corner (the point where the two surfaces meet).

"Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 4

natural_image Two blue 3D geometric shapes with dashed internal lines, one rotated to form a larger shape (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 5

Each time you press the [button, you can show or hide the image and the grid.

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

9 Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to select the area you want to adjust, and then press the J button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

text_image [Correct Shape] Select the area.

Adjustment tips

When Horizontal Corner is selected:

Adjust the upper area based on the lowest point (indicated by the arrow).

Adjust the lower area based on the highest point (indicated by the arrow).

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

text_image A B

When Vertical Corner is selected:

Adjust the left and right based on the point nearest to the vertical line in the center of the screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 4

If the Esc button is pressed for approximately two seconds, the confirm default reset screen is displayed. Select Yes to reset the result of Corner Wall.

10 Press the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons to adjust the shape.

If the message "Cannot adjust any further." is displayed while adjusting, you cannot adjust the shape any further in the direction indicated by the gray triangle.

11 Repeat steps 9 and 10 as needed to adjust any remaining parts. If the image expands or contracts, go to the next step and adjust the linearity.

12 Press the Esc button to display the screen from step 4. Select Linearity, and then press the I button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 5

text_image [Corner Wall] Return Corner Type Horizontal Corner Correct Shape Linearity + [Esc]:Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

Press the [◀][▶] buttons to adjust the linearity.

Correct it so that the distance between lines is equal.

When pressing the [] button

When Horizontal Corner is selected

When Vertical Corner is selected

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

natural_image Simple diagram with a white triangular shape on a light blue vertical grid background (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 4

natural_image Simple diagram with horizontal lines and a small triangle at the top center (no text or symbols)

When pressing the ▶] button

When Horizontal Corner is selected

When Vertical Corner is selected

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 5

natural_image Simple diagram with vertical blue bars and a white triangular play button on the right side (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 6

natural_image Simple diagram with horizontal lines and a downward-pointing triangle at the bottom (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 7

To complete the corrections, press the Menu button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 8

You can fine tune the corrected results. Use Quick Corner to adjust the tilt of the image, and then use Point Correction for fine tuning. Select Quick Corner or Point Correction on the screen from step 4.

"Quick Corner" p.66
"Point Correction" p.74

Point Correction

Divides the projected image by the grid and corrects the distortion by moving the point of intersection from side to side and up and down.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Point Correction - 1

- You can make corrections in 0.5 pixel increments in all directions within the following ranges.

EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U: Vertical and horizontal up to a maximum of 32 pixels.

EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W/EB-L1070: Vertical and horizontal up to a maximum of 20 pixels.

- If 4K Enhancement is enabled, a message is displayed. Select Yes to disable 4K Enhancement. (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only)

Image - Image Enhancement - 4K Enhancement p.140

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Point Correction - 2

Press the Menu button while projecting.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Point Correction - 3

Select Geometry Correction from Settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Point Correction - 4

Select Point Correction, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Point Correction - 5

text_image [Geometric Correction] Return Off H/V-Keystone Quick Corner Curved Surface Corner Wall Point Correction Memory

Esc:Return :Select [●]:Enter Menu:Exit

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

"If this setting is changed, the image may be distorted." is displayed, press the [◀] button again.

4 Select Point Correction, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

text_image [Point Correction] Return Quick Corner Point Correction Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

5 Select Point Correction, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

text_image [Point Correction] Return Point Correction 3x3 Pattern Color White Reset [Esc]:Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit
Point CorrectionSelect the point number (3x3, 5x5, 9x9, 17x17), and then make the Point Correction setting.
Pattern ColorSelect the color of the grid when performing corrections.
ResetResets all corrections for Point Correction to their default values.

6 Select the point number (3x3, 5x5, 9x9, or 17x17), and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 4

If you reduce the number of points during correction, corrections at the position without a point are reset.

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

g

Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to move to the point you want to correct, and then press the ◀[ ] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

natural_image Illustration of a beach scene with clouds, birds, and a small boat on the water (no text or symbols)

h

Use the |▲|, |▼|, |◀|, and |▶| buttons to correct distortion.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

natural_image Diagram showing a mechanical or structural change before and after, with no visible text or symbols.

To continue to correct another point, press the Esc button to return to the previous screen, then repeat the steps 7 and 8.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 4

Each time you press the 📁 button, you can show or hide the image and the grid.

i

To complete the corrections, press the Menu button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 5

You can fine tune the corrected results. Select Quick Corner on the screen from step 4 to adjust the tilt of the image.

"Quick Corner" p.66

Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode)

You can easily obtain the optimum image quality simply by selecting the setting that best corresponds to your surroundings when projecting. The brightness of the image varies depending on the mode selected.

Mode Application
DynamicThis is the brightest mode. Ideal for use in a bright room.
PresentationThe images are vivid and brought to life. Ideal for making presentations or watching a TV program in a bright room.
NaturalReproduces colors faithfully. Ideal for projecting still pictures such as photos.
CinemaGives images a natural tone. Ideal for watching films in a dark room.
BT.709Produces images that conform to the ITU-R BT.709.
DICOM SIMThis produces images with clear shadows. Ideal for projecting X-ray photographs and other medical images. The projector is not a medical device and cannot be used for medical diagnosis.
Multi-ProjectionMinimize the color tone difference between each projected image. Ideal for projecting from multiple projectors.

Each time you press the |Color Mode| button, the Color Mode name is displayed on the screen and the Color Mode changes.

Remote control
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode) - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode) - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Presentation"] --> B["Line Chart"]
    B --> C["Output"]

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode) - 3

You can set Color Mode from the Configuration menu.

Image - Color Mode p.140

Setting the Brightness

Set the brightness for the light source.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Brightness Settings from Settings.
3 Select Light Source Mode, and then press the [←] button.
4 Select the item you want to set, and then press the + button.

Normal: Select this if you do not want to decrease the brightness. This makes the light source operation time approximately 20,000 hours.

Medium: Noise from the fan is louder than when Quiet is selected, but it does not decrease the brightness as much. This sets the

brightness at 85%. This makes the light source operation time approximately 20,000 hours.

Quiet: Select this if you are concerned about the noise made by the fan. This sets the brightness at 70%. This makes the light source operation time approximately 20,000 hours.

Extended: Select this to extend the life expectancy of the light source. This sets the brightness at 70%. This makes the light source operation time approximately 30,000 hours.

Custom: Select this to set the Brightness Level manually. When Custom is selected, Constant Brightness is available.

5 When Light Source Mode is set to Custom, select Brightness Level, and then use the ◀||▶ buttons to set the brightness.
6 To maintain a fixed brightness, select Constant Brightness, and set it to On.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the Brightness - 1

  • When Constant Brightness is set to On, you cannot change the settings for Light Source Mode and Brightness Level. When you want to change these settings, set Constant Brightness to Off.
  • When Constant Brightness is set to Off, the value for Brightness Level changes depending on the current status of the light source.
  • There may be a margin of error in the Brightness Level.
  • When the projector is used continuously for more than 24 hours, or when direct shutdown is used regularly, set Light Source Calibration using the scheduling function. If this is not set, the Constant Brightness function does not work. You can also make settings from the Configuration menu.

"Scheduling Function" p.112
Reset - Light Source Calibration p.162

Guide to Estimated Remains

When Constant Brightness is set to On, the Estimated Remains is displayed. Estimated Remains indicates the amount of time for which constant brightness can be maintained.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Guide to Estimated Remains - 1

text_image [Brightness Settings] Return Light Source Mode Quiet Brightness Level 0 % Settings Constant Brightness On Estimated Remains 0 H or Less Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit
Display Level Estimated Remains
10,000 hours or more
8,000 to 9,999 hours
6,000 to 7,999 hours
4,000 to 5,999 hours
2,000 to 3,999 hours
0 to 1,999 hours

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Guide to Estimated Remains - 2

The time displayed on the screen is just a guide. 30,000 hours or more is displayed in units of 10,000; 2,000 to 29,999 hours is displayed in units of 1,000; and up to 1,999 hours is displayed in units of 100.

Relationship between Brightness Level and light source operation time

The following shows the relationship between Brightness Level and the light source operation time.

When Constant Brightness is set to Off

①: Brightness Level
②: Approximate light source operation time until its brightness is reduced by half

12
100% 20,000 hours
90% 21,000 hours
80% 24,000 hours
70% 30,000 hours
60% 37,000 hours
50% 47,000 hours
40% 61,000 hours
30% 71,000 hours

When Constant Brightness is set to On

①: Brightness Level
②: Approximate time for which constant brightness of the light source can be maintained

12Illustration
85% 6,000hoursEPSON EB-L1065UNL - When Constant Brightness is set to On - 1
80% 10,000hours
70% 19,000hours
60% 29,000hours
50% 41,000hours
40% 56,000hours
30% 78,000hours

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - When Constant Brightness is set to On - 2

  • This is an approximate guide only and may change depending on the projector's usage and surroundings.
    •The times above are the standard hours when using the projector continuously without changing the Brightness Level or Constant Brightness settings and are not guaranteed.
  • This is an approximate guide only and may change depending on the projector's usage and surroundings. You may need to replace internal parts sooner than the estimated light source operation time.
  • When Constant Brightness is set to On, and the approximate constant time has been exceeded, you may not be able to set a high value for Brightness Level.

Setting the Amount of Light of the Projected Image

By automatically setting the luminance according to the brightness of the displayed image, it lets you enjoy deep and rich images. You can also set the light source to turn off automatically.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Light Source Control from Image, and then press the [←] button.
3 Select Light Source Control, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the Amount of Light of the Projected Image - 1

text_image [Light Source Control] Return Signal Light Source Control Off Dynamic Contrast Lights-Out Control Settings Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [◆]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

4 Select the light source operation according to the image signal, and then press the [1] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting the Amount of Light of the Projected Image - 2

text_image [Light Source Control] Return Off Dynamic Contrast Lights-Out Control [Esc] / [◆]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit
  • Off: Select if you do not want to control the light source.
  • Dynamic Contrast: Automatically adjust the amount of light when projecting according to the brightness of the image.
  • Lights-Out Control: Automatically turns off the light after the set time has elapsed at the specified video level.

5 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.
6 If you selected Dynamic Contrast in step 4, make the following settings in Dynamic Contrast.

  • Response Speed: Select High Speed to adjust the amount of light as soon as the scene changes.
  • Black Level: Set the black level when the brightness level of the image signal is zero. When you select 0%, the light source turns off.

7 If you selected Lights-Out Control in step 4, make the following settings in Lights-Out Control.

  • Lights-Out Signal Level: Set the brightness level for the video signal being controlled. After turning off automatically when exceeding the specified image level, it turns on immediately.
  • Lights-Out Timer: Set the amount of time before automatically turning off the light source.

8 Press the Menu button to finish making settings.

Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image

You can change the aspect ratio of the projected image to suit the type, the ratio of height and width, and the resolution of the input signals.

Available aspect modes vary depending on the Screen Type currently set.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image - 1

  • Set the Screen Type before changing the aspect ratio.
    "Screen Settings" p.32
  • This cannot be changed when Scale Mode is set to Zoom
    Display.
    Signal - Scale - Scale Mode p.142

Changing methods

Each time you press the [Aspect] button on the remote control, the aspect mode name is displayed on the screen and the aspect ratio changes.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing methods - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing methods - 2

Aspect Mode Explanation
AutoProjects in an appropriate aspect ratio based on information from the signal being input.
NormalProjects while retaining the aspect ratio of the input image.
4:3Projects at an aspect ratio of 4:3.
16:9Projects at an aspect ratio of 16:9.

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

Aspect Mode Explanation
FullProjects at the full size of the projected screen.
H-ZoomProjects by enlarging the input image to the full width of the projected screen while retaining the aspect ratio. Areas that exceed the edges of the projected screen are not projected.
V-ZoomProjects by enlarging the input image to the full height of the projected screen while retaining the aspect ratio. Areas that exceed the edges of the projected screen are not projected.
NativeProjects to the center of the projected screen at the resolution of the input image. Areas that exceed the edges of the projected screen are not projected.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

- The available aspect ratios differ depending on the input signal from the connected device.

- You can also set the aspect ratio from the Configuration menu.

Signal - Aspect p.142

- If parts of the computer image are missing, set the Resolution setting to Wide or Normal from the Configuration menu, according to the resolution of the computer.

Signal - Resolution p.142

Adjusting the Image

Hue, Saturation, and Brightness adjustment

You can adjust the Hue (tint), Saturation (vividness), and Brightness of the six axes R (red), G (green), B (blue), C (cyan), M (magenta), and Y (yellow) according to your preferences.

2 Select Advanced from Image, and then press the [←] button.

3 Select RGBCMY, and then press the [←] button.

4 Use the [▲][▼] buttons to select the color you want to adjust, and then press the ▼ button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Hue, Saturation, and Brightness adjustment - 1

text_image [RGBCMY] Hue Saturation Return Brightness R 0 0 0 0 G 0 0 0 0 B 0 0 0 0 C 0 0 0 0 M 0 0 0 0 Y 0 0 0 0

Esc:Return :Select [○]:Enter Menu:Exit

5 Use the [▲][▼] buttons to select the item, and then use the [◀][▶] buttons to make the adjustments.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Hue, Saturation, and Brightness adjustment - 2

text_image [R] Hue 0 R Return Saturation 0 Brightness 0

Esc:Return :Select [◀]:Adjust Menu:Exit [Default]:Reset [●]:Display

Each time you press the [] button, the adjustment screen changes.

6 To complete the corrections, press the Menu button.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

82

Gamma adjustment

You can adjust differences in the halftone brightness that occurs depending on the connected device.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Gamma adjustment - 1

Adjust by projecting a still picture. Gamma cannot be adjusted correctly by using movies.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Advanced from Image, and then press the [←] button.
3 Select Gamma, and then press the [◀] button.
4 Use the [][] buttons to adjust the value.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Gamma adjustment - 2

text_image [Gamma] Return Gamma Custom Reset

Esc:Return [◀◆▶]:Select [○]:Set Menu:Exit

When a larger value is selected, the dark areas of images become brighter, but the color saturation for lighter areas may become weaker.

When a smaller value is selected, you can reduce the overall brightness of the image to make the image sharper.

If you select DICOM SIM from Color Mode on the Image menu, select the adjustment value according to the projection size.

- If the projection size is 120 inches or less, select a small value. - If the projection size is 120 inches or more, select a large value.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Gamma adjustment - 3

Medical images may not be reproduced correctly according to your installation environment and screen specifications.

5 To make detailed adjustments, select Custom, and then press the [◀] button.
6 Use the [◀][▶] buttons to select the tone that you want to change, and then use the ▶[▶] buttons to make the adjustments. When you have finished making changes, confirm by using the ▶ button.

If you use the ▶ || ▶ buttons to select the tone that you want to change, the image flashes and you can check the tone area of the adjustment target.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Gamma adjustment - 4

text_image [Gamma] Blinking area is the adjustment target.

7 When Do you want to continue adjusting the setting? is displayed, select Yes or No.

To adjust another tone, select Yes, and repeat the procedure from step 6.

Adjusting Image Resolution (Image Enhancement)

You can adjust the resolution of the image using Image Enhancement to reproduce a clear image with an emphatic texture and material feel.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

2 Select Image Enhancement from Image, and then press the [←] button.

The following screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting Image Resolution (Image Enhancement) - 1

text_image [Image Enhancement] Signal 4K Enhancement Off Image Preset Mode Preset 1 Settings Frame Interpolation Off Deinterlacing Off Noise Reduction 0 MPEG Noise Reduction Low Super-resolution Detail Enhancement Reset Network Info Reset [Esc] / [●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

4K Enhancement (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only)

4K Enhancement is a function that projects an image at a doubled resolution by diagonally shifting 1 pixel in increments of 0.5 pixels.

A high-resolution image signal is projected in fine detail.

1 Select 4K Enhancement from Image Enhancement, and then press the [√] button.
2 Select one of the following, and then press the [] button.

Off: Disables 4K Enhancement. If a signal that exceeds the panel resolution of this projector is input, the image is displayed according to the panel resolution of this projector.

Full HD: If a signal with a resolution of 1080i/1080p/WUXGA or higher is input, 4K Enhancement is enabled.

WUXGA+: If a signal with a resolution that exceeds WUXGA is input, 4K Enhancement is enabled. To project a high-resolution movie, you can project a high-definition image by using this setting with Image Preset Mode.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - 4K Enhancement (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only) - 1

text_image [4K Enhancement] Off Full HD WUXGA+ Return
  • To project from multiple projectors, select Off to unify each image.
  • Off is ideal for projecting presentation materials from computers and so on.
  • If set to Full HD or WUXGA+, the status corrected using the following function is canceled.

Edge Blending, Scale, Curved Surface, Point Correction, Corner Wall

When 4K Enhancement is set to Off, the settings return to their previous state.

3 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

Image Preset Mode

Select the optimal setting according to the projected image from five presets prepared in advance.

The following settings are saved in the presets.

Frame Interpolation, Deinterlacing, Noise Reduction, MPEG Noise Reduction, Super-resolution, Detail Enhancement

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Image Preset Mode - 1

  • To minimize delays, set Image Preset Mode to Off.
  • If you set Image Preset Mode to Off, you cannot set the other items in Image Enhancement.

1 Select Image Preset Mode from Image Enhancement, and then press the 🔊 button.
2 Select one of the following, and then press the [] button.

Preset 1 to Preset 5: The settings saved in advance are applied to the image.

Off: Select this to turn off presets.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Image Preset Mode - 2

text_image [Image Preset Mode] Off Preset 1 Preset 2 Preset 3 Preset 4 Preset 5 Return

Esc / [●]: Return : Select Menu: Exit

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

  • After selecting Preset 1 to Preset 5, you can fine tune each setting individually. The setting after adjustment will be overwritten.
    •The setting after adjustment will be overwritten separately when 4K Enhancement is enabled and disabled.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

Frame Interpolation

The current and previous frames are used to create intermediate frames, interpolating to produce smooth-moving images. You can resolve clumsy-moving images, such as frame skipping when projecting a fast moving image.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Frame Interpolation - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Top Filmstrip"] --> B["Step 1"]
    B --> C["Step 2"]
    C --> D["Step 3"]
    D --> E["Step 4"]
    E --> F["Final Output"]

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Frame Interpolation - 2

You cannot set Frame Interpolation in the following situations.

  • When 4K Enhancement is enabled
  • When a signal with a resolution that exceeds WUXGA is input
  • When Aspect is set to V-Zoom
  • When Scale is set to Auto or Manual
  • When Edge Blending is set to On

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Frame Interpolation - 3

Select Frame Interpolation from Image Enhancement, and then press the [√] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Frame Interpolation - 4

Select the level of interpolation from Low, Normal or High. Set to Off if noise occurs after setting them.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Frame Interpolation - 5

text_image [Frame Interpolation] Return Off Low Normal High [Esc] / [◆]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Frame Interpolation - 6

Press the Menu button to finish making settings.

Noise Reduction

You can smooth out rough images for softer image quality when inputting progressive signals or progressive interlace signals.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Noise Reduction - 1

This is disabled in the following cases.

  • When 4K Enhancement is enabled
  • When a signal with a resolution that exceeds WUXGA is input

1 Select Noise Reduction from Image Enhancement, and then press the [J] button.
2 Use the [◀][▶] buttons to adjust the value.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Noise Reduction - 2

text_image [Image Enhancement] Noise Reduction 0 Return [Esc] / [O]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

3 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

MPEG Noise Reduction

You can reduce dot and block noise that occurs in outlines when projecting MPEG movies.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - MPEG Noise Reduction - 1

This is disabled in the following cases.

  • When 4K Enhancement is enabled
  • When a signal with a resolution that exceeds WUXGA is input

1 Select MPEG Noise Reduction from Image Enhancement, and then press the ↻ button.
2 Select a level to reduce noise from Low, Normal, or High, and then press the ↻ button.

If Off is selected, MPEG Noise Reduction is disabled.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - MPEG Noise Reduction - 2

text_image [MPEG Noise Reduction] Return Off Low Normal High [Esc] / [●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

3 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

Super-resolution

To display a crisp image, you can reduce the blurring that is created on the edge when the resolution of the image signal is scaled up and projected.

1 Select Super-resolution from Image Enhancement, and then press the [√] button.
2 Use the [▲][▼] buttons to select the item, and then use the [◀][▶] buttons to make the adjustments.

Fine Line Adjust: If this parameter is set to a positive value, details such as hair or fabric patterns will be enhanced.

Soft Focus Detail: If this parameter is set to a positive value, the outline, background, and the other main parts of the objects in the image will be enhanced to show them clearly.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Super-resolution - 1

text_image [Super-resolution] Fine Line Adjust 0 Soft Focus Detail 0 Return [Esc] / [◆]: Return [◆]: Select [Menu]: Exit

3 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

Detail Enhancement

You can enhance the contrast in detailed areas of an image to create a more emphatic texture and material feel.

1 Select Detail Enhancement from Image Enhancement, and then press the 🔊 button.
2 Use the [▲][▼] buttons to select the item, and then use the [◀][▶] buttons to make the adjustments.

Strength: The larger the value, the more the contrast is enhanced. Range: The larger the value, the wider the range of detail enhancement becomes.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Detail Enhancement - 1

text_image [Detail Enhancement] Strength 0 Return Range 0 [Esc] / [●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Detail Enhancement - 2

text_image Depending on the image, a highlight may be noticeable at the border between colors. If this bothers you, set a smaller value.

3 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

Projecting 3D Images

By using two projectors, you can project passive 3D images. The following are required to project and view 3D images.

•Polarizer
•Passive 3D glasses
- Mount for stacking

Adjusting the Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 1

•Silver screen for passive 3D

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 2

This projector arranges the direction of polarizing projection for R (red), G (green), and B (blue). It is not necessary to inverse left and right eye G (green) image signals.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjusting the Projected Images - 3

Useful Functions

This section describes the Multi-Projection, Split Screen, Memory, Schedule, and Security functions.

Multi-Projection Function

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Multi-Projection Function - 1

You can setup up to 9 projectors to project one large and wide image. You can adjust the difference of brightness and color tone between each projected image to create a seamless screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Multi-Projection Function - 2

- Set 4K Enhancement to Off. (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only)

- We recommend setting the focus, zoom, and lens shift at least 20 minutes after you start the projection, because images are not stable right after turning on the projector.

- If the values for Geometry Correction are large, the image position adjustment for overlapping images becomes difficult.

•The Test Pattern can be displayed to adjust the projection status without connecting video equipment.

"Displaying the Test Pattern" p.33

- If you project a dot by dot image that can be projected without being enlarged or reduced, you can make adjustments precisely.

- When Run Periodically is set to On in Light Source Calibration, calibration is automatically performed, and colors adjusted using multi-projection may change. Set this to Off to maintain the projected image as it is.

Reset - Light Source Calibration - Run Periodically p.162

Adjustment Procedure

Advance preparation

(1) Turn on all projectors.

(2) Set an ID for all projectors and the remote controls.

"Set the projector ID" p.42

Adjusting the projected position

(1) Adjust the position (angle) of the projector.

"Installation Settings" p.31

(2) Adjust the arrangement of the images.

"Tiling" p.90

Adjusting the projected images

(1) Adjust the aspect ratio of the images.

"Screen Settings" p.32

"Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image" p.80

(2) Adjust the lens shift.

"Adjusting the Position of the Projected Image (Lens Shift Adjustment)" p.34

(3) Adjust the zoom and focus.

"Adjusting the Image Size" p.37

"Correcting the Focus" p.38

(4) Adjust small differences in the images.

"Point Correction" p.74

(5) Adjust the edges of the images.

"Edge Blending" p.91

"Black Level" p.93

(6) Adjust the brightness and tint of the images.

"Color Matching" p.96

(7) Select the sections of the images.

"Displaying a Scaled Image" p.97

Tiling

When using multiple projectors to create one large image, assign a projection position to each projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Tiling - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Input Device"] --> B["Cloud Processing"]
    B --> C["Output Device 1"]
    B --> D["Output Device 2"]
    B --> E["Output Device 3"]
    B --> F["Output Device 4"]

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Tiling - 2

Before performing tiling, adjust the projected image so that it is a rectangle. Also, adjust the size and focus of the images.

"Adjusting the Image Size" p.37
"Correcting the Focus" p.38

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Multi-Projection from Extended, and then press the [◀] button.
3 Select Tiling, and then press the [←] button.
4 Select Layout, and then press the [←] button.

(1) Set the number of projectors in Row and Column.
(2) Select Settings, and then press the [←] button.

5 Repeat steps 1 to 4 for each projector to be used for tiling.

6 Select Location Setup, and then press the [←] button.

(1) Set the positions of the projected images in Row Order and Column Order.

Row Order: Place screens from top to bottom in the order of 1, 2, 3.

Column Order: Place screens from left to right in the order of A, B, C.

1A1B
2A2B

(2) Select Settings, and then press the [←] button.

7 Repeat step 6 for each projector.
8 Input the image signal to display the image.

"Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search)" p.61

When tiling is complete, adjust any positional gaps and the tint of the projected images.

"Adjusting the projected images" p.90

Edge Blending

You can fine tune the overlapping areas to make seamless screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Edge Blending - 1

natural_image Two rectangular panels: one gradient gray, the other with a dashed rectangle (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Edge Blending - 2

Before performing edge blending to raise the precision of adjustments, press the [Color Mode] button on the remote control, and then Color Mode to Multi-Projection.

set

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Multi-Projection from Extended.
3 Select Edge Blending, and then press the [←] button.

The following screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Edge Blending - 3

text_image [Edge Blending] Return Edge Blending Off Top Edge Off Bottom Edge Off Left Edge Off Right Edge Off Line Guide Off Pattern Guide Off Guide Color Red [Esc] / [◆]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit
Submenu Function
Edge BlendingSet to On to activate Edge Blending. Set to Off when not projecting from multiple projectors.
Submenu Function
Top Edge/Bottom Edge/Left Edge/Right EdgeBlending: Set to On to activate Edge Blending towards your settings, and the blend range will be shaded.Blend Start Position: Displays blending start position as a red line, and adjusts at the level of one pixel.Blend Range: Adjusts the range to be shaded. Adjustment is possible at the level of one pixel. The maximum range is 45% of the resolution.Blend Curve: Select how to apply shading.
Line GuideSet to On to display a guide on the Edge Blending setting range.
Pattern GuideSet to On to display a lattice pattern to match the position of the Edge Blending setting range.
Guide ColorSelect a combination of guide colors.

5 Set Line Guide to On.

(1) Select Line Guide, and then press the [←] button.
(2) Select On, and then press the [←] button.
(3) Press the Esc button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Edge Blending - 4

If the guide is not clear, you can change the color of the guide in Guide Color.

6 Set Pattern Guide to On.

(1) Select Pattern Guide, and then press the [←] button.
(2) Select On, and then press the [←] button.
(3) Press the Esc button.

7 Set Top Edge, Bottom Edge, Left Edge, or Right Edge according to the parts of the image that are overlapped.

The following shows how to set screen (1) as an example.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Set Top Edge, Bottom Edge, Left Edge, or Right Edge according to the parts of the image that are overlapped. - 1

text_image ① ③ ②

In the example above, you need to adjust the Left Edge because you can see the overlapping areas on the left side of the image (1).

(1) Select Left Edge, and then press the [←] button.
(2) Select Blending, and then press the [←] button.
(3) Select On, and then press the [←] button.
(4) Press the Esc button.
(5) In Blend Start Position, align the blending start position with the edge (2) of the image.
(6) Press the Esc button.
(7) In Blend Range, adjust the range (3) to be shaded. The value for when the overlapped range and the guide are in the same position is the best.
(8) In Blend Curve, adjust how to apply shading.
(9) Press the Esc button.

8 After the settings are complete, set Line Guide and Pattern Guide to Off to finish.

Black Level

When a black image is displayed, only areas where the images overlap stands out. The black level function allows you to match the brightness and tone for areas where the images do not overlap with areas where the images overlap, to make the difference less noticeable.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 1

natural_image Diagram showing a vertical arrow pointing to a dashed rectangular shape, with two dark rectangular blocks above and one gray block below (no text or symbols)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 2

- You cannot adjust the Black Level when a test pattern is displayed.

  • If the Geometry Correction value is large, you may not be able to adjust correctly.
  • The brightness and tone may differ in areas where the images overlap as well as in other areas even after performing black level adjustment.
  • If you change the Top Edge/Bottom Edge/Right Edge/Left Edge setting, the Black Level is returned to its default value. "Edge Blending" p.91

1 Select Black Level from Multi-Projection, and then press the [↓] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 3

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset [Multi-Projection] Return Projector ID Off Tiling Geometry Correction H/V-Keystone Edge Blending Black Level Scale Photo Color Mode Brightness Settings Color Matching Color Uniformity Reset [Esc]:Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

2 Select Color Adjustment, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 4

text_image [Black Level] Return Signal Color Adjustment Area Correction Reset Settings Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

The areas are displayed based on the settings for Top Edge/Bottom Edge/Right Edge/Left Edge.

3 Select the area you want to adjust, and then press the [] button.

The selected area is displayed in orange.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 5

text_image When multiple screens are overlapping, adjust based on the area with the most overlap (the brightest area). In the illustration below, first align (2) with (1), and then adjust so that (3) aligns with (2). ① ② ② ③

4 Adjust the black tone and brightness.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 6

text_image [Color Adjustment] Red 0 Green 0 Blue 0 Brightness Return [Esc]:Return [◆]:Select [◆]:Adjust [Menu]:Exit [Default]:Reset

5 Repeat steps 3 and 4 as needed to adjust any remaining parts.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 7

After this, if the tone for some areas do not match, adjust them by Area Correction.

6 Press the Esc button, to return to the screen displayed in step 2.

7 Select Area Correction, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 8

text_image [Black Level] Return Color Adjustment Area Correction Reset Settings Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

8 Select Start Adjustments, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 9

text_image [Area Correction] Return Start Adjustments Points 0 Settings Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

Boundary lines that indicate areas where images overlap are displayed.

The boundary lines are displayed based on the settings for Top Edge/Bottom Edge/Right Edge/Left Edge.

9 Use the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons to select a boundary line of the area you want to adjust.

The selected line is displayed in orange.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 10

natural_image Simple geometric shape: a black triangle on a gray background with a vertical line and horizontal line (no text or symbols)

10 Press the ↓ button to confirm the selection.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 11

11 Use the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons to adjust the boundary line positions, and then press the [↓] button.

12 Press the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons to select the point you want to move, and then press the◀[ ] button. The selected point is displayed in orange.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 12

13 Press the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons to move the point. To continue to move another point, press the |Esc| button to return to step 12, and then repeat steps 12 and 13. To adjust another boundary line, press the Esc button until the screen for selecting a boundary line from step 9 is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Black Level - 13

To return Black Level to its default value, press the Esc button to return to the screen from step 7, select [Reset], and then press the ↓ button.

14 To complete the adjustment, press the Menu button.

Color Matching

You can fine tune the color balance and brightness from black to white for each color tone.

1 Select Color Matching from Multi-Projection, and then press the [◀] button.

The following screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Matching - 1

text_image [Color Matching] Adjustment Level 8 Red 0 Green 0 Blue 0 Brightness - / +

Half of the overlapped area is displayed in black so that it is easy to check the edge of the image.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Matching - 2

Adjustment Level: There are eight levels from white, through gray, and up to black. You can adjust each level individually. Red, Green, Blue: Adjusts the tone for each color. Brightness: Adjusts the image brightness.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Matching - 3

Whenever the 🎨 button is pressed, the screen changes between the projected image and the adjustment screen.

2 Select Adjustment Level, and then use the [◀][▶] buttons to set the adjustment level.
3 Select Red, Green, or Blue, and then press the [◀][▶] buttons to adjust the color tone.
4 Select Brightness, and then use the [◀][▶] buttons to adjust the brightness.
5 Return to step 1 and adjust each level.
6 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

Displaying a Scaled Image

A section of the image is cropped and displayed. This allows you to create one large image by combining images projected from multiple projectors.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying a Scaled Image - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Input"] --> B["Process 1"]
    A --> C["Process 2"]
    B --> D["Output 1"]
    C --> E["Output 2"]

1 Project the image, and then press the Menu button.
2 Select Multi-Projection from Extended.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying a Scaled Image - 2

You can also perform the same operation from Scale in Signal.

3 Select Scale, and then press the [←] button.
4 Turn on Scale.

(1) Select Scale, and then press the [←] button.
(2) Select Auto or Manual, and then press the [←] button.

Auto: Automatically adjusts the clipped area according to the adjustment values in Edge Blending and Tiling. You do not need to perform any steps after step 6.

Manual: Allows you to adjust the clipped area manually.

(3) Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying a Scaled Image - 3

If auto adjustment does not work for the clipped image, adjust the aspect ratio, and then select Auto.

"Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image" p.80

5 Set Scale Mode.

(1) Select Scale Mode, and then press the [←] button.
(2) Select Zoom Display or Full Display, and then press the [←] button. Zoom Display: Adjusts according to the image currently displayed.

Enlarge
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Set Scale Mode. - 1

natural_image Two-panel image showing a beach scene before and after transformation, with no visible text or symbols.

Move
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Set Scale Mode. - 2

natural_image Diagram showing a fish jumping from water surface to dark environment, with no visible text or symbols

Full Display: Adjusts according to the projector's panel size (the maximum area in which an image can be displayed).

Enlarge
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Set Scale Mode. - 3

natural_image Two-step diagram showing a person standing on water with cloud-like patterns, before and after transformation (no text or symbols)

Move
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Set Scale Mode. - 4

natural_image Diagram showing a person floating on water with cloud-like patterns, transforming into a dark rectangular frame (no text or symbols)

(3) Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

6 Adjust the scale.

Select the adjustment method with the [▲][▼]buttons, then adjust using the [■][▶] buttons. (Minimum magnification of 0.5 to maximum magnification of 10)

-+: Enlarges or reduces an image horizontally and vertically at the same time.

Scale Vertically: Enlarges or reduces an image vertically.

Scale Horizontally: Enlarges or reduces an image horizontally.

7 The image is clipped and adjusted.

(1) Select Clip Adjustment, and then press the [◀] button. If you select Clip Range, the range and coordinates of the image that the projector will project is displayed.

(2) Use the [▲], [▼], and [ ] buttons to scroll the image. Adjust the coordinates and size of each image while viewing the screen.

(3) Press the Menu button to finish making settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is clipped and adjusted. - 1

You can check the displayed area after clipping for the entire image from Clip Range.

Projecting Two Images Simultaneously (Split Screen)

You can simultaneously project images from two sources on the right and left of the screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projecting Two Images Simultaneously (Split Screen) - 1

bar_line | Month | Bar Value | Line Value | |---|---|---| | Jan | 10 | 8 | | Feb | 6 | 9 | | Mar | 5 | 7 | | Apr | 7 | 8 | | May | 6 | 7 | | Jun | 4 | 6 | | Jul | 5 | 7 | | Aug | 6 | 8 | | Sep | 5 | 7 | | Oct | 4 | 6 | | Nov | 6 | 7 | | Dec | 7 | 8 |

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projecting Two Images Simultaneously (Split Screen) - 2

You cannot use the Split Screen feature in Content Playback mode.

Input Sources for Split Screen Projection

The combinations of input sources that can be projected on a split screen are listed below.

Left Screen Right Screen
HDMI HDBa-seTDVI-D Com-puterBNC LAN
HDMI -
HDBaseT -
DVI-D -
Computer -
BNC---
LAN---

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Input Sources for Split Screen Projection - 1

- Signals with a horizontal resolution that exceeds 1920 are not supported.

- If 4K Enhancement is enabled, a message is displayed. Select Yes to disable 4K Enhancement. (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only)

Image - Image Enhancement - 4K Enhancement p.140

Operating procedures

Projecting on a split screen

1 Press the [Split] button on the remote control while projecting. The currently selected input source is projected on the left of the screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Operating procedures - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Operating procedures - 2

You can perform the same operations from the configuration menu.

Settings - Split Screen p.143

2 Press the Menu button.

The Split Screen Setup screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Operating procedures - 3

text_image [Split Screen Setup] Screen Size Equal Source Swap Screens Audio Source Auto [Network] Display the QR Code Exit Split Screen

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Operating procedures - 4

Select

3 Select Source, and then press the [←] button.

4 Select each input source for Left and Right.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Operating procedures - 5

text_image [Source] Return Left Right HDMI HDBaseT DVI-D Computer BNC LAN Execute

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Operating procedures - 6

/ [+] : Return

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Operating procedures - 7

You can perform the same operations using the following procedure.

"Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search)" p.61
"Switching to the Target Image by Remote Control" p.62

5 Select Execute, and then press the [←] button.

To switch the source during split screen projection, start the procedure from step 2.

Projection Functions

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 1

101

Switching the left and right screens

Use the following procedure to switch the projected images.

1 Press the Menu button during split screen projection.
2 Select Swap Screens, and then press the [◀] button. The projected images on the left and right are swapped.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 2

text_image Comparison image showing two cityscape photos with overlaid line graphs and a magnified inset graph, likely from a photo processing or analysis workflow.

Switching the left and right image sizes

1 Press the Menu button during split screen projection.
2 Select the Screen Size, and then press the [←] button.
3 Select the screen size you want to display, and then press the []← button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 3

text_image [Screen Size] Return Equal Larger Left Larger Right

Esc:Return :Select [●]:Set Menu:Exit

The projected images will appear as shown below after setting the screen size.

Equal Larger Left
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 4

line | Date | Value | |---|---| | 2018-01-01 | 1.0 | | 2018-02-01 | 1.5 | | 2018-03-01 | 2.0 | | 2018-04-01 | 1.8 | | 2018-05-01 | 2.5 | | 2018-06-01 | 2.2 | | 2018-07-01 | 2.8 | | 2018-08-01 | 3.0 | | 2018-09-01 | 2.7 | | 2018-10-01 | 3.5 | | 2018-11-01 | 3.2 | | 2018-12-01 | 3.8 |

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 5

bar_line | Period | Bar Value | Line Value | |---|---|---| | 1 | 0.8 | 0.9 | | 2 | 0.6 | 0.7 | | 3 | 0.7 | 0.8 | | 4 | 0.6 | 0.6 | | 5 | 0.7 | 0.7 | | 6 | 0.8 | 0.6 | | 7 | 0.9 | 0.5 | | 8 | 0.8 | 0.6 | | 9 | 0.9 | 0.7 |

Larger Right
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 6

text_image Composite image showing a line chart and city skyline with skyscrapers, alongside a small inset bar chart.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 7

  • You cannot enlarge both the left screen and right screen images at the same time.
  • When one image is enlarged, the other image is reduced.
  • Depending on the video signals that are input, the images on the left and right may not appear to be the same size even if Equal is set.

Changing the audio

1 Press the Menu button during split screen projection.
2 Select Audio Source, and then press the [◀] button.

Projection Functions

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 1

102

3 Select the audio you want to output, and then press the [] button.

When you select Auto, audio is output for the enlarged screen. If the screen sizes are Equal, audio is output for the screen on the left.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Projection Functions - 2

text_image [Audio Source] Return Auto Screen Left Screen Right [Esc] / [O]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

Ending the split screen

Press the [Esc] button to end split screen.

The following steps can also be used to end the split screen.

  • Press the [Split] button on the remote control.
  • Select Exit Split Screen on the Split Screen Setup screen. p.100

Restrictions during split screen projection

Operating restrictions

The following operations cannot be performed during split screen projection.

  • Setting the configuration menu
    •E-Zoom
    •Changing the aspect mode
  • Using the [User1], [User2], or [User3] button on the remote control
  • Help can be displayed only when image signals are not input or when an error or warning notification is displayed.
    •The user's logo is not displayed.

Restriction relating to images

  • For the image on the right screen, the default values for the Image menu are applied. However, the settings for the image projected on the left screen are applied to the image on the right screen for Color Mode, Color Temp., Frame Interpolation, and Super-resolution.
  • Deinterlacing and Noise Reduction are only enabled for the left screen.

Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute)

You can use this when you want to focus the audience's attention on what you are saying, or if you do not want to show details such as when you are changing between files during presentations from a computer.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute) - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Input Box"] --> B["Bar Chart 1"]
    B --> C["Bar Chart 2"]
    C --> D["Output Table"]
    D --> E["Next Step"]
    E --> F["Blank Output"]

Each time you press the [A/V Mute] button, A/V Mute turns on or off.

Remote control
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute) - 2

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute) - 3

- When A/V Mute is enabled, the light source turns off.

- If you want to fade out or fade in when turning the video on or off, set the desired number of seconds in Fade-out and Fadc-in.

Extended - Operation - A/V Mute Settings - Fade-out, Fade-in p.146

- When A/V mute is activated and no operations are performed for about 2 hours, the projector turns off automatically. If you do not want to turn off the power, set A/V Mute 'Timer to Off.

Extended - Operation - A/V Mute Settings - A/V Mute Timer p.146

- When A/V Mute Release is set to A/V Mute from the configuration menu, the following operations can still be performed without releasing A/V mute.

- Change the source with the change input buttons on the remote control.

- Control the projector from a computer using communication commands.

Extended - Operation - A/V Mute Settings - A/V Mute Release p.146

A/V mute is only released by pressing the [A/V Mute] button, or by sending an A/V mute Off command.

- When projecting moving images, the images and sound continue to be played back while A/V Mute is on. It is not possible to resume projection from the point where A/V Mute was activated.

Freezing the Image (Freeze)

When Freeze is activated on moving images, the frozen image continues to project on the screen, so you can project a moving image one frame at a time like a still photo. Also, you can perform operations such as changing between files during presentations from a computer without projecting any images if the Freeze function is activated beforehand.

Each time you press the |Freeze| button, Freeze turns on or off.

Remote control
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Freezing the Image (Freeze) - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Freezing the Image (Freeze) - 2

•Audio does not stop.
- When projecting moving images, the images continue to be played back while the screen is frozen. It is not possible to resume projection from the point where the screen was frozen.
- If the [Freeze] button is pressed while the Configuration menu or the Help screen is displayed, the menu or the Help screen that is displayed is closed.
- Freeze still works while E-Zoom is being used.

Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom)

This is useful when you want to expand images to see them in greater detail, such as graphs and tables.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom) - 1

bar_line | Category | Bar Value | Line Value | | -------- | --------- | ---------- | | Top Left | 100 | 100 | | Top Right| 80 | 90 | | Bottom Left| 60 | 70 | | Bottom Right| 50 | 60 | | Bottom Left| 40 | 50 | | Bottom Right| 30 | 40 | | Bottom Left| 20 | 30 | | Bottom Right| 10 | 20 | | Bottom Left| 5 | 10 | | Bottom Right| 0 | 5 |

1 Start E-Zoom.

Press the Ⓔ] button to display the Cross

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom) - 2

2 Move the Cross ( ) to the area of the image that you want to enlarge.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom) - 3

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom) - 4

3 Enlarge.

Remote control
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom) - 5

[④] button: Expands the area each time it is pressed. You can expand quickly by holding the button down.

|⊖| button: Reduces images that have been enlarged.

Esc button: Cancels E-Zoom.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom) - 6

- During enlarged projection, press the [▲], [▼], [◀], or [▶] buttons to scroll the image.

- E-Zoom is unavailable when Scale is on. Signal - Scale p.142

- If 4K Enhancement is enabled, a message is displayed. Select Yes to disable 4K Enhancement. (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/FB-L1060U/FB-L1050U only)

Image - Image Enhancement - 4K Enhancement p.140

You can save the image that is currently being projected as a User's Logo.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving a User's Logo - 1

- When User's Logo Protection from Password Protection is set to On, a message is displayed and the User's Logo cannot be changed. Perform operations after setting User's Logo Protection to Off.

"Managing Users (Password Protection)" p.115

- If you use the batch setup function to copy menu settings between multiple projectors, the User's Logo is also copied. Do not set images that you do not want to share across multiple projectors as the User's Logo.

1 Project the image you want to save as the User's Logo, and then press the Menu button.

"Configuration Menu Operations" p.136

2 Select User's Logo from Extended.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving a User's Logo - 2

When you select User's Logo, settings such as Geometry Correction, E-Zoom, Aspect, Scale, and Screen Type are temporarily disabled.

3 Select Start Setting, and then press the [←] button.

The confirmation screen is displayed.

4 Select Yes, and then press the [←] button.

When the message "Save this image as the User's Logo?" is displayed, select Yes.

The image is saved. After the image has been saved, the message "Completed." is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving a User's Logo - 3

Select Reset to delete the image you registered and return to the default settings.

Content Playback Feature

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Content Playback Feature - 1

Content Playback mode allows you to project images suitable for digital signage in locations such as museums, showrooms, and stores. You can project playlists of photos and videos stored in an external memory. You can use the effects features to change the color and shape of the projected image.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Content Playback Feature - 2

natural_image Interior view of a gallery hallway with two people viewing a framed floral artwork on the wall (no text or symbols visible)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Content Playback Feature - 3

The Content Playback feature uses the USB-A port; this means that you cannot use the wireless LAN feature at the same time.

Switching to Content Playback Mode

Switch to Content Playback mode to play a playlist.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

2 Select Content Playback from Settings.

3 Select On, and then press the [←] button. A confirmation message is displayed.

4 Restart the projector to enable Content Playback mode.

5 Press the [button on the control panel or the remote control. The Home screen is displayed.

6 Check that Content Playback mode is enabled.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Switching to Content Playback Mode - 1

text_image EPSON Sources : Switching at sources... HDME HDBaseT DVI-0 Computer BNC USB LAN Userful functions Color Mode Light Source Mode Image Enhancement Frame Interpolation Menu Help Constant Playback : On Projector Value: XXXXXXXX Keyword: XXXXX $50 : XXXXXXXX-XXXXXXXXXX IP : XXXXXXXX IP : XXXXXXXX.XXX Connective Guide Switch the source. Close) Exit

Playing a Playlist

Content Playback mode allows you to project photos and videos that have been saved as playlists.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Playing a Playlist - 1

flowchart
graph LR
    A["Laptop with icons"] --> B["USB"]
    B --> C["Monitor displaying a PNG file with 'Playoff 1', 'Playoff 2', 'Playoff 3', 'Playoff 4', 'Playoff 5', 'Playoff 6', 'Playoff 7', 'Playoff 8'"]

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Playing a Playlist - 2

  • You need to assign USB to a User Button in advance. Settings - User Button p.143
    •The USB flash drive must meet the following requirements.

  • Formatted as FAT 16/32

  • Only one partition
  • No security features enabled
  • Do not use a multi-card reader or USB hub
  • Total length of USB flash drive is 6 cm or less

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Playing a Playlist - 3

natural_image Diagram of a device inside a rack with a blue component inserted, showing no text or symbols

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Playing a Playlist - 4

Press the user button assigned to USB on the remote control. The first playlist or the scheduled playlist is played.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Playing a Playlist - 5

  • Press the numeric buttons while holding down the [Num] button to play a playlist that has been registered to you favorites. You can register favorites using Epson Projector Content Manager.
  • To select a playlist to play from the list, select USB Viewer from the Settings menu, and then use the up, down, left, and right buttons to select your file.
    Settings - Content Playback - USB Viewer p.143

1 Create a playlist using Epson Projector Content Manager and save it to a USB flash device.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Playing a Playlist - 6

See the "Epson Projector Content Manager Operation Guide" for details.

2 Connect the USB flash drive to the projector's USB-A port (the wireless LAN module installation section) while Content Playback mode is enabled.

"Installing the Wireless LAN Unit" p.54

Adding Effects to Images (Effect Feature)

In Content Playback mode, you can change the color and shape of the image you are projecting.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adding Effects to Images (Effect Feature) - 1

natural_image Two circular images showing a floral arrangement with pink roses and white flowers, no text or symbols visible.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adding Effects to Images (Effect Feature) - 2

When using the Effect feature, you need to run Refresh Mode periodically.

Reset - Refresh Mode p.162

1 Press the Menu button while Content Playback mode is enabled, select [Settings], and then press the◀] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adding Effects to Images (Effect Feature) - 3

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Geometry Correction H/V-Keystone Volume 0 HDMI Link Lock Setting Brightness Settings Remote Receiver Front/Rear User Button Test Pattern Memory Content Playback Reset [Esc] .Return [◆].Select [●].Enter [Menu].Exit

2 Select Overlay Effect from Content Playback, and then press the [◀] button.

3 Set Overlay Effect to On, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adding Effects to Images (Effect Feature) - 4

text_image [Overlay Effect] Overlay Effect Off Shape Filter Off Color Filter Off Lightness 0 [◆]:Select [◆]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

4 Select Shape Filter, and then press the [◀] button.

5 Adjust the following items as necessary.

- Shape: Select the shape of the effect from Circle, Square, or Custom.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adding Effects to Images (Effect Feature) - 5

You can register your favorite images to Custom using Epson Projector Content Manager. See the "Epson Projector Content Manager Operation Guide" for details.

  • Filter Effect: Select whether to mask the inside or the outside of the selected shape.
    •Size: Set the size of the selected shape.
  • Position: Set the display position of the selected shape.

6 Select Color Filter, and then press the [←] button.
7 Adjust the following items as necessary.

•Color Filter: Select the color of the effect.

- Custom: Adjust the Red, Green, and Blue.

8 Select Lightness to set the brightness of the effect.
9 Press the Menu button to finish making settings.

Restrictions on Content Playback Mode

Operating restrictions

You cannot change the following operations or settings in Content Playback mode.

Content Playback Feature

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Content Playback Feature - 1

• Color Temp. (when Warm White or Cool White is selected as the Color Filter)
- Blanking
- Split Screen
- Display Background
•Screen
•Auto Source Search
- Remote Password
-Edge Blending
- Log Save Destination
Also, you cannot use Epson Projector Professional Tool in Content Playback mode.

Memory Function

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Memory Function - 1

The settings for the image currently displayed and values for geometry correction are saved as a memory, allowing you to load them when necessary.

Saving/Loading/Erasing/Resetting the Memory

1 Press the [Memory] button while projecting.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving/Loading/Erasing/Resetting the Memory - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving/Loading/Erasing/Resetting the Memory - 2

You can also operate from the Configuration menu.

Settings - Memory p.143

2 Select a memory type, and then press the [] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving/Loading/Erasing/Resetting the Memory - 3

text_image [Memory] Return Settings Memory Lens Position Geometry Correction Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] /[●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

Memory: Settings for the following menu items are saved in the memory. You can register up to 10 values.

Top Menu Submenu
ImageAll setting items
SignalScale
SettingsBrightness Settings
ExtendedEdge BlendingBlack LevelColor Matching

Lens Position: Registers the position of the lens adjusted using lens shift, zoom, focus, and distortion. You can register up to 10 values. "Registering and Loading Lens Adjustment Values" p.39

Geometry Correction: Adjustment value of the geometry correction is saved. You can register up to 3 values.

3 Select the function you want to perform, then press the [] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving/Loading/Erasing/Resetting the Memory - 4

text_image [Memory] Return Load Memory Save Memory Erase Memory Rename Memory Reset Memory Settings Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] / [●]: Return [◆]: Select [Menu]: Exit
Function Explanation
Load MemoryLoads the saved memory. When you select a memory and press the [←] button, the settings applied to the current image are replaced with the settings from the memory.
Save MemoryRegisters current settings in the memory. When you select a memory name and press the [←] button, the settings are saved.
Erase MemoryErases the registered memory. When you select a memory name and press the [←] button, a message is displayed. Select Yes, and then press the [←] button to erase the selected memory.
Rename MemoryChanges the memory name. Select the memory name you want to change, and then press the [←] button. Enter the memory name using the soft keyboard. "Soft keyboard operations" p.152When you have finished, move the cursor over Finish, and then press the [←] button.
Function Explanation
Reset MemoryResets the name and settings of a saved memory.To reset all memories saved in Memory, Lcns Position, and Geometry Correction, use Reset All Memories.◆ Reset - Reset All Memories p.162

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving/Loading/Erasing/Resetting the Memory - 5

If the mark on the left of the memory name is turned blue, it means the memory has already been registered. When you select a registered memory, a message is displayed asking you to confirm that you want to overwrite the memory. If you select Yes, the previous settings are deleted and the current settings are registered.

Scheduling Function

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Scheduling Function - 1

You can schedule turning the projector power on/off and switching the input source, as events in the schedule. Registered events are executed automatically at the specified time on the specified dates or weekly. You can register up to 30 events in Schedule, and one event in Extended Schedule.

Saving an Event

Setting an Event

1 Press the Menu button while projecting. "Configuration Menu Operations" p.136

2 Select Schedule Settings from Extended. 3 Select Add New from Schedule.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting an Event - 1

text_image Schedule Settings Start Now End Now 10:00 24:00 30:00 36:00 42:00 48:00 54:00 60:00 66:00 72:00 78:00 84:00 90:00 96:00 102:00 108:00 114:00 120:00 126:00 132:00 138:00 144:00 150:00 156:00 162:00 168:00 174:00 180:00 186:00 192:00 198:00 204:00 210:00 216:00 222:00 228:00 234:00 240:00 246:00 252:00 258:00 264:00 270:00 276:00 282:00 288:00 294:00 300:00 306:00 312:00 318:00 324:00 330:00 336:00 342:00 348:00 354:00 360:00 366:00 372:00 378:00 384:00 390:00 396:00 402:00 408:00 414:00 420:00 426:00 432:00 438:00 444:00 450:00 456:00 462:00 468:00 474:00 480:00 486:00 492:00 498:00 504:00 510:00 516:00 522:00 528:00 534:00 540:00 546:00 552:00 558:00 564:00 570:00 576:00 582:00 588:00 594: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1

4 Set the schedule.

Submenu Name Function
Event SettingsSelect an operation of the projector when the event is executed. Select No Change for items that you do not want to change when the event occurs.You can set the following item operations.SchedulePowerSourceLight Source ModeA/V MuteLight Source CalibrationRefresh ModeVolume
Date / Time SettingsSet the date, day of the week, and time to execute the event. You can set up to four weeks later. Use the soft keyboard to enter the date and time."Soft keyboard operations" p.152

5 Select Save, and then press the [←] button.

To register additional events, repeat steps 3 to 5.

6 Select Setup complete, and then select Yes to finish saving.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting an Event - 2

- Light Source Calibration does not start automatically when the projector is used continuously for more than 24 hours, or when direct shutdown is used regularly. Set Light Source Calibration to enable this function after every 100 hours of usage. - When Light Source Calibration is enabled, turn on the projector at least 20 minutes before the event.

Scheduling Function

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Scheduling Function - 1

Checking an Event

This section explains how to check a Schedule event.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Schedule Settings from Extended.

3 Press the [◀][▶] buttons to highlight the date you want to check. The details of the events registered on the selected date are displayed. The indicator turns on when an event is saved.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Checking an Event - 1

text_image Schedule Settings Add Noise 08:00 / Sandy/Communication (0) 13:00P / Power Consumption (DCI) 15:00P / Service (SIC) 17:00P / Power Consumption (Normal) 04:00 04:00 04:00 04:00 04:00 Select Show Latency Latency

(Blue): Enabled event
(Gray): Disabled event

: Regular event

(Aqua): Single event
(Orange): Regular event
(Green): Communication monitoring On/Off
= (Gray): Disabled event

Editing an Event

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.

"Configuration Menu Operations" p.136

Scheduling Function

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Scheduling Function - 1

2 Select Schedule Settings from Extended.
3 Use the [◀][▶] buttons to highlight the date containing the event you want to edit.
4 Highlight the event you want to edit, and then press the Esc button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Scheduling Function - 2

text_image Schedule Settings Add Time 08:00 / ScanRay/Communication (0) 13:00 / Filter Communication (5) 15:00 / Save (1.0M) 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0

5 Edit the event.

Submenu Name Function
On/DisabledEnable or disable the selected event.
EditEdits the content of the selected event. Select Save, and then press the [←] button to complete the editing.
ClearDeletes the selected event.
Add NewSaves a new event. Select Save, and then press the [←] button to complete registering.

6 Select Setup complete, and then select Yes to finish editing.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Scheduling Function - 3

text_image Schedule Settings Back to Configuration Setup menu Show Show Event Setup console Set the schedule settings? Yes Cancel

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Scheduling Function - 4

To delete all registered events, select Schedule Reset, and then select Yes. Select Setup complete, and then select Yes to delete the events.

The projector has the following enhanced security functions.

- Password Protection

You can limit who can use the projector.

•Control Panel Lock/Remote Control Button Lock

You can prevent people changing the settings on the projector without permission.

"Restricting Operation" p.117

•Anti-Theft Lock

The projector is equipped with the following anti-theft security device.

"Anti Theft/Fall Prevention" p.119

Managing Users (Password Protection)

When Password Protection is activated, people who do not know the password cannot use the projector to project images even if the projector power is on. Furthermore, the user's logo that is displayed when you turn on the projector cannot be changed. This acts as an anti-theft function as the projector cannot be used even if it is stolen. At the time of purchase, Password Protection is not activated.

Kinds of Password Protection

The following four kinds of Password Protect settings can be made according to how the projector is being used.

•Power On Protection

When Power On Protection is On, you need to enter a preset password after the projector is plugged in and turned on (this also applies to Direct Power On). If the correct password is not entered, projection does not start.

-User's Logo Protection

Even if someone tries to change the User's Logo set by the owner of the projector, it cannot be changed. When User's Logo Protection is set to On, the following setting changes for the User's Logo are prohibited.

•Capturing a User's Logo

- Setting Display Background or Startup Screen from Display

Extended - Display p.146

•Network Protection

When Network Protection is set to On, changing the settings for Network is prohibited.

"Network Menu" p.151

•Schedule Protection

When Schedule Protection is set to On, changing settings for the projector's system time or schedules is prohibited.

Setting Password Protection

Use the following procedure to set Password Protect.

1 During projection, hold down the [Freeze] button for about five seconds.

The Password Protection setting menu is displayed.

Remote control
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Password Protection - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Password Protection - 2

If Password Protection is already activated, you must enter the password.

If the password is entered correctly, the Password Protection setting menu is displayed.

"Entering the password" p.116

2 Select the type of Password Protect you want to set, and then press the 📄 button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Password Protection - 3

text_image [Password Protection] Power On Protection Off User's Logo Protection Off Network Protection Off Schedule Protection Off Password [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

3 Select On, and then press the [←] button.

Press the Esc button to display the screen from step 2.

4 Set the password.

(1) Select Password, and then press the [←] button.
(2) When the message "Change the password?" is displayed, select Yes and then press the [◀] button. The default password is set to "0000". Change this to your own desired password. If you select No, the screen displayed in step 2 is displayed again.
(3) While holding down the [Num] button, enter a four digit number using the numeric buttons. The number entered is displayed as "****". When you enter the fourth digit, the confirmation screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Password Protection - 4

(4) Re-enter the password.

"Password accepted." is displayed.

If you enter the password incorrectly, a message is displayed prompting you to re-enter the password.

Entering the password

When the password entry screen is displayed, enter the password using the remote control.

While holding down the [Num] button, enter the password by pressing the numeric buttons.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Entering the password - 1

text_image [Password] Enter the password. See your documentation for more information. [0-9] :Enter

When you enter the correct password, Password Protect is temporarily released.

Attention

  • If an incorrect password is entered three times in succession, the message "The projector's operation will be locked." is displayed for approximately five minutes, and then the projector switches to standby mode. If this happens, disconnect the power plug from the electrical outlet and then reinsert it and turn the projector's power back on. The projector displays the password entry screen again so that you can enter the correct password.
  • If you have forgotten the password, make a note of the "Request Code: xxxxx" number that appears on the screen and contact the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.

Epson Projector Contact List

  • If you continue to repeat the above operation and input the wrong password thirty times in succession, the following message is displayed and the projector does not accept any more password entries. "The projector's operation will be locked. Contact your nearest Epson service center."
    Epson Projector Contact List

Restricting Operation

The following three kinds of operation restriction functions are available with the projector.

•Control Panel Lock
This is useful at events or shows when you want to deactivate all buttons during projection or at schools when you want to limit button operation.
- Lens Lock

This function deactivates all buttons on the remote control related to the lens operation to prevent improper lens adjustment after it is properly adjusted.

- Remote control button lock

This function deactivates buttons except for main buttons needed for basic remote control operation, to prevent mistakes in operations.

Control Panel Lock

Perform one of the following to lock the operation buttons on the control panel. Even if the control panel is locked, you can still use the remote control as usual.
•Full Lock

All of the buttons on the control panel are locked. You cannot perform any operations from the control panel, including turning the power on or off.

- Partial Lock

All of the buttons on the control panel, except for the button, are locked.

1 Press the ⏻ button on the control panel during projection to display the Control Panel Lock screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Control Panel Lock - 1

You can also make settings in Control Panel Lock from the configuration menu.

Settings - Lock Setting - Control Panel Lock p.143

2 Select either Full Lock or Partial Lock according to your purpose.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Control Panel Lock - 2

text_image [Control Panel Lock] Return Full Lock Partial Lock Off

Esc:Return :Select [●]:Set Menu:Exit

3 Select Yes when the confirmation message is displayed.

The control panel buttons are locked according to the setting you chose.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Control Panel Lock - 3

You can release the control panel lock by one of the following two methods.

- Use the remote control to set Control Panel Lock to Off from the configuration menu.

Settings - Lock Setting - Control Panel Lock p.143

- Press and hold down the ↓ button on the control panel for about seven seconds, a message is displayed and the lock is released.

Lens Lock

This function locks the following buttons on the remote control related to the lens operation.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Lens Lock - 1

Set the Lens Lock to On in the Configuration menu.

Settings - Lock Setting - Lens Lock p.143

Remote control button lock

This function locks the following buttons on the remote control.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Remote control button lock - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Auto"] --> B["Aspect"]
    B --> C["Color Mode"]
    D["Jet Pattern"] --> E["Freeze"]
    E --> F["Split"]
    G["Lens Shift"] --> H["Zoom"]
    H --> I["Focus"]
    J["Menu"] --> K["Instortion"]
    K --> L["Esc /"]
    M["A/V Mate"] --> N["Page"]
    N --> O["Volume"]
    O --> P["I-Zoom"]
    Q["Geometry"] --> R["Memory"]
    S["User1"] --> T["User2"]
    U["1"] --> V["2"]
    W["4"] --> X["5"]
    Y["7"] --> Z["8"]
    AA["ID"] --> AB["0"]
    AC["On Off"] --> AD["Home"]

Each time the ⏻ button is pressed for approximately 5 seconds, the remote control button lock turns on or off.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Remote control button lock - 2

text_image Remote control 4 5 6 7 8 9 ID 0 Num On Off Home

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Remote control button lock - 3

Even if the remote control button lock is on, the following operations are possible.

  • Resetting default for the Remote Receiver setting
    ●Releasing the remote control button lock

Anti Theft/Fall Prevention

The projector is equipped with the following types of anti-theft security devices.

•Security slot

The security slot is compatible with the Microsaver Security System manufactured by Kensington.

See the following for more details on the Microsaver Security System.

http://www.kensington.com/

•Security cable installation point

A commercially available theft-prevention wire lock can be passed through the installation point to secure the projector to a desk or pillar. See the documentation supplied with the wire lock for locking instructions.

You can also attach a safety wire to secure the projector and the ceiling mount to prevent it from falling.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Anti Theft/Fall Prevention - 1

Using the Projector on a Network

Follow the instructions in these sections to set up your projector for use on a network.

Wired Network Projection

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 1

You can send images to your projector through a wired network. To do this, connect the projector to your network, and then set up your projector and computer for network projection.

After connecting and setting up the projector, install Epson iProjection from the EPSON Projector Software CD-ROM (if available) or Web site.

Epson iProjection software sets up your computer for network projection. It also allows you to hold interactive meetings by projecting user's computer screens over a network. See the "Epson iProjection Operation Guide (Windows/Mac)" for instructions.

Selecting Wired Network Settings

Before you can project from computers on your network, you need to select network settings on the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wired Network Settings - 1

Make sure you already connected the projector to your wired network using the LAN port.

"Connecting a LAN Cable" p.52

1 Press the Menu button on the control panel or remote control.
2 Select the Network menu and press [Enter].
3 Select Network Configuration and press [Enter].

4 Select the Basic menu and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wired Network Settings - 2

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Projector Name P.JLink Password Remote Password Web Control Password Moderator Password Projector Keyword Off Display Keyword Off Display LAN Info. Text & QR Co... Return [[sc] /[●]:Return [◆]:Select

5 Select the basic options as necessary.

  • Projector Name: Enter the projector name used to identify the projector over a network. You can enter up to 16 single-byte alphanumeric characters.
  • PJLink Password: Lets you set a password for using the PJLink protocol for projector control. You can enter up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters.
  • Remote Password: Allows you to set an authentication password for using the Remote function in Epson Web Control when setting or controlling the projector. You can enter up to 8 single-byte alphanumeric characters. (The user name is EPSONREMOTE; the default password is guest.)
  • Web Control Password: Allows you to set an authentication password for using Web Control in Epson Web Control when setting or controlling the projector. You can enter up to 8 single-byte alphanumeric characters. (The user name is EPSONWEB; the default password is admin.)

Wired Network Projection

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 1

  • Moderator Password: Allows you to set an authentication password for using Epson iProjection when connecting to the projector as a moderator. Enter four digits for the password. (There is no default password.)
  • Projector Keyword: Lets you turn on a security password to prevent access to the projector by anyone not in the room with it. You must enter a displayed keyword using Epson iProjection to project images and send or receive data.
  • Display Keyword: Lets you display a projector keyword on the projection screen when connecting to the projector using Epson iProjection.
  • Display LAN Info. lets you set the display format for the projector's network information.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 2

Use the displayed keyboard to enter the name, passwords and keyword. Press [▲][▼][▼] buttons on the remote control to highlight characters and press [Enter] to select them.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 3

Select the Wired LAN menu and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 4

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete IP Settings IP Address Display Off IPv6 Settings Return

Assign the IP settings for your network as necessary.

  • If your network assigns addresses automatically, select IP Settings to set the DHCP setting to On.
  • If you must set addresses manually, select IP Settings to set the DHCP setting to Off, and then enter the projector's IP Address, Subnet Mask, and Gateway Address as necessary.
  • If you want to connect the projector to the network using IPv6, select IPv6 Settings.

"Wired LAN menu" p.157

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 5

Press the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons on the remote control, and then select the number you want to enter on the soft keyboard displayed. Press the [Enter] button to confirm.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 6

To prevent the IP address from being displayed on the LAN standby screen and Home screen, set the IP Address Display setting to Off.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 7

If you have finished making settings, select Setup complete. Follow the on-screen instructions to save the settings and close the menu.

Wired Network Projection

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired Network Projection - 1

10 Press the [LAN] button on the remote control.

The wired network settings complete when you see the correct IP address on the LAN standby screen.

[LAN]
Projector Name :
SSID :
IP Address ↓ :
IP Address (q)
Keyword :
Event ID : 

Wireless Network Projection

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wireless Network Projection - 1

You can send images to your projector through a wireless network.

To do this, you must install the Epson 802.11b/g/n wireless LAN module, and then set up your projector and computer for wireless projection.

"Installing the Wireless LAN Unit" p.54

You can connect the projector to your wireless network by configuring the connection manually using the projector's Network menus.

Set the projector's time before configuring the Network menu. If the time is not set, the wireless LAN may not be configured correctly.

"Setting the 'Time' p.44

After installing the wireless LAN module and setting up the projector, install the network software from the EPSON Projector Software CD-ROM (if available) or download the software, as necessary. Use the following software and documentation to set up and control wireless projection:

  • Epson iProjection (Windows/Mac) software allows you to hold interactive meetings by projecting the computer screens of users over a network. See the "Epson iProjection Operation Guide (Windows/Mac)" for instructions.
  • Epson iProjection (iOS/Android) app allows you to project from iOS or Android mobile devices.

You can download Epson iProjection (iOS/Android) for free from App Store or Google Play. Any fees incurred when communicating with the App Store or Google Play are the responsibility of the customer.

- Epson iProjection (Chromebook) allows you to project images from a Chromebook.

You can download Epson iProjection (Chromebook) for free from the Chrome Web Store. Any fees incurred when communicating with the Chrome Web Store are the responsibility of the customer.

Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually

Before you can project from your wireless network, you need to select network settings for the projector.

1 Press the Menu button on the control panel or remote control.
2 Select the Network menu and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually - 1

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Return Wireless Mode Wireless LAN... Net. Info. - Wireless LAN Net. Info. - Wired LAN Display the QR Code Network Configuration Wireless LAN Diagnosis [Esc] / [●]: Return [◆]: Select [Menu]: Exit

3 Set Wireless Mode to Wireless LAN On.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually - 2

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Return Wireless Mode Wireless L... Net. Info. - Wireless LAN Net. Info. - Wired LAN Display the QR Code Network Configuration [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

4 Select Network Configuration and press [Enter].
5 Select the Basic menu and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually - 3

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Projector Name P&Link Password Remote Password Web Control Password Moderator Password Projector Keyword Off Display Keyword Off Display LAN Info. Text & QR Co... Return [Esc] / [O]:Return [◆]:Select

6 Select the basic options as necessary.

  • Projector Name: Enter the projector name used to identify the projector over a network. You can enter up to 16 single-byte alphanumeric characters.
  • PJLink Password: Lets you set a password for using the PJLink protocol for projector control. You can enter up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters.
  • Remote Password: Allows you to set an authentication password for using the Remote function in Epson Web Control when setting or controlling the projector. You can enter up to 8 single-byte alphanumeric characters. (The user name is EPSONREMOTE; the default password is guest.)
  • Web Control Password: Allows you to set an authentication password for using Web Control in Epson Web Control when setting or controlling the projector. You can enter up to 8 single-byte alphanumeric characters. (The user name is EPSONWEB; the default password is admin.)

  • Moderator Password: Allows you to set an authentication password for using Epson iProjection when connecting to the projector as a moderator. Enter four digits for the password. (There is no default password.)

  • Projector Keyword: Lets you turn on a security password to prevent access to the projector by anyone not in the room with it. Turn on "Projector Keyword" when using thumbnail display or the send function between the projector and connected devices.
  • Display Keyword: Lets you display a projector keyword on the projection screen when connecting to the projector using Epson iProjection.
  • Display LAN Info. lets you set the display format for the projector's network information.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually - 4

Use the displayed keyboard to enter the name and password. Press [▲][▼] [▲] buttons on the remote control to highlight characters and press [Enter] to select them.

7 Select the Wireless LAN menu and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually - 5

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wireed LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Connection Mode Quick SSID Security Open Passphrase Channel 1ch SSID Display Off IP Address Display Off IPv6 Settings Return

Esc / : Return : Select

8 Select the Connection Mode setting.

  • Quick lets you connect to multiple smartphones, tablets, or computers directly using wireless communication.
  • Advanced: Lets you connect to a smartphone, tablet, or computer over a wireless LAN access point.

9 If you selected the Advanced connection mode, select Search Access Point to select the access point you want to connect to.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually - 6

If you need to assign the SSID manually, select SSID to enter the SSID.

10 For the Advanced connection mode, assign the IP settings for your network as necessary.

  • If your network assigns addresses automatically, select IP Settings to set the DHCP setting to On.
  • If you must set addresses manually, select IP Settings to set the DHCP setting to Off, and then enter the projector's IP Address, Subnet Mask, and Gateway Address as necessary.
  • If you want to connect the projector to the network using IPv6, select IPv6 Settings.

"Wireless LAN menu" p.154

11 To prevent the SSID or IP address from being displayed on the LAN standby screen and Home screen, set the SSID Display setting or the IP Address Display setting to Off.
12 If you have finished making settings, select Setup complete. Follow the on-screen instructions to save the settings and close the menu.

13 Press the [LAN] button on the remote control.

The wired network settings complete when you see the correct IP address on the LAN standby screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Selecting Wireless Network Settings Manually - 7

text_image [LAN] Projector Name : SSID : IP Address ↓ IP Address (f) Keyword : Event ID :

When you have finished making wireless settings for your projector, you need to select the wireless network on your computer. Then start the network software to send images to your projector through a wireless network.

Selecting Wireless Network Settings in Windows

Before connecting to the projector, select the correct wireless network on your computer.

1 To access your wireless utility software, double-click the network icon on the Windows taskbar.
2 When connecting in Advanced connection mode, select the network name (SSID) of the network the projector is connecting to.
3 Click Connect.

Selecting Wireless Network Settings in Mac

Before connecting to the projector, select the correct wireless network on your computer.

1 Click the AirPort icon on the menu bar at the top of the screen.
2 When connecting in Advanced connection mode, make sure AirPort is turned on and select the network name (SSID) of the network the projector is connecting to.

Setting Up Wireless Network Security

You can set up security for your projector to use on a wireless network. Set up one of the following security options to match the settings used on your network:

•WPA2-PSK security
•WPA2-EAP security *
•WPA/WPA2-PSK security *
•WPA/WPA2-EAP security *
* Only available for the Advanced connection mode.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Up Wireless Network Security - 1

Contact your network administrator for guidance on entering the correct information.

1 If you want to set up the WPA2-EAP or WPA/WPA2-EAP security, make sure your digital certificate file is compatible with projector registration and placed directly on the USB storage device.
"Supported Client and CA Certificates" p.129

2 Press the Menu button on the control panel or remote control.

3 Select the Network menu and press [Enter].

4 Select Network Configuration and press [Enter].

5 Select the Wireless LAN menu and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Up Wireless Network Security - 2

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Return Connection Mode Advanced Search Access Point SSID Security Open Passphrase EAP Method IP Settings SSID Display Off IP Address Display Off IPv6 Settings [Esc] / [●]:Return [◆]:Select

6 Select the Security setting and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Up Wireless Network Security - 3

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Return Connection Mode Advanced Search Access Point SSID Security Open Passphrase EAP Method IP Settings SSID Display Off IP Address Display Off IPv6 Settings [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter

7 Select the security settings to match your network settings.

•WPA2-PSK, WPA/WPA2-PSK:

Select Setup complete. Follow the on-screen instructions to save the settings and close the menu.

•WPA2-EAP, WPA/WPA2-EAP:

Select EAP Method and press [Enter].

8 Select the protocol for authentication as the EAP Type setting.

9 To import your certificate, select the certificate type and press [Enter].

- Client Certificate for the PEAP-TLS or EAP-TLS type

- CA certificate for the PEAP, PEAP-TLS, EAP-TLS, or EAP-FAST type

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Up Wireless Network Security - 4

You can also register the digital certificates from your Web browser. However, be sure to register just once or the certificate may not install correctly.

"Setting a certificate using a Web browser" p.133

10 Select Register and press [Enter].

11 Connect a USB storage device to the projector's USB-A port (the wireless LAN module installation section).

If the wireless LAN module is already installed in the projector, remove it.

"Installing the Wireless LAN Unit" p.54

12 Press [Enter] to display the certificate list.

13 Select the certificate to import using the displayed list. A message is displayed prompting you to enter the password for the certificate.

14 Enter a password and press [Enter].

The certificate is imported and a completion message appears.

15 Select your EAP settings as necessary.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting Up Wireless Network Security - 5

text_image [EAP Method] Return Wireless LAN EAP Type PEAP User name Password Client Certificate Verify Server Cert. Off CA certificate RADIUS Serv.Name [Esc] / [◆]:Return [◆]:Select
  • User Name: Enter the user name. You can enter up to 64 single-byte alphanumeric characters. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text. When importing a client certificate, the name the certificate was issued to is automatically set.
  • Password: Enter the password used for authentication in PEAP, EAP-FAST, and LEAP. You can enter up to 64 single-byte alphanumeric characters. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text.
  • Verify Server Cert. lets you select whether or not to verify the server certificate when a CA certificate has been set.
  • RADIUS Serv.Name lets you enter the server name to be verified.

16 If you have finished making settings, select Setup complete.

Follow the on-screen instructions to save the settings and close the menu.

Supported Client and CA Certificates

You can register these types of digital certificates.

Client Certificate (PEAP-TLS/EAP-TLS)

Item Explanation
FormatPKCS#12
ExtensionPFX, P12
EncryptionRSA
HashesMD5/SHA-1/SHA-256/SHA-384/SHA-512
Key length512/1024/2048/4096 bit
Password *You need to setup a password. Up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters

CA Certificate (PEAP/PEAP-TLS/EAP-TLS/EAP-FAST)

Item Explanation
FormatX509v3
ExtensionDER/CER/PEM
EncryptionRSA
HashesMD5/SHA-1/SHA-256/SHA-384/SHA-512
Key length512/1024/2048/4096 bit
EncodingBASE64/Binary

* You can set a password using up to 64 alphanumeric characters. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text.

"Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215

Using a QR Code to Connect a Mobile Device

After making the wireless network settings for your projector, you can display a QR code on the screen and use it to connect a mobile device using the Epson iProjection (iOS/Android) app.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a QR Code to Connect a Mobile Device - 1

  • Make sure you have installed the latest version of Epson iProjection on your device (Epson iProjection V1.3.0 or later supports this feature).
  • You can download Epson iProjection for free from the App Store or Google Play. Any fees incurred when communicating with the App Store or Google Play are the responsibility of the customer.
  • When using Epson iProjection in Quick connection mode, we recommend making security settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a QR Code to Connect a Mobile Device - 2

Press the [LAN] button on the remote control.

The QR code is displayed on the projected surface.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a QR Code to Connect a Mobile Device - 3

- If you do not see the QR code, set the Display LAN Info. setting to Text & QR Code in the projector's Network menu.

Network - Network Configuration - Display LAN Info. p.153

•To hide the QR code, press the Esc button.
- When the QR code is hidden, press the [Enter] button to display the code.
- You can also display the QR code by selecting the icon on the Home screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a QR Code to Connect a Mobile Device - 4

Start Epson iProjection on your mobile device.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a QR Code to Connect a Mobile Device - 5

Read the projected QR code using Epson iProjection to connect it to the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a QR Code to Connect a Mobile Device - 6

To correctly read the QR code, make sure you face the screen squarely and closely enough so that the projected code fits into the guide of the mobile device's QR code reader. If you are too far from the screen, the code may not be read.

When a connection is established, select Contents menu from , and then select the file you want to project.

Using a USB Key to Connect a Windows Computer

You can set up your USB flash drive as a USB key to quickly connect the projector to a wireless LAN supported Windows computer. The USB key allows you to automatically select a computer's wireless network settings and project your presentation wirelessly.

1 Set up the USB key using Epson iProjection (Windows). See the "Epson iProjection Operation Guide (Windows/Mac)" for instructions.
2 Make sure the wireless LAN module is installed.
3 Turn on the projector.
4 Press the [LAN] button on the remote control. The LAN standby screen is displayed. Verify that an SSID and IP address are displayed.
5 Remove the wireless LAN module from the projector and insert the USB key into the same port used for the wireless LAN module.

"Installing the Wireless LAN Unit" p.54

You see a projected message that the network information update is complete.

6 Remove the USB key.
Reinsert the wireless LAN module into the projector.
7 Connect the USB key to a USB port on your computer.
8 Follow the on-screen instructions to install the necessary application.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a USB Key to Connect a Windows Computer - 1

  • If the Windows Firewall message is displayed, click Yes to disable the firewall.
  • You need administrator authority to install the software.
  • If it is not installed automatically, double-click MPPLaunch.exe in the USB key.

After a few minutes, your computer image is displayed by the projector. If it does not appear, press the [LAN] button on your projector's remote control or restart your computer.

9 Run your presentation.
10 When you have finished projecting wirelessly, select the Safely Remove Hardware option in the Windows taskbar, and then remove the USB key from your computer.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using a USB Key to Connect a Windows Computer - 2

You may need to restart your computer to reactivate your wireless LAN connection.

Secure HTTP

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Secure HTTP - 1

You can use the HTTPS protocol to increase security between the projector and a Web browser communicating with it. To do this, you create a server certificate, install it on the projector, and turn on the Secure HTTP setting in the projector menus to verify the reliability of the Web browser.

Network - Network Configuration - Others - Secure HTTP p.159

Even if you do not install a server certificate, the projector automatically creates a self-signed certificate and allows communication. However, because the self-signed certificate cannot verify reliability from a Web browser, you see a warning about the server's reliability when you access the projector from a Web browser. This warning does not prevent communication.

Importing a Web Server Certificate Using the Menus

You can create your Web server certificate, and import it using the projector menus and a USB flash drive.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Importing a Web Server Certificate Using the Menus - 1

You can also register the digital certificates from your Web browser. However, be sure to register just once or the certificate may not install correctly.

p.133

1 If you want to set up the WPA2-EAP or WPA/WPA2-EAP security, make sure your digital certificate file is compatible with projector registration and placed directly on the USB storage device.
"Supported Web Server Certificates" p.133
2 Press the Menu button on the control panel or remote control.
3 Select the Network menu and press [Enter].
4 Select Network Configuration and press [Enter].

5 Select the Others menu and press [Enter].

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Importing a Web Server Certificate Using the Menus - 2

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Secure HTTP Off Web Server Cert. Priority Gateway Wired LAN AMX Device Discovery Off Crestron Connected Off Message Broadcasting Off Return [Esc] / [◆]: Return [◆]: Select

6 Select On as the Secure HTTP setting.
7 Select Web Server Cert. and press [Enter].
8 Select Register and press [Enter].
9 Connect a USB storage device to the projector's USB-A port (the wireless LAN module installation section).

If the wireless LAN module is already installed in the projector, remove it.

"Installing the Wireless LAN Unit" p.54

10 Press [Enter] to display the certificate list.
11 Select the certificate to import using the displayed list. A message is displayed prompting you to enter the password for the certificate.

12 Enter a password and press [Enter].

The certificate is imported and a completion message appears.

Supported Web Server Certificates

You can register these types of digital certificates.

Web Server Certificate (Secure HTTP)

Item Explanation
FormatPKCS#12
ExtensionPFX, P12
EncryptionRSA
HashesMD5/SHA-1/SHA-256/SHA-384/SHA-512
Key length512/1024/2048/4096 bit
Common NameNetwork IHost Name
OrganizationOptional
Password *You need to setup a password. Up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters

* You can set a password using up to 64 alphanumeric characters. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text.
"Setting a certificate using a Web browser" p.133

Setting a certificate using a Web browser

You can use an electronic certificate as the projector's security settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting a certificate using a Web browser - 1

You can install the electronic certificate from the projector's Network menu. However, be sure to register just once or the certificate may not install correctly.

"Setting Up Wireless Network Security" p.127

1 Prepare a certificate that is supported by the projector.
2 Make sure the projector is turned on.
3 Launch the Web browser on the computer or mobile device connected to the network.
4 Enter the IP address of the projector in the address input box of the browser to connect to the Epson Web Control screen. The Epson Web Control screen is displayed.
5 Select Advanced.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting a certificate using a Web browser - 2

You need to login to display the Advanced screen. When the login screen is displayed, enter your user name and password. (The user name is EPSONWEB; the default password is admin.)

6 Select Certificate from Network.
7 Click the Choose File button, select the certificate file.
8 Enter the password in the Password box, and then click Send.
9 When the settings are complete, click the Apply.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setting a certificate using a Web browser - 3

Configuration Menu

This chapter explains how to use the Configuration menu and its functions.

Configuration Menu Operations

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Configuration Menu Operations - 1

This section explains how to use the Configuration menu.

Although steps are explained using the remote control as an example, you can perform the same operations from the control panel. Check the guide under the menu for the available buttons and their operations.

1 Display the Configuration menu screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Display the Configuration menu screen. - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Display the Configuration menu screen. - 2

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Color Mode Photo Brightness 0 Contrast 0 Color Saturation 0 Tint 0 Sharpness White Balance Image Enhancement Advanced Light Source Control Off Reset Return

Esc / [●]: Return [●]: Select Menu: Exit

2 Select a top menu item.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select a top menu item. - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select a top menu item. - 2

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Geometry Correction H/V Keystone Spot Screen Volume 0 HDMI Link Lock Setting Brightness Settings Remote Receiver Front/Rear User-Button Test Pattern Memory Content Playback Reset Return

Esc / [●]: Return : Select Menu: Exit

3 Select a submenu item.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select a submenu item. - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select a submenu item. - 2

text_image Geometry Correction H/V-Keystone Split Screen Volume 0 HDMI Link Lock Setting Brightness Settings Front/Rear Remote Receiver User Button Test Pattern Memory Content Playback Reset [Esc]:Return Select Enter [Menu]:Exit

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select a submenu item. - 3

4 Change settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Change settings. - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Change settings. - 2

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Change settings. - 3

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Change settings. - 4

text_image [Control Panel Lock] Return (Full Lock) (Partial Lock) Off [Esc]:Return [◆]:Select [O]:Set [Menu]:Exit

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Change settings. - 5

When "[Default]: Reset" is displayed on the guide under the menu, pressing the [Default] button on the remote control returns the settings being adjusted to their default values.

5 Press the [Menu] button to finish making settings.

Configuration Menu Table

Settable items vary depending on the model being used and the image signal and source being projected.

Top Menu Name Submenu Name Items or Setting Values
Image menup.140Color Mode Dynamic, Presentation, Natural,Cinema, B'1.709, DICOM SIM,Multi-Projection
Brightness 0 to 100
Contrast 0 to 100
Color Saturation 0 to 100
Tint 0 to 100
Sharpness Standard, Thin Line Enhancement,Thick Line Enhancement
White Balance Color Temp., G-M Correction,Offset R, Offset G, Offset B, Gain R,Gain G, Gain B
Image Enhancement 4K Enhancement, Image PresetMode, Frame Interpolation,Deinterlacing, Noise Reduction,MPEG Noise Reduction, Super-resolution, Detail Enhancement,Reset
Advanced Gamma, RGB CMY
Light Source Control Light Source Control, DynamicContrast, Lights-Out Control
Signal menup.142Resolution Auto, Wide, Normal, and Manual
Aspect Auto, Normal, 4:3, 16:9, Full, H-Zoom, V-Zoom, Native
Tracking -
Sync. 0 to 31
Top Menu Name Submenu Name Items or Setting Values
Position-128 to 127
Auto SetupOn, Off
OverscanAuto, Off, 4%, and 8%
BlankingTop, Bottom, Left, and Right
Advanced Video Range, Input Signal, BNC Sync Termination, EDID, DDC Buffer
ScaleScale, Scale Mode, Scale Vertically, Scale Horizontally, Clip Adjustment, Clip Range
Settings menup.143Geometry CorrectionOff, H/V-Keystone, Quick Corner, Curved Surface, Corner Wall, Point Correction, Memory
Split Screen-
Volume0 to 20
HDMI LinkDevice Connections, HDMI Link, Audio Out Device, Power On Link, Power Off Link, Link Buffer
Lock SettingControl Panel Lock, Lens Lock
Brightness SettingsLight Source Modc, Brightness Level, Constant Brightness, Estimated Remains
Remote ReceiverFront/Rear, Front, Rear, and Off
User Button User Button1, User Button 2, and User Button 3
Test Pattern Standard, Cross-hatching, Cross-hatching R, Cross-hatching G, Cross-hatching B, Color Bars V, Color Bars H, Grayscale, Gray Bars V, Gray Bars H, Checkerboard 1, Checkerboard 2, White, Black, Aspect Frame
Memory Memory, Lens Position, Geometry Correction
Content Playback Content Playback, Overlay Effect, USB Viewer
Extended menu p.146Home Screen Home Screen Auto Disp., Custom Function 1, Custom Function 2
Display Menu Position, Message Position, Messages, Display Background, Startup Screen, Standby Confirmation, Air Filter Notice, Screen, Panel Alignment, Color Uniformity, OSD Rotation
User's Logo Start Setting, Reset
Projection Front, Front/Ceiling, Rear, and Rear/Ceiling
Operation Direct Power On, Sleep Mode, Sleep Mode Timer, High Altitude Mode, Auto Source Search, Auto Power On, Startup Source, A/V Mute Settings, Advanced, Date & Time, Lens Calibration
A/V Settings A/V Output, Monitor Out, and Audio Settings
Standby Mode Communication On and Communication Off
HDBaseT Control Communications, Extron XTP
Multi-Projection Projector ID, Tiling, Geometry Correction, Edge Blending, Black Level, Scale, Color Mode, Brightness Settings, Color Matching, Color Uniformity, Reset
Schedule Settings -
Top Menu Name Submenu Name Items or Setting Values
Language27 languages
Info menu p.161Projector InfoTotal Op. Time, Operation Hours, Source, Input Signal, Resolution, Refresh Rate, Sync Info, Status, Serial Number, Lens Type, Event ID, HDBaseT Signal Level
Light Source Info Light Source Hours, Estimated Remains
VersionMain, Video2, Sub, Sub2, HDMI, IIDBaseT, IIDBaseT2
Status InformationStatus Information, Source, Signal Information, Network Wired, Network Wireless, Maintenance, Version
Temp Warning Info-
Power On/Off History-
Reset menu p.162Reset All Memories-
Refresh ModeTimer, Messages, Start
Light Source CalibrationRun Now, Run Periodically, Schedule Settings, Last Run
Reset All Config-
Reset All (Factory Default)Reset All (Factory Default), Password

Network menu

Top Menu NameSubmenu NameItems or Setting Values
Basic menu p.153Projector Name-
PJLink Password-
Remote Password-
Top Menu Name Sub menu Name Items or Setting Values
Web Control Password -
Moderator Password -
Projector Keyword On, Off
Display Keyword On, Off
Display LAN Info. Text & QR Code, Text
Wireless LAN menu p.154Connection Mode Quick, Advanced
Search Access Point -
SSID -
Security Open, WPA2-PSK, WPA/WPA2-PSK, WPA2-EAP, WPA/WPA2-EAP
Passphrase -
EAP Method EAP Type, User name, Password, Client Certificate, Verify Server Cert., CA certificate, RADIUS Serv.Name
Channel 1ch, 6ch, and 11ch
IP SettingsDHCP, IP Address, Subnet Mask, Gateway Address
SSID DisplayOn, Off
IP Address DisplayOn, Off
IPv6 Settings IPv6, Auto Configuration, Use Temporary Address
Wired LAN menu p.157IP SettingsDHCP, IP Address, Subnet Mask, Gateway Address
IP Address DisplayOn, Off
Top Menu NameSubmenu NameItems or Setting Values
IPv6 Settings IPv6, Auto Configuration, Use Temporary Address
Notifications menu p.159Mail NotificationOn, Off
SMTP Server-
Port Number-
From-
Address 1 Setting, Address 2 Setting, Address 3 SettingEmail Address, No Signal, System Error, Laser Error, High Temp Error, Air Filter Error, Laser Warning, High Temp Warning, Air Filter Warning, Air Filter Notice, Constant Bright. End
SNMPOn, Off
Trap IP Address 1, Trap IP Address 2-
Community Name-
PJLink NotificationOn, Off
Notified IP Address-
Others menu p.159Secure HTTPOn, Off
Web Server Cert.-
Priority GatewayWired LAN, Wireless LAN
AMX Device DiscoveryOn, Off
Crestron ConnectedOn, Off
Message BroadcastingOn, Off

Image Menu

Settable items vary depending on the image signal and source currently being projected. Setting details are saved for each color mode.

"Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search)" p.61

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Image Menu - 1

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Color Mode Photo Brightness 0 Contrast 0 Color Saturation 0 Tint 0 Sharpness White Balance Image Enhancement Advanced Light Source Control Off Reset [Esc] / [◆]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit
Submenu Function
Color ModeYou can select the quality of the image to suit your surroundings. "Selecting the Projection Quality (Selecting Color Mode)" p.76
BrightnessAdjusts the image brightness.
ContrastAdjusts the difference between light and shade in the images.
Color SaturationAdjusts the color saturation for the images.
TintYou can adjust the image tint.
Submenu Function
SharpnessStandard: You can adjust the image sharpness. Thin Line Enhancement: If this parameter is set to a positive value, details such as hair or fabric patterns will be enhanced. Thick Line Enhancement: If this parameter is set to a positive value, the outline, background, and the other main parts of the objects in the image will be enhanced to show them clearly.
White BalanceYou can adjust the overall tint of the image. Color Temp.: You can adjust the overall tint of the image within a range from 3200K to 10000K. The image is tinted blue when a high value is selected and tinted red who low value is selected. When Color Mode is set to Dynamic, the set Color Temp. may differ from the actual Color Temp. of the light from the projector. Use this menu as a guide G-M Correction: The color tone is tinted red when set to a negative value, and tinted green when set to a positive value. Offset R/G/B, Gain R/G/B: You can adjust the offset and gain of each color R (red), G (green), and B (blue) individually.
Submenu Function
Image EnhancementYou can adjust the image resolution.◆ "Adjusting Image Resolution (Image Enhancement)" p.834K Enhancement*: (FB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/FB-L1065U/FB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only) You can project at a doubled resolution.Image Preset Mode: You can select the optimal setting according to the projected image from five presets prepared in advance.Frame Interpolation: You can play fast moving images smoothly by producing intermediate frames between the original frames.Deinterlacing: (Only when the input signal is 480i, 576i, or 1080i) You can convert interlace signals into progressive signals. (IP conversion)Off is ideal for images with a large amount of movementVideo for general video images, and Film/Auto for movie films, computer graphics, and animation.Noise Reduction: You can smooth out the roughness in progressive images.MPEG Noise Reduction: You can reduce dot and block noise that occurs in outlines when projecting MPEG movies.Super-resolution: To display a crisp image, you can reduce the blurring that is created on the edge when the resolution of the image signal is scaled up and projected.Detail Enhancement: You can enhance the contrast of details in an image.Reset: Returns the selected preset to its defaults.
AdvancedYou can make adjustments by choosing the following items.Gamma: You can adjust the coloring by selecting one of the gamma correction values, or referring to the projected graph.RGBCMY: You can adjust the hue, saturation, and brightness of each color R (red), G (green), B (blue), C (cyan), M (magenta), Y (yellow) individually.
Submenu Function
Light Source ControlLight Source Control: Select the light source operations according to the image signal.➤ "Setting the Amount of Light of the Projected Image p.79Dynamic Contrast: (This can only be set if Light Source Control is set to Dynamic Contrast) Automatically adjusts the amount of light when projecting according to the brightness of the image.Lights-Out Control: (This can only be set if Light Source Control is set to Lights-Out Control) Automatically turns off the light after the set time has elapsed at the specified video level.
ResetYou can reset all adjustment values for the Image menu to their default settings. See the following to return all menu items to their default settings.➤ "Reset Menu" p.162

* This cannot be set when Aspect is set to Native.

Signal Menu

Settable items vary depending on the image signal and source currently being projected. Setting details are saved for each image signal.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Signal Menu - 1

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Resolution Auto Aspect 4:3 Tracking 0 Sync. 0 Position Auto Setup Off Blanking Advanced Scale Reset [Esc] / [●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit
Submenu Function
Resolution(Only available when an analog RGB computer signal is being input.)Set toAutoto automatically identify the resolution of the input signal. If images are not projected correctly when set toAuto, for example if some of the image is missing, set toWidefor wide screens, or set toNormalfor 4:3 or 5:4 screens depending on the connected computer.Manual allows you to specify theresolution. This is ideal when connected computer is fixed.
AspectYou can set the Aspect Ratio for projected images."Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image" p.80
Tracking(Only available when an analog RGB computer signal is being input.)You can adjust computer images when vertical stripes appear in the images.
Submenu Function
Sync.(Only available when an analog RGB computer signal is being input.)You can adjust computer images when flickering, fuzziness, or interference appear in the images.
PositionYou can adjust the display position up, down, left, and right when a part of the image is missing so that the whole image is projected.
Auto Setup(Only available when an analog RGB computer signal is being input.)Set to On to automatically adjust Tracking, Sync., and Position to the optimum state when the input signal changes.
OverscanChanges the output image ratio (the range of the projected image). You can set the cropping range to 4% or 8%. When set to Auto, this is automatically adjusted according to the input signal.
BlankingYou can hide images in the set area. Use the [◀]▶buttons to adjust the area. You can adjust by using a combination of Top, Bottom, Left, and Right. You can hide up to half of the projected image in each direction (except for one pixel).
AdvancedYou can set by choosing the following items.Video Range: Select the video range for the input signal from the HDMI port, DVI-D port, or HDBaseT port. If the brightness range is 16 to 235, select Limited (16-235), if it is 0 to 255, select Full (0-255).Input Signal: Select an input signal from the Computer port or BNC port. If set to Auto, the input signal is set automatically according to the connected equipment. If colors do not appear correctly when set to Auto, select the appropriate signal according to the connected equipment.BNC Sync Termination: Set the end process for signals from the BNC In port. This should usually be set to Off. Set to On when analog (75Ω) termination such as for switchers is necessary.EDID: (Displayed when the current source is HDMI, HDBaseT, or DVI-D) Make settings related to EDID. Even in setups with multiple displays with different resolutions, you can switch the EDID of the current source and unify the EDID across the displays by setting the same EDID as the standard display.Preset EDID: Select the optimal setting from the presets prepared in advance. Change the preset sub menu settings for Resolution, Refresh Rate, and Color Depth if necessary. Select Settings, and then press the [←] button.Resolution: Select from the resolutions displayed.Refresh Rate: Select from the refresh rates displayed.Color Depth: Select the maximum color depth limit supported by the projector. When you select 12bit, the projected images support signals up to 12 bits.Reset: You can reset all adjustment values for EDID to their default values.DDC Buffer: (Displayed when the current source is HDMI or DVI-D) Setting this to On can sometimes improve images that are not displayed correctly from devices connected using an HDMI or DVI extension cable.
ScaleWhen using multiple projectors to project one image, adjust the range of the image displayed by each projector."Displaying a Scaled Image" p.97
Submenu Function
ResetYou can reset all adjustment values on the Signal menu to their default settings, except for Input Signal and EDID.See the following to return all menu items to their default settings."Reset Menu" p.162

Settings Menu

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Settings Menu - 1

text_image Image Signal Settings Geometry Correction H/V-Keystone Spit Screen Volume 0 HDMI Link Lock Setting Brightness Settings Remote Receiver Front/Rear User Button Test Pattern Memory Content Playback Reset

Esc / [●]: Return : Select Menu: Exit

Submenu Function
Geometry CorrectionYou can correct distortion.➤ "Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image" p.64➤Off:Temporarily cancels the geometry correction.➤H/V-Keystone:Adjust V-Keystone, V-Balance, H-Keystone, and H-Balance to correct vertical and horizontal keystone distortion.➤Quick Corner:Select and correct the four corners of the projected image.➤Curved Surface:Corrects distortion that occurs when projecting on a curved surface.➤Corner Wall:Corrects distortion that occurs when projecting on a surface with right angles.➤Point Correction:Divides the projected image into a grid and corrects the distortion by moving the selected point of intersection from side to side and up and down.➤Memory:You can save the adjustment value of the geometry correction and load it when needed.➤ "Memory Function" p.110
Split ScreenYou can split the screen into two screens.➤ "Projecting Two Images Simultaneously (Split Screen)" p.99
VolumeYou can adjust the volume. Setting values are saved for each source.
Submenu Function
HDMI LinkSets HDMI Link.Device Connections:Displays a list of the devices connected to the HDMI port.HDMI LinkEnables or disables HDMI Link.Audio Out Device:When the projector is connected to an AV amplifier, select whether to output audio from the external speakers connected to the projector or to output audio from the AV amplifier's speakers.Power On Link:Set the operation to perform when turning on the projector or a connected device.Bidirectional:Turns on the connected device when the projector is turned on, or turns on the projector when the connected device is turned on-connected Device→PJ:Turns on the projector when the connected device is turned on.PJ→Connected Device:Turns on the connected device when the projector is turned on.Power Off Link:Set whether or not to turn off the connected device when the projector is turned off.Link Buffer:If HDMI Link is not working properly, changing this setting may improve linking operations.
Lock SettingControl Panel Lock:You can use this to restrict operation of the projector's control panel."Control Panel Lock" p.117Lens Lock:When set to On,[Lens Shift],[Zoom], and [Focus] button operations on the remote control are disabled."Lens Lock" p.118
Submenu FunctionSubmenu Function
Brightness Set- tingsLight Source Mode: Set the brightness for the light source.Normal: Select this if you do not want to decrease the brightness. This makes the light source operation time approximately 20,000 hours.Medium: Noise from the fan is louder than when Quiet is selected, but it does not decrease the brightness as much. This sets the brightness at 85%. This makes the light source operation time approximately 20,000 hours.Quiet: Select this if you are concerned about the noise made by the fan. This sets the brightness at 70%. This makes the light source operation time approximately 20,000 hours.Extended: Select this to extend the life expectancy of the light source. This sets the brightness at 70%. This makes the light source operation time approximately 30,000 hours.Custom: Select this to set the brightness level within a range of 30 to 100%.Brightness Level: (Only available when Light Source Mode is set to Custom) Sets the brightness for the light source. Constant Brightness: (Only available when Light Source Mode is set to Custom) When set to On, the brightness of the light source set in Brightness Levld is maintained as it is. When Constant Brightness is set to On, you cannot change the settings for Light Source Mode and Brightness Level."Setting the Brightness" p.77Estimated Remains: When Constant Brightness is set to On, this indicates the amount of time for which constant brightness can be maintained."Guide to Estimated Remains" p.78Remote ReceiverYou can limit the reception of the operation signal from the remote control.When set to Off, you cannot perform any operations from the remote control. If you want to make operations from the remote control, hold down the [Menu] button on the remote control for at least 15 seconds to reset the setting to its default value.
User ButtonSelect the items in the Configuration menu that you want to assign to the [User1], [User2], and [User3] buttons on the remote control. The following items can be assigned.Light Source Mode, Multi-Projection, Resolution, On-Screen Display, Display the QR Code, Image Enhancement, Frame Interpolation, Link Menu, Content Playback, USB(USB is only enabled when Content Playback is set to On.)
Test PatternYou can display a test pattern to adjust the projection without connecting other equipment when you set up the projector."Displaying the Test Pattern" p.33
MemoryPerform operations and make settings for the memory function."Memory Function" p.110
Content Play-backContent Playback: When this is set to On, you can play playlists created in Epson Projector Content Manager. Overlay Effect: Adds color and shape decorations to the image. (This is only enabled when Content Playback is set to On.)USB Viewer: Plays playlists stored on a USB flash device. (This is only enabled when Content Playback is set to On.)
Submenu Function
ResetYou can reset all adjustment values on the Settings menu to their default settings, except for Audio Out Device, Power On Link, Power Off Link, Link Buffer, User Button, Memory, Content Playback.See the following to return all menu items to their default settings."Reset Menu" p.162

* This cannot be set when Edge Blending is set to On

Extended Menu
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Settings Menu - 2

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Home Screen Display User's Logo Projection Front Operation A/V Settings Standby Mode Communication Off HDBaseT Multi-Projection Schedule Settings Language English Reset Return [Esc] / [◆]: Return [◆]: Select [Menu]: Exit
Submenu Function
Home ScreenHome Screen Auto Disp.: When set to On, the Home screen is displayed when the projector turns on. The Home screen is not displayed when the selected source has an image signal when the projector turns on.Custom Function 1, Custom Function 2: Select functions to be assigned to the Home screen from the following five functions. Network Settings, Info, Image Enhancement, Frame Interpolation, Split Screen
DisplayYou can make settings related to the projector's display.Menu Position: Select the position to display the menu on the projected screen.Message Position: Select the position to display the message on the projected screen.Messages: When set to Off, the following items will not be displayed.Item names when the Source, Color Mode, or Aspect is changed, messages when no signal is being input, and warnings such as High Temp Warning.Display Background: You can set the screen background to Black, Blue, or Logo when no image signal is available.Startup Screen*: Set to On to display the User's Logo when you start projecting.Standby Confirmation: If it is set to Off, you can turn off the power simply by pressing the [O] button once.Air Filter Notice: You can set whether or not (On/Off) to enable Air Filter Notice. When this is set to On and a clog in the air filter is detected, the message is displayed on the screen.Screen: (This is unavailable when projecting images from a computer over a network.) Set the aspect ratio and position of the projected screen according to the screen being used."Screen Settings" p.32Panel Alignment: Corrects color misalignments (red and blue) in the screen."Panel Alignment" p.210Color Uniformity: Adjusts the color tone balance for the whole screen."Color Uniformity" p.212OSD Rotation: Rotates the menu direction by 90° degrees.
User's Logo *You can change the user's logo that is displayed as a background during Display Background, A/V Mute, and so on."Saving a User's Logo" p.104
Submenu Function
ProjectionSelect from one of the following projection methods depending on how the projector is installed.Front, Front/Ceiling, Rear, Rear/CeilingYou can change the setting as follows by pressing down the [A/V Mute] button for about five seconds.Front ↔ Front/CeilingRear ↔ Rear/Ceiling

Submenu Function

OperationDirect Power On: Set to On to turn on the projector simply by plugging it in.When the power cord is plugged in, note that the projector turns on automatically in cases such as a power outage being restored.Sleep Mode: When set to On, this automatically stops projection when no image signal is being input and no operations are carried out.Sleep Mode Timer: When Sleep Mode is set to On, you can set the time before the projector automatically turns off within a range of 1 to 30 minutes.High Altitude Modc: Set this to On if you are using the projector above an altitude of 1,500 meters.Auto Source Search: Set to On to automatically detect an image signal from another source and project the image when there is no image signal from the current source.Auto Power On: If it is set to Computer or BNC, the projector is turned on when the signals are received from the Computer port or BNC port, even when the projector is in standby status.Startup Source: Select the source you want to project when the projector is turned on in Content Playback mode.A/V Mute Settings: Perform settings related to A/V mute.Fadc-in: Specify the number of seconds for fade-in when displaying an image.Fade-out: Specify the number of seconds for fade-out when hiding an image.A/V Mute Timer: When it is set to On, if no operations are performed for about 2 hours after A/V mute is activated, the projector turns off automatically.A/V Mute Release: When it is set to A/V Mute, you can release A/V mute only by pressing the [A/V Mute] button (or by sending an A/V mute Off command).When set to Any Button, A/V mute is released when any operation is performed on the projector.

Submenu Function

◆ "Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mutc)" p.102Advanced: The following items can be set.● Beep: When this is set to On, the confirmation buzzer beeps to notify you that the power turns on or off, cooling down is finished.● Indicators: When set to Off, the projector's indicators are turned off, except for abnormality or warning.● Log Save Destination: Set where you want to save the operation logs for the projector. Select USB and Internal Memory to save the logs to the USB flash drive connected to the projector's USB-A port. Logs are saved as text files (.log) on the USB flash drive.The following logs are saved.- Error information- Laser information- Temperature logs- Operation logs● Batch Setup Range: Select All to copy all of the menu settings using the batch setting function. Select Limited if you do not want to copy the following settings.- EDID from the Signal menu- Network menu● Lens Type: When using the following lens, select the model number of the lens.ELPLS04, ELPLU02, ELPLR04, ELPLW04, ELPLM06, ELPLM07, ELPLL07Date & Time: Make system time settings for the projector.◆ "Setting the Time" p.44Lens Calibration: Acquires the information of the lens installed on the projector.
Submenu Function
A/V SettingsA/V Output: Set this to Always On if you want to output audio and images to an external device even when the projector is in standby status.Monitor Out: Select the image source output to an external monitor when the projector is in standby status. When set to Auto, analog RGB signals from the Computer port or the BNC port are output depending on which source was selected when the projector was turned off.Audio Settings: Performs the following audio related settings.·Audio Output: Select the audio to be output when projecting images from the Computer port, BNC port, or DVI-D port. When set to Auto, audio is output from the audio input port corresponding to each image input port. "Connecting Equipment" p.47·HDMI Audio Output: Select the audio source when projecting images from the HDMI port. If you select HDMI, audio for the image is output as it is. If you select Audio3, audio is output from the Audio3 port.
Standby ModeIf you set Communication On, you can perform the following operations even if the projector is in standby mode.·Monitor and control the projector over a network.·Output audio and images to an external device. (Only when A/V Output is set to Always On.)·Communication from the HDBaseT port is enabled. (Only when Control Communications is set to On.)When monitoring or controlling the projector using wireless LAN, set Connection Mode to Advanced.Network - Wireless LAN - Connection Mode p.154
Submenu Function
HDBaseTControl Communications: (This cannot be set when Extron XTP is set to On.) When set to On, Ethernet communication, serial communication, and the wired remote control through the HDBaseT Transmitter connected to the HDBaseT port are all enabled.Extron XTP: Set to On when you connect the Extron XTP transmitter or switcher to the HDBaseT port. See the following Extron Web site for more details on the XTT system.http://www.extron.com/EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Settings Menu - 3 ·When Control Communications or Ex-tron XTP is set to On, Standby Mode is automatically set to Communication On, ·When Control Communications or Ex-tron XTP is On, the projector's LAN port, RS-232 port, and Remote port are disabled. ·When Extron XTP is set to On, the fan may rotate in standby mode but this is not abnormal.
Submenu Function
Multi-ProjectionMake settings when projecting from multiple projectors. "Multi-Projection Function" p.90Projector ID: Set the ID from 01 to 30. Off indicates that no ID is set. "ID Settings" p.42Tiling: Set the number of split screens and positions of each projected image. "Tiling" p.90Geometry Correction: Corrects distortion in the projected image. "Correcting Distortion in the Projected Image" p.61Edge Blending: Corrects a border between multiple images to create a seamless screen. "Edge Blending" p.91Black Level: Adjusts the differences in brightness and tone for areas where images overlap and areas where the images do not overlap. "Black Level" p.93Scale: When using multiple projectors to project one image, adjust the range of the image displayed by each projector. "Displaying a Scaled Image" p.97Color Mode: Select the appropriate color mode according to the type of image and the surroundings. Select the same color mode for all projectors.Brightness Settings: Set the brightness for the light source. "Setting the Brightness" p.77Color Matching: Corrects the differences in the tint and brightness between images. "Color Matching" p.96Color Uniformity: Adjusts the color tone balance for the whole screen. "Color Uniformity" p.212Reset: You can reset all adjustment values for the Multi-Projection menu to their default settings.
Submenu Function
Schedule SettingsYou can set the projector's schedule so that it perform specific operation at a pre-scheduled time. "Scheduling Function" p.112
LanguageYou can set the language for messages and menus.
ResetYou can reset all adjustment values for the Extended menu to their default settings. However, the following items not reset.Screen Type, Screen Position, Panel Alignment, Color Uniformity, Projection, High Altitude Mode, Auto Source Search, A/V Mutc Release, Lens Type, Date & Time, Lens Calibration, A/V Output, Monitor Out, Standby Mode, Control Communications, Extron XTP, Projector ID, Tiling, Edge Blending, Black Level, Scale, Color Modc, Brightness Settings, Color Matching, LanguageSee the following to return all menu items to their defa settings."Reset Menu" p.162

* When User's Logo Protection is set to On in Password Protection, you cannot change settings related to user's logo. You can make changes after setting User's Logo Protection to Off.

"Managing Users (Password Protection)" p.115

Network Menu

When Network Protection is set to On in Password Protection, a message is displayed and the network settings cannot be changed. Set Network Protection to Off and then configure the network.

"Setting Password Protection" p.115

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Network Menu - 1

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Wireless Mode Net. Info. - Wireless LAN Net. Info. - Wired LAN Display the QR Code Network Configuration Return Wireless L... [Esc] / [◆]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit
Submenu Function
Wireless ModeSet this to Wireless LAN On when connecting the projector and a computer via a wireless LAN. If you do not want to connect via wireless LAN, turn it Off to prevent unauthorized access by others.
Submenu Function
Net. Info. - Wireless LANDisplays the following network setting status information.•Connection Mode•Wireless LAN system•Antenna Level•Projector Name•SSID•DHCP•IP Address•Subnet Mask•Gateway Address•MAC Address•Region CodeWhen IPv6 is selected, the following information is displayed.•IPv6 Address (Manual):IPv6 Address, Prefix Length, Gateway Address•IPv6 Address (Auto):Temporary Address, Link-local Address, Stateless Address, Stateful Address
Net. Info. - Wired LANDisplays the following network setting status information.•Projector Name•DHCP•IP Address•Subnet Mask•Gateway Address•MAC Address•IPv6 Address (Manual):IPv6 Address, Prefix Length, Gateway Address•IPv6 Address (Auto):Temporary Address, Link-local Address, Stateless Address, Stateful Address
Display the QR CodeWhen connecting iOS or Android devices using Epson iProjection, read the QR code displayed.

Network Configuration

The following menus are available for setting Network items. Basic, Wireless LAN, Wired LAN, Notifications, Others, Reset

Notes on operating the Network menu

Selecting from the top menu and sub menus, and changing selected items is the same as making operations from the Configuration menu.

When done, make sure you go to the Complete menu, and select Yes, No, or Cancel. When you select Yes or No, you are returned to the Configuration menu.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Notes on operating the Network menu - 1

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete 5 Save network settings. Select Enter

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Notes on operating the Network menu - 2

Yes: Saves the settings and exits the Network menu.

No: Does not save the settings and exits the Network menu.

Cancel: Continues displaying the Network menu.

Soft keyboard operations

The Network menu contains items that require input of alphanumeric during setup. In this case, the following software keyboard is displayed. Use [▲]||▼||▼ buttons to move the cursor to the desired key, and then press the [▼] button to enter the selected character. Enter figures by holding down the [Num] button on the remote control, and pressing the

numeric buttons. After inputting, press Finish on the keyboard to confirm your input. Press Cancel on the keyboard to cancel your input.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Soft keyboard operations - 1

text_image [SSID] 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 ! " # S A B C D E F G H I 2 & K I M N O P Q R S 0 + CAPS T U V W X Y Z / . SYN2 Backsp Del ← Space AllDel Cancel Finish

• Each time the CAPS key is selected and the [◀] button is pressed, it sets and changes between upper case and lower case letters.
• Each time the SYM1/2 key is selected and the [◀] button is pressed, it sets and changes the symbol keys for the section enclosed by the frame.

The following types of character can be entered.

Numbers0123456789
LettersABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
Symbols!" # $ % & ' () * +, - / ;; <= > ? @ [ \ ] ^ _ ' { | } -

Basic menu

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Basic menu - 1

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Projector Name PJLink Password Remote Password Web Control Password Moderator Password Projector Keyword Off Display Keyword Off Display LAN Info. Text & QR Co... [Esc] /[●]:Return [◆]:Select
Submenu Function
Projector NameEnter the projector name used to identify the projector over a network.When editing, you can enter up to 16 single-byte alphanumeric characters. (" * + , / : ; <= > ? [ \ ] ' | and spaces cannot be used.)
PJLink PasswordSet a password to use when you access the projector using compatible PJLink software.You can enter up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters.(Spaces and symbols cannot be used.)● "About PJLink" p.227
Remote Pass-wordSet a password to use Remote in Epson Web Control. You can enter up to 8 single-byte alphanumeric characters. (*: and spaces cannot be used.) The default user name is "EPSONREMOTE" and the default password is "guest".● "Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215
Submenu Function
Web Control PasswordSet a password for authentication to use when making settings and controlling the projector using Web Control in Epson Web Control. You can enter up to eight single-byte alphanumeric characters (* : and spaces cannot be used). The default user name is "EPSONWEB" and the default password is "admin". ➕ "Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215
Moderator Pass-wordEnter the four digit authentication password for using Epson iProjection when connecting to the projector as a moderator. (There is no default password.)
Projector Key-wordSet this to On to enable a security password to prevent other users from accidentally projecting images. When projecting images from a computer or mobile device, you need to enter the keyword displayed on the projection screen in Epson iProjection.
Display KeywordWhen this is set to On and when connecting to the projector using Epson iProjection, the projector keyword is displayed on the projection screen. This is only enabled when Projector Keyword is set to On.
Display LAN Info.Set the display format for the projector's network information. If you display the QR code, you can connect to a network just by reading the QR code in Epson iProjection. Text & QR Code is set by default.

Wireless LAN menu

To connect the projector to a computer using a wireless LAN, install the Wireless LAN unit (ELPAP10).

"Installing the Wireless LAN Unit" p.54

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wireless LAN menu - 1

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Connection Mode Advanced Search Access Point SSID Security Open Passphrase EAP Method IP Settings SSID Display Off IP Address Display Off IPv6 Settings Return [Esc] / [●]: Return [◆]: Select
Submenu Function
Connection ModeSet the connection mode to use when connecting the projector and a computer via a wireless LAN.Quick:Lets you directly connect to a smartphone, tablet, or computer via a wireless LAN.Advanced:Lets you connect to a smartphone, tablet, or computer over a wireless LAN access point. The connection is established in infrastructure mode.
Search Access PointWhen Connection Mode is set toAdvanced,you can search for surrounding access points, and set the SSID to be connected from those access points. Depending on the access point settings, they may not be displayed in the list."Search Access Point screen"p.156
Submenu Function
SSIDEnter an SSID. When an SSID is provided for the wireless LAN system in which the projector participates, enter the SSID.You can enter up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters.
SecuritySelect the security type according to the wireless LAN settings.Open: Security is not set.WPA2-PSK: Communication is performed using WPA2 security. Uses AES method for encryption. When establishing a connection from a computer to the projector enter the value set in the passphrase.WPA/WPA2-PSK*: Connects in WPA personal mode.Encryption method is selected automatically according to the access point settings. Set a passphrase which is the same for the access point.WPA2-EAP*: Communication is performed using WPA2 security. Uses AES method for encryption.WPA/WPA2-EAP*: Connects in WPA enterprise mode.Encryption method is selected automatically according to the access point settings.
PassphraseEnter a passphrase used to connect to the network when Security is set to WPA2-PSK or WPA/WPA2-PSK.You can enter at least 8 and up to 63 single-byte alphanumeric characters.You can enter up to 32 characters on the Configuration menu. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text."Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215When Connection Mode is set to Quick, the initial passphrase is set.
EAP MethodSet protocols for WPA2-EAP and WPA/WPA2-EAP authentication.EAP Type: Select the certification protocol.PEAP: Authentication protocol widely used in Windows Server.PEAP-TLS: Authentication protocol used in Windows Server. Select when using a client certificate.EAP-TLS: Authentication protocol widely used to use a client certificate.EAP-FAST, LEAP: Select this when these authentication protocols are used.User name: Enter a user name to be used for authentication. You can enter up to 64 single-byte alphanumeric characters.You can enter up to 32 characters on the Configuration menu. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text."Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215If you also need to enter a domain name, add the domain name before the user name separated by a backslash (domain name\user name).Password: Enter the password used for authentication in PEAP, EAP-FAST, and LEAP. You can enter up to 64 single-byte alphanumeric characters. You can enter up to 32 characters on the Configuration menu. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text."Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215When the password is entered andFinishis selected, the value is set and displayed as an asterisk (*).Client Certificate: Imports client certificates for use in PEAP-TLS and EAP-TLS.
Submenu Function
Verify Server Cert.: Set to On to perform verification for the certificate of the certification server. To verify a server certificate, you need to set CA certificate.CA certificate: Imports CA certificates for use in PEAP, PEAP-TLS, EAP-TLS, and EAP-FAST.RADIUS Serv.Name: Specify the name of the certification server. You can enter up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters.
ChannelYou can select the channels used to connect in Quick mode. If interference from other signals occurs, use a different channel.
IP SettingsPerform network settings.DHCP: Set to On to configure the network using DHCP. If this is set to On, you cannot set any more addresses.IP Address: Enter the IP address assigned to the projector. You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following IP addresses cannot be used.0.0.0.0, 127.x.x.x, 224.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (where x is a number from 0 to 255)Subnet Mask: Enter the projector's subnet mask. You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following subnet masks cannot be used.0.0.0.0, 255.255.255.255Gateway Address: Enter the IP address for the gateway for the projector. You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following Gateway Address cannot be used.0.0.0.0, 127.x.x.x, 224.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (where x is a number from 0 to 255)
SSID DisplayTo prevent the SSID from being displayed on the LAN Standby screen, set this to Off.
IP Address Dis-playTo prevent the IP address from being displayed on the LAN Standby screen, set this to Off.

IPv6 Settings

Perform settings to use the IPv6 protocols.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - IPv6 Settings - 1

•The following functions support IPv6 protocols.

- Epson Web Control - PJLink

- When setting the IPv6 address manually, make settings in Advanced from Epson Web Control.

"Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215

IPv6: Set this to On when using IPv6 protocols. Make sure one link local address is set when using IPv6. This is composed of the interface ID created from fe80:: and the projector's MAC address.

Auto Configuration: Set this to On to automatically acquire an IPv6 address from RA (Router Advertisement). The address is composed as shown below.

- Stateless Address (0 to 6): Created automatically by combining the prefix acquired from the RA (Router Advertisement) and the interface ID created from the projector's MAC address.

- Stateful Address (0 to 1): Created automatically from the DHCP server using DHCPv6.

Use Temporary Address: Set this to On to temporarily validate the IPv6 address (0 to 1) when Auto Configuration is On.

* This can only be selected when Connection Mode is set to Advanced.

Type of security

When the optional wireless LAN unit is attached and being used in Advanced connection mode, it is strongly recommended that you set security.

WPA is an encryption standard that improves the security for wireless networks. The projector supports TKIP and AES encryption methods.

WPA also includes user authentication functions. WPA authentication provides two methods: using an authentication server, or authenticating between a computer and an access point without using a server. This projector supports the latter method, without a server.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Type of security - 1

For setting details, follow the instructions from your network administrator.

Search Access Point screen

Detected access points are displayed in a list.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Search Access Point screen - 1

text_image [Search Access Point] abcd1234 efgh5678 ijkl9876 mnop5432 Return + Refresh

Esc / [●]: Return : Select

Submenu Function
RefreshSearches for the access point again.
Indicates an already set access point.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Submenu Function - 1

Indicates the access points where security is set.

If you select an access point where security has not been set, the Wireless LAN menu is displayed.

If you select an access point where security has been set, the Security menu is displayed. Select a type of security according to the security settings for the access point.

Wired LAN menu

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Wired LAN menu - 1

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete IP Settings IP Address Display Off IPv6 Settings Return [Esc] /[●]:Return [◆]:Select

IP Settings

You can make settings related to the following addresses.

DHCP: Set to On to configure the network using DHCP. If this is set to On, you cannot set any more addresses.

IP Address: Enter the IP address assigned to the projector. You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following IP addresses cannot be used.

0.0.0.0, 127.x.x.x, 224.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (where x is a number from 0 to 255)

Subnet Mask: Enter the projector's subnet mask. You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following subnet masks cannot be used.

0.0.0.0, 255.255.255.255

Gateway Address: Enter the IP address for the gateway for the projector. You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following Gateway Address cannot be used.

0.0.0.0, 127.x.x.x, 224.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (where x is a number from 0 to 255)

Submenu Function
IP Address DisplayTo prevent the IP address from being displayed on the LAN Standby screen, set this to Off.
IPv6 SettingsPerform settings to use the IPv6 protocols.EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Submenu Function - 1 The following functions support IPv6 protocols.- Epson Web Control- PJLinkWhen setting the IPv6 address manually, make settings in Advanced from Epson Web Control."Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215IPv6: Set this to On when using IPv6 protocols. Make sure one link local address is set when using IPv6. This is composed of the interface ID created from fe80:: and the projector's MAC address.Auto Configuration: Set this to On to automatically acquire an IPv6 address from RA (Router Advertisement). The address is composed as shown below.Stateless Address (0 to 6): Created automatically by combining the prefix acquired from the RA (Router Advertisement) and the interface ID created from the projector's MAC address.Stateful Address (0 to 1): Created automatically from the DHCP server using DHCPv6.Use Temporary Address: Set this to On to temporarily validate the IPv6 address (0 to 1) when Auto Configuration is On.

Notifications menu

When this is set, you receive an email notification if a problem or warning occurs in the projector.

"Reading error notification mail" p.225

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Notifications menu - 1

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Mail Notification Off SMTP Server 0. 0. 0. 0 Port Number 0 From Address 1 Setting Address 2 Setting Address 3 Setting SNMP Off Trap IP Address 1 0. 0. 0. 0 Trap IP Address 2 0. 0. 0. 0 Community Name PJLink Notification Off Notified IP Address 0. 0. 0. 0 Return

Esc / [●]: Return : Select

Submenu Function
Mail NotificationSet to On to send an email to the preset addresses when a problem or warning occurs with a projector.
SMTP ServerYou can input the IP Address for the SMTP server for the projector.You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following IP addresses cannot be used.L27.x.x.x,224.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (where x is a number from 0 to 255)
Port NumberYou can input the port number for the SMTP server. The default value is 25. You can input numbers between 1 to 65535.
FromEnter the email address of the sender. You can enter up to 64 single-byte alphanumeric characters. You can enter up to 32 characters on the Configuration menu. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text. (" ( ) , : ; < > | \ ] and spaces cannot be used.)● "Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215
Address 1 Setting/ Address 2 Setting/ Address 3 SettingSet the destination email addresses for the notification email, and the notification content. You can register up to three destinations. You can enter up to 64 single-byte alphanumeric characters. You can enter up to 32 characters on the Configuration menu. When entering more than 32 characters, use your Web browser to enter the text. (" ( ), :; < > [ \ ] and spaces cannot be used.)● "Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215
SNMPSet to On to monitor the projector using SNMP. To monitor the projector, you need to install the SNMP manager program on your computer. SNMP should be managed by a network administrator. The default value is Off.
Trap IP Address 1/ Trap IP Address 2You can register up to two IP addresses for the SNMP trap notification destination.You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following IP addresses cannot be used.127.x.x.x, 224.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (where x is a number from 0 to 255)
Community NameSet the community name of SNMP. You can enter up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters. (Spaces and symbols cannot be used.)
PJLink NotificationSet this to On to use the PJLink notification function.
Notified IP AddressEnter the IP address of the computer to which you want to send notifications of the projector's operating status using the PJLink notification function.You can enter a number from 0 to 255 in each field of the address. However, the following IP addresses cannot be used.127.x.x.x, 224.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (where x is a number from 0 to 255)

Others menu

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Others menu - 1

text_image Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete Secure HTTP Web Server Cert. Priority Gateway AMX Device Discovery Crestron Connected Message Broadcasting Return Off Wired LAN Off Off Off [Esc] / [◆]: Return [◆]: Select
Submenu Function
Secure HTTPTo strengthen security, communication between the projector and computer in Epson Web Control is encrypted. When setting security with Epson Web Control, we recommend setting this to On.
Web Server Cert.Imports the Web server certificate used in Secure HTTP.
Priority GatewayFor the priority gateway, select either Wired or Wireless.
AMX Device DiscoveryWhen you want to allow the projector to be detected by AMX Device Discovery, set this to On. Set this to Off if you are not connected to an environment controlled by a controller from AMX or AMX Device Discovery.
Crestron ConnectedSet this to On only when monitoring or controlling the projector over the network using Crestron Connected®. Otherwise, set this to Off."About Crestron Connected®" p.228Changes in projector settings take effect upon restarting.When this is set to On, you cannot use the Message Broadcasting feature in Epson Projector Management.
Message BroadcastingSet this to On to receive information sent by the Message Broadcasting feature in the Epson Projector Management software.Download software and User's Guides from the following Web site.http://www.epson.com

Reset menu

Resets all of the network settings.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reset menu - 1

text_image Reset network settings. Basic Wireless LAN Wired LAN Notifications Others Reset Complete [◆]:Select [●]:Enter
Submenu Function
Reset network settings.To reset all of the Network settings, select Yes.

Info Menu (Display Only)

Lets you check the status of the image signals being projected and the status of the projector. Items that can be displayed vary depending on the source currently being projected.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Info Menu (Display Only) - 1

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Projector Info Light Source Info Version Status Information Temp Warning Info Power On/Off History Return [Esc] /[●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit
Submenu Function
Projector Info OOperation Hours*Displays the operation time after turning on the projector.
SourceYou can display the source name for the connected equipment currently being projected.
Input SignalYou can display the content of Input Signal set in the Signal menu according to the source.
ResolutionYou can display the resolution.
Refresh RateYou can display the Refresh Rate.
Submenu Function
Sync InfoYou can display the image signal information.This information may be needed if service is required.
StatusThis is information about errors that have occurred on the projector.This information may be needed if service is required.
Serial NumberDisplays the projector's serial number.
Lens TypeDisplays the model number of your lens.
Event IDWhen problems occur when the projector and computer are connected through the network, information on the problem is displayed using an Event ID. See the following page for information on interpreting the Event ID."About Event ID" p.201
HDBaseT Signal LevelDisplays the level for the image signal being input from the HDBaseT port. When this is displayed in yellow, the strength of the signal level is reduced. We recommend the following signal levels.•1080p: 16dB or more•4K: 18dB or more
Light Source InfoLight Source HoursDisplays the operating time for the light source according to the light source mode.
Estimated RemainsWhen Constant Brightness is set to On, this displays the amount of time for which the brightness of the light source can be maintained.
Version MainVideo2SubSub2HDMIHDBaseTHDBaseT2Displays the projector's firmware version information.
Status InformationDisplays the projector's status."Reading the Status Display" p.182
Temp Warning InfoDisplays a high temperature warning. When you selectDetailwhen a Warning or Error is displayed, you can check detailed logs for before and after the error was detected.
Power On/Off HistoryDisplays the power on/off logs.

* The cumulative use time is displayed as "0H" for the first 10 hours. 10 hours and above is displayed as "10H", "11H", and so on.

Reset Menu
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Info Menu (Display Only) - 2

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Return Reset All Memories Refresh Mode Light Source Calibration Reset All Config Reset All (Factory Default) Reset [Esc] / [◆]: Return [◆]: Select [Menu]: Exit
Submenu Function
Reset All MemoriesResets all names and settings saved in Memory, Lens Position, and Geometry Correction.➤ "Memory Function" p.110
Refresh ModeMake settings related to the Refresh Mode.Timer: Select when to run Refresh Mode.Messages: Select whether or not to display messages during refresh operations.Start: Removes any afterimages (screen burn-in) that remain in the projected image. The projector turns off once the set time has elapsed. When you press any button on the control panel or remote control, a message is displayed asking if you want to continue using Refresh Mode.
Light Source CalibrationMake settings related to Light Source Calibration. When performing Light Source Calibration, the difference between the white balance and the brightness level for the light source is corrected. We recommend running this function periodically.●Run Now: Starts Light Source Calibration.This cannot be started in the following cases.- Within 20 minutes of turning on the projector.- If the surrounding temperature gets too high, and the brightness has been automatically dimmed.● Run Periodically: When this is set to On, Light Source Calibration is performed every 100 hours of use. When Off is selected to maintain the projected image that has been adjusted using Multi-Projection, perform corrections using Run Now or set the scheduling function to perform Light Source Calibration periodically.● Schedule Settings: Displays the schedule settings screen. Set Light Source Calibration to run periodically.● Last Run: Displays the last date and time Light Source Calibration was performed.
Reset All ConfigYou can reset all items in the Configuration menu to their default settings.The following items are not reset to their defaults: Input Signal, EDID, Memory, Content Playback, User's Logo, all items for Network menus, Language, Date & Time, Panel Alignment, Color Uniformity, Lens Calibration, Color Matching, Light Source Info, and Operation Hours.
Reset All (Factory Default)Resets all of the projector's settings. However, Date & Time, Operation Hours, Light Source Info, Password Protection items and their passwords are not reset. You need to enter a password to perform a reset. The default password is set to "0000". Change this to your own desired password.

Once the Configuration menu content has been set for one projector, you can use it to perform batch setup for multiple projectors (batch setup function). The batch setup function is only for projectors with the same model number.

Use one of the following methods.

  • Setup using a USB flash drive.
  • Setup by connecting the computer and projector with a USB cable.
  • Set through Epson Projector Management.

This manual explains the USB flash drive and the USB cable methods.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Info Menu (Display Only) - 3

  • The content for Light Source Info and Status Information from the Info menu is not reflected by the batch setup function.
  • Perform batch setup before adjusting the projected image. Adjustment values for the projected image, such as Geometry Correction are reflected by the batch setup function. If batch setup is performed after adjusting the projected image, the adjustments you made may change.
  • By using the batch setup function, the registered User's Logo is set for the other projectors. Do not register confidential information and so on as the User's Logo.
  • If you do not want to copy the following settings, set Batch Setup Range to Limited.

- EDID from the Signal menu

- Network menu (except for the Notifications menu and the Others menu)

Extended - Operation - Advanced - Batch Setup Range p.146

- Items for which Password Protection is set are not copied.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Info Menu (Display Only) - 4

Caution

Performing batch setup is the customers responsibility. If batch setup fails due to a power failure, communication error, and so on, the customer is responsible for any repair costs incurred.

Setup Using a USB Flash Drive

This section explains how to perform batch setup using a USB flash drive.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setup Using a USB Flash Drive - 1

  • Use a FAT format USB flash drive.
  • The batch setup function cannot be used by USB flash drives that incorporate security functions. Use a USB flash drive that does not incorporate security functions.
    •The batch setup function cannot be used by USB card readers or USB hard disks.

Saving settings to the USB flash drive

1 Disconnect the power cord from the projector, and check that all of the projector's indicators have turned off.
2 Connect a USB flash drive to the projector's USB-A port (the wireless LAN module installation section).

"Installing the Wireless LAN Unit" p.54

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving settings to the USB flash drive - 1

natural_image Diagram of a refrigerator interior with a blue plastic component inserted, showing no text or symbols

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving settings to the USB flash drive - 2

  • Connect the USB flash drive directly to the projector. If the USB flash drive is connected to the projector through a USB hub, the settings may not be saved correctly.
  • Connect an empty USB flash drive. If the USB flash drive contains data other than the batch setup file, the settings may not be saved correctly.
  • If you have saved a batch setup file from another projector to the USB flash drive, delete the file or change the file name. The batch setup function cannot overwrite a batch setup file.
  • The file name for the batch setup file is PJCONFDATA.bin. If you need to change the file name, add text after PJCONFDATA. If you change the file name in any other way, the projector may not be able to recognize the file correctly.
  • You can only use single-byte characters for the file name

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving settings to the USB flash drive - 3

While holding down the Esc button on the remote control or the control panel, connect the power cord to the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving settings to the USB flash drive - 4

text_image Menu Enter +

Batch Setup

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 1

When the projector's indicators turn on as follows, release the Esc button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 2

text_image 投影器 On/Standby Filter Temp Laser Status

Power supply Status Laser Temp

Blue - On Blue - On Orange - On Orange - On

When all of the indicators start flashing, the batch setup file is being written.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 3

Caution

- Do not disconnect the power cord from the projector while the file is being written. If the power cord is disconnected, the projector may not start correctly.

- Do not disconnect the USB flash drive from the projector while the file is being written. If the USB flash drive is disconnected, the projector may not start correctly.

When writing completes normally, the projector enters standby status.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 1

text_image 光盘参考器 On/Standby Fiber Temp Laser Status

Power
Blue - On

When the projector is in standby status, remove the USB flash drive.

Reflecting saved settings to other projectors

1 Disconnect the power cord from the projector, and check that all of the projector's indicators have turned off.
2 Connect the USB flash drive on which the settings are saved to the projector's USB-A port (the wireless LAN module installation section).

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reflecting saved settings to other projectors - 1

natural_image Diagram of a refrigerator interior with a blue plastic component inserted, showing no text or symbols

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reflecting saved settings to other projectors - 2

  • When the USB flash drive contains 1 to 3 types of batch setup files, the file is reflected to the projector with the same model number. If there are multiple files for a projector with the same model number, the settings may not be reflected correctly.
  • When there are four or more types of batch setup files on the USB flash drive, the settings may not be reflected correctly.
  • Do not store any data except for the batch setup file on the USB flash drive. If the USB flash drive contains data other than the batch setup file, the settings may not be reflected correctly.

3 While holding down the Menu on the remote control or the control panel, connect the power cord to the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reflecting saved settings to other projectors - 3

text_image Menu Enter i +

When the projector's indicators turn on as follows, release the Menu button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reflecting saved settings to other projectors - 4

text_image Filter Spring Laser Status On/Standby

Power supply Status Laser Temp

Blue - On Blue - On Orange - On Orange - On

The indicators remain on for about 75 seconds.

When all of the indicators start flashing, the settings are being written.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reflecting saved settings to other projectors - 5

Caution

  • Do not disconnect the power cord from the projector while the settings are being written. If the power cord is disconnected, the projector may not start correctly.
  • Do not disconnect the USB flash drive from the projector while the settings are being written. If the USB flash drive is disconnected, the projector may not start correctly.

4 When writing completes normally, the projector enters standby status.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Caution - 1

text_image Fiber Temp Laser Status OvSandy

Power Blue - On

When the projector is in standby status, remove the USB flash drive.

Setup by Connecting the Computer and Projector with a USB Cable

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Setup by Connecting the Computer and Projector with a USB Cable - 1

The following operating systems support the batch setup function

•Windows Vista or later
•Mac OS X 10.7.x or later

Saving settings to a computer

1 Disconnect the power cord from the projector, and check that all of the projector's indicators have turned off.
2 Connect the computer's USB port to the projector's Service port with a USB cable.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving settings to a computer - 1

natural_image Diagram showing a laptop connected to an oscilloscope with a device and signal output (no text or symbols present)

3 While holding down the Esc button on the remote control or the control panel, connect the power cord to the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Saving settings to a computer - 2

text_image Menu Enter +

Batch Setup

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 1

When the projector's indicators turn on as follows, release the Esc button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 2

text_image Filter Temp Laser Status OloStandby

Power supply Status Laser Temp

Blue - On Blue - On Orange - On Orange - On

The projector is recognized as a removable disk by the computer.

4 Open the removable disk, and save the batch setup file (PJCONFDATA.bin) to the computer.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 3

If you need to change the name of the batch setup file, add text after PJCONFDATA. If you change the file name, the projector may not be able to recognize the file correctly.

5 Perform "Remove USB device" on your computer, and then disconnect the USB cable.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 4

When using Mac, perform "Remove EPSON_PJ".

The projector enters standby status.

Reflecting saved settings to other projectors

1 Disconnect the power cord from the projector, and check that all of the projector's indicators have turned off.

2 Connect the computer's USB port to the projector's Service port with a USB cable.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reflecting saved settings to other projectors - 1

text_image Diagram showing a laptop connected to an oscilloscope with an attached device, illustrating the connection and display setup.

Batch Setup

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 1

3 While holding down the Menu on the remote control or the control panel, connect the power cord to the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 2

text_image Diagram showing a hand gesture with 'Menu' and 'Esc' labels, a plus sign, and an attached USB port with blue arrow indicating connection.

When the projector's indicators turn on as follows, release the Menu button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 3

text_image Filter Temp Laser Status On/Standby

Power supply Status Laser Temp

Blue - On Blue - On Orange - On Orange - On

The projector is recognized as a removable disk by the computer.

4 Copy the batch setup file (PJCONFDATA.bin) that you saved to your computer to the top level folder of the removable disk.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 4

Do not copy any files or folders other than the batch setup file to the removable disk.

5 Perform "Remove USB device" on your computer, and then disconnect the USB cable.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 5

When using Mac, perform "Remove EPSON_PJ".

When all of the indicators start flashing, the settings are being written.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Batch Setup - 6

Caution

Do not disconnect the power cord from the projector while the settings are being written. If the power cord is disconnected, the projector may not start correctly.

When writing completes normally, the projector enters standby status.

When Setup Fails

The Indicators notify you if an error occurs. Check the status of the indicators.

Status of the Indicators Remedy
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - When Setup Fails - 1Laser: Orange - flashing fastTemp: Orange - flashing fastThe batch setup file may be corrupt, or the USB flash drive may not be connected correctly.Disconnect the USB flash drive, unplug and then plug in the projector's power cord, and then try again.
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - When Setup Fails - 2Power: Blue - flashing fastStatus: Blue - flashing fastLaser: Orange - flashing fastTemp: Orange - flashing fastWriting the settings may have failed and an error may have occurred in the projector's firmware.Stop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - When Setup Fails - 3

Troubleshooting

This chapter explains how to identify problems and what to do if a problem is found.

Using the Help

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using the Help - 1

If a problem occurs with the projector, you can display the Help screen to assist you. You can also set the projector to an appropriate state by answering the questions.

1 Press the [ ] button.

The Home screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Press the [ ] button. - 1

text_image Remote control 4 5 6 7 8 9 ID 0 Num ID On Off Home

2 Select Help, and then press the [] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select Help, and then press the [] button. - 1

text_image EPSON Sources - Searching at Source... HDNI HDBase T DVI-0 Computer BNC USB LAN Username Function: Color Mode Light Source Mode Image Enhancement Frame Interpolation Menu Help Content Playback : On Projector Name: xxxxxxxxx Keyword: xxxxx SSD: xxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx IP: xxxxxxxxx IP: xxxxxxxxx.xx Connection Guide Submit the source. [Home] Exit

The Help screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select Help, and then press the [] button. - 2

text_image [Help] The image is small. The image is distorted. The color tone is unusual. There is no audio or it is too low.

3 Select a menu item.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Select a menu item. - 1

4 Confirm the selection.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Confirm the selection. - 1

Questions and solutions are displayed as shown on the screen below. Press the Menu button to exit Help.

The image is small.

Is zoom set to minimum? - Press the [Zoom] button to change the size of the image.
Is the projector too close to the screen? Move the projector away from the screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 1

See the following if the Help function does not provide a solution to the problem.

"Reading the Indicators" p.175

This projector has the following five indicators to indicate the projector's status.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 2

text_image ① On/Standby ② Status ③ Laser ④ Temp ⑤ Filter

① Power indicator

Indicates the projector's status.

② Status indicator

Indicates the projector's status.

③ Laser indicator

Indicates the light source status.

4 Temp indicator

Indicates the internal temperature status. This is normally turned off.

⑤ Filter indicator

Indicates the air filter status. This is normally turned off.

The following indicator status are used during regular operation.

"Status varies" indicates that the indicators turn on, off, or flash depending on the status of the projector.

Indicator Projector's Sta-tusExplanation
Power supplyStatus Laser TempFilter
Blue - OnOff Off OffOffOffOffStandby conditionPower is being supplied to the projector. In this status, you can start projecting by pressing the [1] button on the remote control or control panel.(Sometimes, when the power cord is unplugged, the power indicator remains lit for a short period, but this is not a fault.)
Network monitor-ing statusThe projector is being monitored and controlled over a network (when Standby Mode is set to Communication On).If the power cord is disconnected and then reconnected in this status, the power indicator flashes blue.
Blue - OnBlue - FlashingStatus variesOff OffOffWarm-up statusThis is the status immediately after turning on the projector. Warm-up takes approximately 30 seconds after the light source turns on.The [O] button is disabled during warm-up.
Blue - OnBlue - On Status variesOff OffOff Off0Projecting The projector is projecting.
Blue - OnBlue - FlashingOff OffOff0Cool down statusThis is the status immediately after turning off the power. In this status, all buttons are disabled.
Blue - FlashingOff OffOff Off00Preparing Network monitoringPreparing to monitor and control this projector over a network.During network monitoring preparation, all button operations are disabled.
Blue - OnBlue - OnBlue - FlashingOff Off0A/V Mute activatedA/V Mute is active.
Status variesBlue - FlashingOrange - FlashingStatus variesStatus variesRefresh Mode activatedRefresh Mode is active.Reset - Refresh Mode p.162

When an error has occurred in the projector, the error status is indicated by the indicator's color and combination of flashing or lit.

Refer to the following table to see what the indicators mean and how to remedy problems that they indicate.

Indicator Cause Remedy or Status
Power supplyStatus Laser TempFilter
Off[08T5]Blue - FlashingEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 3Orange - Flashing[26T6]Off OffOffInternal ErrorStop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
Off[DTAB]Blue - FlashingOffEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 4Orange - FlashingOffFan ErrorSensor ErrorStop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
OffEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 5Blue - FlashingOffOrange - OnOffHigh Temp Error(Overheating)The light source turns off automatically and projection stops. Wait for about five minutes. After about five minutes, the projector switches to standby mode, so check the following three points.Check that the air filter, air exhaust vent, and air intake vent are clear, and that the projector is not positioned against a wall.Check if the temperature around the air intake is too high.If the air filter are clogged, remove the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then clean or replace them."Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent" p.204"Replacing the Air Filter" p.208If the error continues after checking the points above, stop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
When using at an altitude of 1500 m or more, set High Altitude Mode to On.Extended - Operation - High Altitude Mode p.146
OffBlue - FlashingOrange - OnOff OffOffLaser Error Retardation Plate ErrorStop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
OffBlue - FlashingOff OffOff OffOrange - OnFilter Airflow ErrorCheck the following two points.Check that the air filter and air exhaust vents are clear, and that the projector is not positioned against a wall.If the air filter is clogged, turn off the power, remove the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then clean or replace them."Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent" p.204"Replacing the Air Filter" p.208After checking, connect the power cord to the electrical outlet.If the error continues after checking the points above, stop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
OffBlue - FlashingOrange - OnOrange - OnOffLens Shift ErrorStop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
Off[22CD]Blue - FlashingBlue - FlashingStatus variesOrange - On[2860]Status variesOrange - On[7D0Z]Orange - FlashingOff[03KO]Status variesLens Error No LensHigh Temp WarningInstall the lens unit. If the lens unit is already installed, remove it and then reinstall it. If the error continues after checking the points above, stop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact ListThis is not an error. However, if the temperature rises too high again, projection stops automatically. Check the following three points.Check that the air filter, air exhaust vent, and air intake vent are clear, and that the projector is not positioned against a wall.Check if the temperature around the air intake is too high.If the air filter is clogged, turn off the power, remove the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then clean or replace them."Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent" p.204"Replacing the Air Filter" p.208
- [24XA]Blue - FlashingStatus variesEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 6Orange - FlashingEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 7Status varies[CKBD]Status variesLaser WarningStop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
[6460]Blue - Flashing[120]Status variesStatus variesEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 8Orange - FlashingStatus variesEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 9Status variesStatus variesEPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 10Status variesOrange - OnLens Warning An unsupported lens is attached. Use a supported lens."Optional Accessories and Consumables" p.233Low Air FlowThis is not an error. However, projection stops automatically if the airflow falls any further.The message "The air filter is clogged. Clean or replace the air filter." is displayed. Check the following two points.Check that the air filter and air exhaust vents are clear, and that the projector is not positioned against a wall.If the air filter is clogged, turn off the power, remove the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then clean or replace them."Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent" p.204"Replacing the Air Filter" p.208If the error continues after checking the points above, stop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
[120]Status variesStatus variesStatus variesOrange - FlashingAir Filter Notice"Time to clean the air filter. Clean or replace the air filter." is displayed.Turn off the projector's power, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then clean the air filter."Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent" p.204The indicators or messages regarding air filter notice are displayed only when Air Filter Notice is set to On in the Configuration menu.Extended - Display - Air Filter Notice p.146
[120]Status variesStatus variesStatus variesStatus varics
[120]Status variesOrange - FlashingStatus variesStatus varicsConstant Brightness EndEnds the Constant Brightness mode in Brightness Settings."Setting the Brightness" p.77

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 11

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 12

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 13

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 14

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 15

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 16

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 17

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 18

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 19

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 20

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 21

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 22

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 23

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 24

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 25

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 26

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 27

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 28

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 29

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 30

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 31

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 32

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 33

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 34

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 35

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 36

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 37

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 38

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 39

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 40

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 41

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 42

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 43

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 44

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 45

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 46

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 47

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 48

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 49

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 50

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 51

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 52

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 53

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 54

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 55

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 56

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 57

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 58

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 59

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 60

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 61

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 62

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 63

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 64

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 65

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 66

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 67

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 68

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 69

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 70

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 71

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 72

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 73

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 74

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 75

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 76

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 77

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 78

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 79

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 80

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 81

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 82

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 83

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 84

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 85

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 86

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 87

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 88

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 89

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 90

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 91

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 92

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 93

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 94

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 95

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 96

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 97

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 98

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 99

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 100

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 101

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 102

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 103

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 104

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 105

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 106

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 107

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 108

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 109

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 110

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 111

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 112

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 113

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 114

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 115

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 116

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 117

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 118

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 119

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 120

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 121

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 122

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 123

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 124

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 125

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 126

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 127

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 128

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 129

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 130

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 131

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 132

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 133

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 134

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 135

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 136

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 137

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 138

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 139

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 140

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 141

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 142

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 143

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 144

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 145

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 146

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 147

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 148

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 149

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 150

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 151

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 152

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 153

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 154

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 155

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 156

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 157

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 158

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 159

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 160

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 161

text_image dir Pow supl Blu Flash Stat vari Stat vari

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 162

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 163

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 164

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 165

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 166

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 167

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 168

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 169

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 170

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 171

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 172

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 173

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 174

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 175

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 176

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 177

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 178

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 179

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 180

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 181

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 182

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 183

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 184

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 185

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 186

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 187

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 188

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 189

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 190

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 191

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - The image is small. - 192

  • See the following if the projector is not operating properly, even though the indicators are all showing normal.
    "Problem Solving" p.190
  • If the indicators are in a state not shown in this table, stop using the projector, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.
    Epson Projector Contact List

Reading the Status Display

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 1

You can display the operating status of the projector on the projected image. You can check the detailed status of the projector by using button operations.

1 Press the [] button while projecting.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 2

text_image Remote control Control panel Geometry Memory User2 User3 2 3 4 5 6 A/V Mate Lens

2 Select Status Information, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 3

text_image Image Signal Settings Extended Network Info Reset Return Projector Info Light Source Info Version Status Information Temp Warning Info Power On/Off History [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 4

text_image You can also operate from the Configuration menu. Info - Status Information p.161

3 Use the [◀][▶] buttons or the [▲][▼] buttons to select a category.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 5

text_image [Status Information] 1/7 Return [Status Information] System Source Computer On-ScreenDisplay On A/V Note On Intake Air Temp Internal Temp LV L Laser Status On Info Reset [Esc] / [●]:Return [◀●]:Select [Menu]:Exit

Each display category contains the following information.

Status Information : Operating status of the projector

Source : Input signal information

Signal Information : Input digital signal information

Network Wired: Wired LAN settings

Network Wireless : Wireless LAN settings

Maintenance : Operating time for the projector and light source

Version : Projector's firmware version

Explanations of the Display Content

Category Item Status Display Explanation
Status InformationSystemDisplays the projector's status. See the following for more information on how to remedy the errors and warnings. "Reading the Indicators" p.175
OK The projector isin normal status.
Warm-Up The projectoris warming up.
Standby The projector isin standby status.
Cool Down The projectoris in cool down status.
Temp Error A high temp error has occurred.
Fan Error A fan errorhas occurred.
Sensor Error A sensor error has occurred.
Power Error A power error (Ballast) has occurred.
Internal ErrorAn internal error has occurred.
Airflow ErrorA filter airflow error has occurred.
Temp WarningA high temp warning has occurred.
Internal WarningA warning about the internal system has occurred.
Airflow DeclineA low air flow error has occurred.
Power WarningA power warning (Ballast) has occurred.
Clean FilterAn air filter notice has occurred.
Lens ErrorA lens error has occurred.
Laser ErrorA laser error has occurred.
Laser WarningA laser warning has occurred.
Temp Error FEA laser error has occurred because the laser temperature is too high.
Temp Warning FEA laser warning has occurred because the laser temperature is too high.
Status InformationSourceHDMIDisplays the source name for the connected equipment currently being projected.
HDBascT
DVI-D
Computer
BNC
USB
LAN
On-Screen DisplayOnDisplays the settings for the On-Screen Display. When set to Off, the menus or messages are not displayed on the projected images.
Off
A/V Mute On Displaysthe operating status of A/V mute.
Off
Intake Air Temp - Displays the air intake temperature.
Internal Temp Lv - Displays the projector's internal temperature.
Laser StatusOn Displays the operating status of the light source.
Off
SourceSourceHDMIDisplays the source name for the connected equipment currently being projected.
HDBascT
DVI-D
Computer
BNC
USB
LAN
Resolution - Displays the resolution of the current input signal.
Source Color Space RGBDisplays the color spaceof the current input signal.
YCbCr
YPbPr
H-Frequency - Displaysthe horizontal frequencyof the current input signal.
V-Frequency - Displaysthe vertical frequency ofthe current input signal.
Sync Polarity H:Posi / VV:Posi Displays the Syncpolarity.
II:Posi / V:Nega
II:Nega / V:Posi
H:Nega / V:Nega
Sync Mode Composite SyncDisplays thesync type.
Separate Sync
Sync On Green
Detected Mode-Displays the discriminant resolution of the current input signal.
TransportInterlaceDisplays the scanning method.
Progressive
Video RangeAuto(Limited)Displays the video level of the projector.
Auto(Full)
Limited(16-235)
Full(0-255)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 6

Items displayed for source vary depending on the model being used and the image signal and source being projected.

Category Item Status Display Explanation
Signal Information 5V Detect Detected Displays the detection results of 5V signals.
Not Detect
TMDS Clock - Displays the TMDS frequency of the current input signal.
H-Frequency - Displays the horizontal frequency of the current input signal.
V-Frequency - Displays the vertical frequency of the current input signal.
DetChg 5CFHMP123 - Displays the factors of signal changes.
Stable Time - Displays the operating time since the input source is determined.
IIDCP StatusNon-IIDCP Displays the IIDCP status.
Passed
Failed
HDCP Ri-
HDCP AKSV-
HDCP An-
HDCP Ver- Displays the HDCP version.
AVI VIC- Displays the VIC information (AVI) of the current input signal.
AVI ChecksumOK Displays the checksum result for AVI.
NG
AVI Sampling StrRGB4:4:4 Displays color sampling for AVI.
YCbCr4:4:4
YCbCr4:2:2
YCbCr4:2:0
Signal Mode HDMIDisplays the signal mode.
DVI
EDID Mode- Displays the EDID mode.
HDBascT Level- You can display the image signal information from the HDBascT port.

Reading the Status Display

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Reading the Status Display - 2

Items displayed for Signal Information vary depending on the model being used and the image signal and source being projected.

Category Item Status Display Explanation
Network WiredProjector Name-Displays the projector name used to identify the projector when connected to a network.
Connection Mode HDBaseT Displays the connection path for LAN.
LAN
DHCP On Displays theDHCP settings.
Off
IP Display On Displaysthe IP address display settings.
Off
IP Address - Displays the IP address.
MAC Address- Displays the MAC address.
Network WirelessProjector Name-Displays the projector name used to identify the projector when connected to a network.
Connection ModeQuickDisplays the connection mode to use when connecting the projector and a computer over a wireless LAN.
Advanced
SSID DisplayOn Displays the SSIDdisplay settings.
Off
IP Display On Displaysthe IP address display settings.
Off
SSID- Displays the SSID.
IP Address - Displays the IP address.
DUCP On Displays theDUCP settings.
Off
MAC Address- Displays the MAC address.
SecurityNoDisplays the security settings.
WPA2-PSK
WPA/WPA2-PSK
Antenna LevelLEVEL 0-5Displays the reception status for Wi-Fi.
Maintenance Operation Time - Displays the total operation time of the projector.
Laser Op.Time-Displays the laser operating time for each setting in Light Source Mode.
Version Serial No. - Displays the projector's serial number.

If any of the following problems occur and the indicators do not offer a solution, refer to the pages given for each problem.

Problems Relating to Images

No images appearProjection does not start, the projection area is completely black, or the projection area is completely blue.p.191
Moving images are not displayedVideos played back on a computer are black or no image is projected, or the video is not played back on the computer.p.191
Projection stops automaticallyp.192
The message "Not supported" is displayedp.192
“No Signal” is displayedp.192
Images are fuzzy, out of focus, or distortedp.193
Interference or distortion appear in imagesp.193
The image is truncated (large) or small, the aspect ratio is not suitable, or the image has been reversedOnly part of the image is displayed, the height and width ratios of the image are not correct, or the image may appear reversed from top to bottom or left to right.p.194
Image colors are not rightThe whole image appears purplish or greenish, images are black & white, or colors appear dull.p.195
Images appear dark p.195

Problems when Projection Starts

• 'The projector does not turn onp.196

Problems with Content Playback Mode

Cannot play the playlistp.197

Other Problems

• There are afterimages (screen burn-in) in the projected imagep.197
• No sound can be heard or the sound is faintp.198
• The remote control does not workp.198
• Nothing appears on the external monitorp.199
• I want to change the language for messages and menusp.199
• Email is not received even if a problem occurs in the projectorp.200
• “The battery that saves your clock settings is running low.” is displayedp.200

Problems Relating to Images

No images appear

Check Remedy
Did you press the [ ⏻ ] button on the remote control or control panel?Press the [ Ⓑ button to turn on the power.
Are the indicators switched off?The power cord is not connected correctly or power is not being supplied.Connect the projector's power cord correctly.Check that your electrical outlet or power source is functioning correctly.
Is A/V Mute active? Press the [A/V Mute] button to release A/V Mute."Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute)" p.102
Are the Configuration menu settings correct? Reset all of the settings.Reset - Reset All Config p.162
Is the image to be projected completely black?(Only when projecting computer images)Some input images, such as screen savers, may be completely black.
Is Windows Media Center displayed in full screen?(Only during network connection)When Windows Media Center is displayed at full screen, you cannot project using a network connection. Reduce the screen size.
Is an application using the Windows DirectX function displayed?(Only during network connection)Applications using the Windows DirectX function may not display images correctly.

Moving images are not displayed

Check Remedy
Is the computer's image signal being output to the LCD and the monitor?(Only when projecting images from a laptop computer or a computer with a built-in LCD screen)Change the image signal from the computer to external output only. Check your computer's documentation, or contact the computer's manufacturer.
Are the contents of the moving image you are trying to project copyright protected?The projector may not be able to project copyright protected moving images that are being played back on a computer. For more details, see the user's guide supplied with the player.

Projection stops automatically

Check Remedy
Is Sleep Mode set to On?Press the [ ⏻ ] button to turn on the power. If you do not want to use Sleep Mode, change the setting to Off. ➕ Extended - Operation - Sleep Mode p.146

"Not supported" is displayed

Check Remedy
Do the image signal resolution and the refresh rate correspond to the mode?(Only when projecting computer images)Refer to the computer's documentation for how to change the image signal resolution and the refresh rate output from the computer.■ "Supported Monitor Displays" p.274

"No Signal" is displayed

Check Remedy
Are the cables connected correctly?Check that all the cables required for projection are securely connected.Check that no cables are disconnected and that there are no poor contacts in the cables.
Is the correct port selected? Change the image by pressing the [Search] button."Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search)" p.61
Is the power for the computer or video source turned on? Turn the power on for the equipment.
Are the image signals being output to the projector?(Only when projecting images from a laptop computer or a computer with a built-in LCD screen)If the image signals are only being output to the computer's LCD monitor or to the accessory monitor, you need to change the output to an external destination as well as the computer's own monitor. For some computer models, when the image signals are output externally, they no longer appear on the LCD monitor or accessory monitor.If the connection is made while the power of the projector or computer is already turned on, the Fn key (Function key) that changes the computer's image signal to external output may not work. Turn the power for the computer and the projector off and then back on again.Computer's documentation

Images are fuzzy, out of focus, or distorted

Check Remedy
Is the focus adjusted correctly?Make sure that at least 20 minutes has passed after the projection starts, and press the [Focus] button on the remote control to adjust the focus.■ "Correcting the Focus" p.38
Is the projector at the correct distance?Is it projecting outside of the recommended projection distance range?Setup within the recommended range.■ "Screen Size and Projection Distance" p.234
I has condensation formed on the lens?If the projector is suddenly taken from a cold environment to a warm environment, or if sudden ambient temperature changes occur, condensation may form on the surface of the lens, and this may cause the images to appear fuzzy. Set the projector up in the room about one hour before it is used. If condensation forms on the lens, turn the projector off and wait for the condensation to disappear.

Interference or distortion appear in images

Check Remedy
Are the cables connected correctly?Check that all the cables required for projection are securely connected.⇨ "Connecting Equipment" p.47
Is an extension cable being used?If an extension cable is used, electrical interference may affect the signals.
Is the correct resolution selected?(Only when projecting computer images)Set the computer so that the signals being output are compatible with the projector.⇨ "Supported Monitor Displays" p.274⇨ Computer's documentation
Is the Sync./Tracking adjusted correctly?(Only when projecting computer images)Press the [Auto] button on the Remote Control or the [ ↺ ] button on the Control panel to perform automatic adjustment. If the images are not adjusted correctly even after performing automatic adjustment, you can also make adjustments from the Configuration menu.⇨ Signal - 'Tracking, Sync. p.142
Is the Resolution set to anything other than Auto?(Only when projecting on a split screen)The image may be collapsed if the Resolution on the Configuration menu and the resolution of the projected image are not the same.If the image is collapsed, set the Resolution to Auto.⇨ Signal - Resolution p.142

The image is truncated (large) or small, the aspect is not suitable, or the image has been reversed

Check Remedy
Have theScreenbeen set correctly?Make the appropriateScreenfor the screen being used.⇨ "Screen Settings" p.32
Is the aspect adjusted correctly?Press the [Aspect] button to select an aspect suitable for the input source.⇨ "Changing the Aspect Ratio of the Projected Image" p.80
Is a wide panel computer image being projected?(Only when projecting computer images)Change the setting according to the signal for the connected equipment.⇨ Signal - Resolution p.142
Is the image still being enlarged by E-Zoom?Press the [Esc] button on the remote control to cancel E-Zoom.⇨ "Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom)" p.104
IsScaleturned on?SetScalcto Offon the configuration menu.⇨ Signal - Scale - Scaled p.142
Is the display range restricted byBlanking?Appropriately setBlankingin the configuration menu.⇨ Signal - Blanking p.142
Is the image position adjusted correctly?(Only when projecting analog RGB signals input from the Computer port)Press the [Auto] button on the remote control or the [←] button on the control panel to adjust the position.You can also adjust the position from the Configuration menu.⇨ Signal - Position p.142
Is the computer set for dual display?(Only when projecting computer images)If dual display is activated in theDisplay Propertiesof the computer’s Control Panel, only about half of the image on the computer screen is projected. To display the entire image on the computer screen, turn off the dual display setting.⇨ Computer video driver documentation
Is the correct resolution selected?(Only when projecting computer images)Set the computer so that the signals being output are compatible with the projector.⇨ "Supported Monitor Displays" p.274⇨ Computer’s documentation
Is the image direction correct?Make the correct settings inProjectionfrom the Configuration menu.⇨ "Installation Settings" p.31

Image colors are not right

Check Remedy
Do the input signal settings match the signals from the connected device?Change the setting according to the signal for the connected equipment.■ Signal - Advanced - Input Signal p.142
Is the image brightness adjusted correctly?Adjust the Brightness setting from the Configuration menu.■ Image - Brightness p.140
Are the cables connected correctly?Check that all the cables required for projection are securely connected.Check that no cables are disconnected and that there are no poor contacts in the cables.■ "Connecting Equipment" p.47
Is the Contrast adjusted correctly?Adjust the Contrast setting from the Configuration menu.■ Image - Contrast p.140
Is the color adjustment set correctly?Adjust the Gamma or RGBCMY setting from the Configuration menu.■ Image - Advanced p.140■ "Adjusting the Image" p.81
Are the color saturation and tint adjusted correctly?Adjust the Color Saturation and Tint settings from the Configuration menu.■ Image - Color Saturation, Tint p.140
Are you projecting from multiple projectors at the same time?Make sure that Light Source Calibration from the Reset menu is set correctly for all of the projectors. If Light Source Calibration is only executed for some of the projectors, there may be differences in the White Balance or the Brightness Level between projectors.If there are still differences in the color, set Light Source Calibration to Off.

Images appear dark

Check Remedy
Is the image brightness set correctly?Check theBrightnessandBrightness Settingsvalues from the Configuration menu.➤ Image - Brightness p.140➤ Settings - Brightness Settings p.143
Is the Contrast adjusted correctly?Adjust theContrastsetting from the Configuration menu.➤ Image - Contrast p.140
Is only one projector being used? Check if the following item is set to dark.Extended - Multi-Projection- Brightness Settings p.146

Problems when Projection Starts

The projector does not turn on

Check Remedy
Did you press the [ ⏻ ] button on the remote control or control panel?Press the [ ⏻ button to turn on the power.
Are the indicators switched off?The power cord is not connected correctly or power is not being supplied.Disconnect and then reconnect the power cord.Check that your electrical outlet or power source is functioning correctly.
Do the indicators turn on and off when the power cord is touched?There is probably a poor contact in the power cable, or the power cable may be defective. Reinsert the power cable. If this does not solve the problem, stop using the projector, disconnect the power cable from the electrical outlet, and contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
Is the Control Panel Lock set to Full Lock?Press the [ ⏻ ] button on the remote control. If you do not want to use Control Panel Lock, change the setting to Off."Control Panel Lock" p.117
Is the correct setting for the remote receiver selected?Check the Remote Receiver from the Configuration menu.Settings - Remote Receiver p.143
Was the power cord plugged back in or was the breaker turned on immediately after direct power off?If the operation described in the column on the left is performed when Direct Power On is set to On, the power may not turn back on. Press the [ ⏻ ] button to turn on the power.
Is the [ID] switch on the remote control set to On?When the switch is set to On, you can use the remote control to operate only a projector with a matching ID. Set the [ID] switch to Off."Setting the remote control ID" p.43

Problems with Content Playback Mode

Cannot play the playlist

Check Remedy
Is Content Playback set to On?Set Content Playback to On, and then restart the projector. You can only play playlists on USB flash drives in Content Playback mode.Settings - Content Playback - Content Playback p.143
Are there any playlists on the USB flash drive?Make sure the USB flash drive contains a playlist. See the "Epson Projector Content Manager Operation Guide" for details on creating playlists.
Is the USB flash drive connected to the projector?Make sure the USB flash drive is connected directly to the projector. Do not use a multicard reader or a USB hub.
Is the USB flash drive partitioned?If the USB flash drive is partitioned, you may not be able to play back playlists. Delete all of the partitions before saving the playlists on the USB flash drive.
Are you playing the same playlist on projectors with different resolutions?Do not share a playlist between projectors that are different in resolution. Color and shape effects added by using Overlay Effect may not be reproduced correctly.Settings - Content Playback - Overlay Effect p.143

Other Problems

There are afterimages (screen burn-in) in the projected image

Check Remedy
Are you using Refresh Mode?You can remove afterimages (screen burn-in) from the projected image by using Refresh Mode. Select Start from Refresh Mode in the Reset menu.→ Reset - Refresh Mode p.162

No sound can be heard or the sound is faint

Check Remedy
Check that the audio/video cable is securely attached to both the projector and audio source.Disconnect the cable from the Audio port, and then reconnect the cable.
Is the projector volume set to the minimum? Adjust the volume so that sound can be heard.Settings - Volume p.143"Adjusting the Volume" p.63
Is the volume for the computer or from the image source set to the minimum?Adjust the volume so that sound can be heard.
Is A/V Mute active? Press the [A/V Mute] button to release A/V Mute."Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute)" p.102
Is the audio cable's specification "No resistance"?When using a commercially available audio cable, make sure it is labeled "No resistance".
Is it connected with an HDMI cable?If no audio is output when connecting via an HDMI cable, set the connected equipment to PCM output.
Is the correct audio input selected?Check the Audio Settings from the configuration menu.Extended - A/V Settings - Audio Settings p.146

The remote control does not work

Check Remedy
Is the remote control light-emitting area pointing towards the remote receiver on the projector during operation?Point the remote control towards the remote receiver.⇨ "Remote control operating range" p.24
Is the remote control too far from the projector? Check the operating range.⇨ "Remote control operating range" p.24
Is direct sunlight or strong light from fluorescent lamps shining onto the remote receiver?Set the projector up in a location where strong light does not shine onto the remote receiver.
Is the correct setting for the Remote Receiver selected?Check the Remote Receiver from the Configuration menu.⇨ Settings - Remote Receiver p.143
Are the batteries dead or have the batteries been inserted correctly?Make sure the batteries are inserted correctly or replace the batteries with new ones if necessary.⇨ "Replacing the remote control batteries" p.23

Problem Solving

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Problem Solving - 1

199

Check Remedy
Are the remote control ID and the projector ID matched?Make sure the ID for the projector you want to operate and the ID for the remote control match. To operate all projectors by remote control regardless of the ID setting, set the [ID] switch on the remote control to Off."ID Settings" p.42
Is the optional remote control cable connected to the projector's Remote port?When the remote control cable is connected, the projector's remote receiver is disabled. When not using the remote control cable set, disconnect it from the Remote port.
Is Control Communications or Extron XTP set to On?The Remote port is disabled. When using the optional remote control cable set, set Control Communications or Extron XTP to Off.Extended - HDBaseT p.146
Is the remote control button lock set?When the remote control button lock is set, buttons except for those needed for basic remote control operations are deactivated. 1Hold down the [ ↑ ] button to cancel the remote control button lock."Remote control button lock" p.118

Nothing appears on the external monitor

Check Remedy
Are images input from a port other than the Computer port or BNC port?Only RGB signals from the Computer port or the BNC port can be displayed on an external monitor.
Are you projecting a split screen?Only RGB signals projected on the left screen from the Computer port or the BNC port can be displayed on an external monitor.◆ "Projecting Two Images Simultaneously (Split Screen)" p.99
Is the projector in standby status?Check that Standby Modc, A/V Output, and Monitor Out from the Configuration menu are set correctly.◆ Extended - Standby Modc, A/V Settings p.146

I want to change the language for messages and menus

Check Remedy
Change the Language setting.Adjust the Language setting from the Configuration menu. ➕ Extended - Language p.146

Email is not received even if a problem occurs in the projector

Check Remedy
Is Standby Mode set to Communication On?To use the Mail Notification function when the projector is in standby, set Communication On in Standby Mode from the Configuration menu. ➕ Extended - Standby Mode p.146
Is power being supplied to the projector?Check that your electrical outlet or power source is functioning correctly.
Is the Mail Notification function set correctly in the Configuration menu?An error notification email is sent according to the Notifications settings in the Configuration menu. Check if it is set correctly. ➕ "Notifications menu" p.158

"The battery that saves your clock settings is running low." is displayed

Check Remedy
The internal power supply that saves your clock settings is running low.Contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List. 📄 Epson Projector Contact List

Check the numbers and then apply the following countermeasures. If you cannot resolve the problem, contact your network administrator, or contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.

Epson Projector Contact List

Event ID CauseRemedy
04320435Failed to start the network software. Restart the projector.
0434048104820485Network communication is unstable.Check the network communication status, and reconnect after waiting for a while.
0433 Cannot play transferred images. Restart the network software.
0484 Communication was disconnected from the computer.
048304FEThe network software ended unexpectedly.Check the status of network communications. Restart the projector.
047904FFA system error occurred in the projector. Restart the projector.
0891Cannot find an access point with the same SSID.Set the computer, the access point, and the projector to the same SSID.
0892The WPA/WPA2 authentication type does not match.Check that the wireless LAN security settings are correct.
0893 The TKIP/AES encryption types do not match.Network - Wireless LAN p.154
0894 Communication was disconnected because the projector connected to an unauthorized access point.Contact your network administrator for more information.
0898Failed to acquire DIICP.Check that the DIICP server is operating correctly. If you are not using DIICP, turn off the DIICP setting.
0899Other communication errorsIf restarting the projector or network software does not solve the problem, contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List
089AThe EAP authentication type is not the same.Check that the wireless LAN security settings are correct. Also, check if the certificate is installed correctly.
089BEAP server authentication failed.
089CEAP client authentication failed.Network - Wireless LAN p.154

About Event ID

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - About Event ID - 1

202

Event ID Cause Remedy
089D Key exchange failed.
0920 The internal power supply that saves your clock settings is running low.Contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.Epson Projector Contact List

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - About Event ID - 2

Maintenance

This chapter provides information on maintenance procedures to ensure the best level of performance from the projector for a long time to come.

Cleaning the Parts

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the Parts - 1

204

You should clean the projector if it becomes dirty or if the quality of projected images starts to deteriorate.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the Parts - 2

Caution

When cleaning, unplug the power cable from the electric outlet. Otherwise, it could cause an electric shock.

Cleaning the Projector

Clean the projector's surface by wiping it gently with a soft cloth. If the projector is particularly dirty, moisten the cloth with water and firmly wring it out before wiping, and then finish with a dry cloth.

Attention

Do not use volatile substances such as wax, benzene, or thinner, or kitchen detergent to clean the projector's surface. The quality of the case may change or become discolored.

Cleaning the Lens

Use a commercially available cloth for cleaning glasses to gently wipe the lens.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the Lens - 1

Warning

Do not use sprays that contain flammable gas to remove dust and lint from the lens. The projector may catch fire due to the high internal temperature.

Use a vacuum cleaner or a hand-held air blower to remove any dust and lint attached to the lens.

Attention

Do not rub the lens with harsh materials or subject the lens to shocks, as it can easily become damaged.

Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent

When the following message is displayed and the filter indicator flashes orange, clean the air filter and the air intake vent.

"Time to clean the air filter. Clean or replace the air filter."

"The projector is overheating. Make sure nothing is blocking the air vent, and clean or replace the air filter."

"The air filter is clogged. Clean or replace the air filter."

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the Air Filter and Air Intake Vent - 1

Warning

Do not use sprays that contain flammable gas to remove dust and lint from the filter.

The projector may catch fire due to the high internal temperature. Use a vacuum cleaner or a hand-held air blower to remove any dust and lint attached to the air filter and so on.

Attention

  • If dust collects on the air filter, it can cause the internal temperature of the projector to rise, and this can lead to problems with operation and shorten the optical engine's service life. Clean the air filter immediately when the message is displayed.
  • Do not rinse the air filter in water. Do not use detergents or solvents.
  • When using a brush for cleaning, use one with long soft bristles, and brush it lightly. If it is brushed too strongly, dust will be ground into the air filter and cannot be removed.

Cleaning the Parts

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the Parts - 1

205

Cleaning the air filter

The air filter can be replaced even when the projector is suspended from a ceiling.

1 After you turn off the projector's power and the confirmation buzzer beeps, disconnect the power cord.
2 Loosen the fixing screws and open the air filter cover.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the air filter - 1

text_image Diagram showing airflow or ventilation process on a computer monitor with numbered annotations

3 Remove the air filter. Grip the tab of the air filter, and pull it straight out.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the air filter - 2

natural_image Illustration of hands installing a blue filter component on a computer keyboard (no text or symbols visible)

4 With the front (the side with tabs) of the air filter facing down, tap the air filter four or five times to shake off the dust. Turn it over and tap the other side in the same way.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the air filter - 3

natural_image Illustration of a hand holding a blue rectangular object with a rotating arrow, no text or symbols present

Attention

If the air filter is hit too hard, it may become unusable due to deformities and cracks.

5 Remove any dust remaining on the air filter by using a vacuum cleaner from the front side.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

natural_image Line drawing of a pipette dispensing liquid into a grid-lined rectangular container (no text or symbols)

6 Replace the air filter.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

natural_image Diagram of a computer monitor with a blue rack and ventilation panel, showing airflow direction (no text or symbols)

7 Close the air filter cover and tighten the fixing screws.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 3

text_image Diagram showing airflow or ventilation process on a device with numbered annotations indicating steps ① and ②.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 4

  • If a message is frequently displayed, even after cleaning, it is time to replace the air filter. Replace it with a new air filter.
    "Replacing the Air Filter" p.208
  • It is recommended that you clean the air filter every 20,000 hours. Clean it more often than this if using the projector in a particularly dusty environment.
  • The indicators or messages regarding Air Filter Notice are displayed only when Air Filter Notice is set to On from the Configuration menu.
    Extended - Display - Air Filter Notice p.146

Cleaning the air intake vent

1 After you turn off the projector's power and the confirmation buzzer beeps, disconnect the power cord.
2 Use a vacuum cleaner or a soft brush to carefully remove the dust.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cleaning the air intake vent - 1

natural_image Line drawing of a projector with a magnified inset showing a screen (no text or symbols)

Replacing Consumables

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Replacing Consumables - 1

208

This section explains how to replace the air filter.

Replacing the Air Filter

Air filter replacement period

If the message is displayed frequently even though the air filter has been cleaned, replace the air filter.

Replacing the air filter

The air filter can be replaced even when the projector is suspended from a ceiling.

1 After you turn off the projector's power and the confirmation buzzer beeps, disconnect the power cord.

2 Loosen the fixing screws and open the air filter cover.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Replacing the air filter - 1

text_image Diagram showing airflow or ventilation process on a computer monitor with labeled components ① and ②

3 Remove the air filter.

Grip the tab of the air filter, and pull it straight out.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Replacing the air filter - 2

natural_image Illustration of hands installing a blue filter component on a computer monitor (no text or symbols visible)

4 Install the new air filter.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Replacing the air filter - 3

natural_image Diagram of a blue heat exchanger mounted on a metal rack, with no visible text or symbols

5 Close the air filter cover and tighten the fixing screws.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Replacing the air filter - 4

text_image Diagram showing airflow or ventilation process on a device with numbered annotations indicating steps ① and ②.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Replacing the air filter - 5

Dispose of used air filters properly in accordance with your local regulations.

Material of the frame part: Polypropylene

Material of the filter part: Polypropylene

Panel Alignment

Adjusts the pixel color shift for the LCD panel. You can adjust the pixels horizontally and vertically by 0.125 pixels within a range of ±3 pixels.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Panel Alignment - 1

  • Image quality may decline after performing LCD alignment.
  • Images for pixels that extend beyond the edge of the projected screen are not displayed.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Display from Extended.
3 Select Panel Alignment, and then press the [←] button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Panel Alignment - 2

text_image [Display] Return Menu Position Message Position Top Messages Off Display Background Off Startup Screen Off Standby Confirmation Off Air Filter Notice Off Screen Panel Alignment Color Uniformity OSD Rotation Off [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

4 Enable Panel Alignment.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Panel Alignment - 3

text_image [Panel Alignment] Return Signal Settings Extended Select Color R Pattern Color R/G/B Start Adjustments Reset Network Info Reset [Esc] :Return [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

(1) Select Panel Alignment, and then press the [←] button.
(2) Select On, and then press the [←] button.
(3) Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

5 Select the color you want to adjust.

(1) Select Select Color, and then press the [←] button.
(2) Select R (red) or B (blue), and then press the [←] button.
(3) Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

6 Select the grid color displayed when making adjustments from Pattern Color.

(1) Select Pattern Color, and then press the [←] button.

Image Maintenance

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Image Maintenance - 1

(2) Select a combination of R (red), G (green), and B (blue) for the grid color.

R/G/B: Displays a combination all three colors; red, green and blue. The actual color of the grid is white.

R/G: This is available when R is selected from Select Color. Displays a combination of two colors; red and green. The actual color of the grid is yellow.

G/B: This is available when B is selected from Select Color. Displays a combination of two colors; green and blue. The actual color of the grid is cyan.

(3) Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.

7 Select Start Adjustments, and then press the [◀] button. First, select Shift the whole panel to adjust the entire LCD panel. When the start confirmation message is displayed, press the◀] button to start adjustment.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Image Maintenance - 2

The image may become distorted while adjusting. The image is restored once adjustments are complete.

8 Use the [▲][▼][◀][▶] buttons to make adjustments, and then press the ⏻ button.

9 To perform more detailed adjustments, select Adjust the four corners, and then press the button to confirm.

10 Use the [▲], [▼], [◀], and [▶] buttons to make adjustments, and then press the [◀] button to move to the next adjustment point.

11 When you have adjusted all four corners, select Exit, and then press the 📁 button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Image Maintenance - 3

text_image [Panel Alignment] Adjustment complete. To make finer adjustments, you can also select any intersection and then adjust. Select intersection and adjust Exit ⚙ [◆]:Select [●]:Enter [Menu]:Exit

If you feel you still need to make adjustments after correcting all four points, select Select intersection and adjust and then continue making adjustments.

Color Uniformity

Adjusts the color tone for the whole screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Uniformity - 1

The color tone may not be uniform even after performing color uniformity.

1 Press the Menu button while projecting.
2 Select Display from Extended.
3 Select Color Uniformity, and then press the [←] button. The following screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Uniformity - 2

text_image [Color Uniformity] Return Color Uniformity Off Adjustment Level Start Adjustments Reset Extended Network Info Reset [Esc] /[●]:Return [◆]:Select [Menu]:Exit

Color Uniformity: Turns color uniformity on or off.

Adjustment Level: There are eight levels from white, through gray, and up to black. You can adjust each level individually.

Start Adjustments: Starts adjusting color uniformity.

Reset: Resets all adjustments and settings for Color Uniformity to their default values.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Uniformity - 3

The image may become distorted while adjusting Color Uniformity. The image is restored once adjustments are complete.

4 Select Color Uniformity, and then press the [←] button.
5 Set to On, and then press the Esc button.
6 Select Adjustment Level, and then press the [←] button.
7 Use the [ ][ ] buttons to set the adjustment level.
8 Press the Esc button to return to the previous screen.
9 Select Start Adjustments, and then press the [←] button.
10 Select the area you want to adjust, and then press the [] button.

Adjust the outer areas first, and then adjust the whole screen.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Uniformity - 4

text_image [Color Uniformity] Top Left Top Top Right Right Bottom Right Bottom Bottom Left Left All Return

11 Use the [▲][▼] buttons to select the color you want to adjust, and then use the ⬆[▶]buttons to adjust.

Press the [◀] button to weaken the color tone. Press the [ ] button to strengthen the color tone.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Uniformity - 5

text_image [Color Uniformity] All Adjustment Level Red 0 Green 0 Blue 0

[Default] :Reset [○]:Switch Background

12 Return to step 6 and adjust each level.
13 To complete the adjustment, press the Menu button.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Color Uniformity - 6

Appendix

Epson Projector Management

Epson Projector Management lets you carry out operations such as checking the status of multiple Epson projectors that are connected to a network at a computer monitor, and controlling the projectors from the computer.

Download the Epson Projector Management software from the following website.

http://www.epson.com

Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)

By using a Web browser of a computer or mobile device connected to the projector on a network, you can set functions and control the projector. This function allows you to perform setup and control operations remotely.

You can use the following Web browsers.

  • Internet Explorer 11.0 or later (except for Metro) (Windows)
  • Microsoft Edge (Windows)
    •Safari (Mac)
  • Chrome (Android)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control) - 1

If you set Standby Mode to Communication On, you can use the Web browser to make settings and perform control even if the projector is in standby mode (when the power is off).

Extended - Standby Mode p.146

Displaying the Epson Web Control Screen

Use the following procedure to display the Epson Web Control screer. Make sure your device and projector are ready for the network connection.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Epson Web Control Screen - 1

If your Web browser is set up to connect via a proxy server, the Epson Web Control screen cannot be displayed. To display Web Control, you need to make settings so that a proxy server is not used for a connection.

1 Connect your device to the same network as the connected projector.

The connection method varies depending on the device. See the manual supplied with your device for details. When using a mobile device, check the Wi-Fi settings.

2 Start the Web browser on your device.

3 Connect by entering the address of the connected projector in the URL field of the Web browser.

The Home screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Epson Web Control Screen - 2

text_image 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Read Control Data Source Path Lyme Control Text Patterns Text Information Designer Connected Arrayset

1 Basic Control

"Basic Control Screen" p.216

② Lens Control

"Lens Control Screen" p.218

③ Status Information

"Status Information Screen" p.220

4 Advanced

You are moved to the Advanced screen.

⑤ Crestron Connected

"About Crestron Connected®" p.228

6 Test Pattern

"Test Pattern Operation Screen" p.219

7 OSD Control Pad

"OSD Control Pad Screen" p.217

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Displaying the Epson Web Control Screen - 3

- When performing the functions from the Home screen, you may be prompted to enter the user name and password. When the login screen is displayed, enter your user name and password. (The user name is EPSONWEB; the default password is admin.)

- You cannot change the user name. You can change the password in the Network menu from the Configuration menu.

Network - Basic - Web Control Password p.153

- You must enter the user name for Web Control Password even when the password is disabled.

- You can only set the following items from the Advanced screen.

Monitor Password (up to 16 single-byte alphanumeric characters)

Network - Basic - Monitor Password p.153

IPv6 Settings (Manual)

Network - IPv6 Settings p.154, p.157

Add HTTP port (for the port number used for Web control, use anything except for 80 (default), 843, 3620, 3621, 3625, 3629, 4352, 4649, 5357, 10000, 10001, 41794)

Network - Others p.159

Basic Control Screen

You can perform basic projector operations.

When the login screen is displayed, enter your user name and password.

(The user name is EPSONREMOTE; the default password is guest.)

Monitoring and Controlling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 2

text_image ① ② ③ ④ HDMI HDMI HDBT DVI-D BNC

① Moves to the Home screen.
② Turns the projector on.
③ Switches to the target image.
4 Turns the video and audio on or off.
⑤ Automatically detects the input signal.
6 Turns the projector off.

OSD Control Pad Screen

You can operate the Configuration menu of the projector.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - OSD Control Pad Screen - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4 5 6 QSO Control Panel 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40

① Moves to the Home screen.
② Displays and closes the Configuration menu.
③ You can operate the Configuration menu using your finger or mouse. Flick to select an item, and tap to confirm the selection.
4 Enabled when Default: Reset is displayed on the Configuration menu guide. The settings being adjusted are returned to their default values.
⑤ Returns to the previous menu level in the Configuration menu.
6 Displays information on using the OSD Control Pad.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - OSD Control Pad Screen - 2

Items in the Configuration menu that cannot be set in Epson Control are listed below.

  • Image menu - Advanced - Gamma - Custom
  • Signal menu - Advanced - BNC Sync Termination, EDID, DDC Buffer
  • Settings menu - HDMI Link, User Button, Content Playback
    •Extended menu - Display - Message Position
    •Extended menu - User's Logo
  • Extended menu - Operation - Advanced - Lens Type
  • Extended menu - Operation - Lens Calibration
    •Extended menu - Language
    •Network menu - Search Access Point, Crestron Connected
    The settings for items on each menu are the same as the projector's Configuration menu.
    "Configuration Menu" p.135

Lens Control Screen

You can operate the lens of the projector.

Focus/Distortion Operation Screen

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Lens Control Screen - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4 5 Laser Sensitive - + - + - Project Function Screw Lens Shell Tool Trigger Memory 6 7 8 9 10

① Moves to the Home screen.
② Move the slider to adjust the focus.
③ Press the buttons to adjust the focus.
4 Move the slider to adjust image warping.
⑤ Press the buttons to adjust image warping.
6 Displays the Focus / Distortion operation screen.
⑦ Displays the Zoom operation screen.
⑧ Displays the Lens Shift operation screen.
9 Displays the Test Pattern operation screen.
⑩ Displays the Memory operation screen.
* This is not available for ELPLU02.

Zoom Operation Screen

This is not available for ELPLX01, ELPLX01W, and ELPLR04.

Monitoring and Controlling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 2

text_image ① ② T W Focal Diameter Size Left Shift Top Shift None

① Move the slider to adjust the zoom.
② Press the buttons to adjust the zoom.

Lens Shift Operation Screen
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 3

text_image C Hense Laser Shift ① ② V-Shift D H-Shift D ③ < 3 4 Penset / Subset Zoom Lock Shift Text Pattern Sensor

① Displays the position of the image as a blue square. When you move the image position, a red square is displayed at the destination.
② Displays the vertical image position. You can directly specify the position by tapping it and entering a number.
③ Moves the image position up, down, left, or right.

4 Moves the lens position to the home position if you press the OK button in the confirmation screen.
⑤ Displays the horizontal image position. You can directly specify the position by tapping it and entering a number.

Test Pattern Operation Screen
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 4

text_image C Name Test Pattern Check ① ② 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100

① Displays a test pattern.
② Closes the test pattern.

Memory Operation Screen

See the following for memory function details.

"Memory Function" p.110

Monitoring and Controlling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 1

220

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 2

text_image 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100

① Loads a memory.
② Saves a memory.
③ Displays a list of memories.
4 Erases a memory.
⑤ Changes a memory name.

Status Information Screen

You can check the projector's status. See the following for display details.

"Reading the Status Display" p.182

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Status Information Screen - 1

text_image ① ② ③ ④ Data Information Data To Print/Export Auto Tools Auto Tools Auto Tools Auto Tools

1 Moves to the Home screen.
② Displays the item name.
③ Displays the status of each item.
4 Selects a category from the following. Status Information, Source, Signal Information, Network Wired, Network Wireless, Maintenance, Version, Air Temp Info

Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Content Playback Mode)

In Content Playback mode, you can use a Web browser to set and control network projectors, and edit playlists.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Content Playback Mode) - 1

You can also control projectors using a Web browser from Epson iProjection (iOS/Android).

Attention

Do not remove the USB flash drive from the projector or unplug the power cord in the following situations. Otherwise, data on the USB flash drive may be corrupted.

●While viewing the Playlist screen
●While viewing the USB flash drive screen

1 Make sure that the projector is in Content Playback mode.

2 Connect your device to the same network as the connected projector.

3 Start the Web browser on your device. Enter the IP address of the projector in the address input box of the browser to connect to the Epson Web Control screen. When entering an IPv6 address, enclose the address in square brackets [].

The Epson Web Control screen is displayed.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["1"] --> B["Remote"]
    B --> C["Playlists"]
    C --> D["USB Memory Device"]
    E["2"] --> F["Time Table"]
    F --> G["OSD Control Pad"]
    G --> H["Lens Control"]
    I["3"] --> J["Test Patterns"]
    J --> K["Status Information"]
    K --> L["Creation Connected"]
    M["4"] --> N["Advanced"]
    O["5"] --> P["Developer's Menu"]
    Q["6"] --> R["Developer's Menu"]
    S["7"] --> T["Developer's Menu"]
    U["8"] --> V["Developer's Menu"]
    W["9"] --> X["Developer's Menu"]
    Y["10"] --> Z["Developer's Menu"]

① You can use this to operate the projector remotely.
② Edit the playlist you want to play in Content Playback mode.
③ Displays the Timetable screen.
4 Operate the Configuration menus using your finger or mouse.
⑤ Displays a test pattern.
6 Displays the projector's status.
⑦ Make advanced settings for the projector.
⑧ Displays the Crestron Connected operation screen. This is only enabled when using Crestron Connected.
9 Operate the lens of the projector.
⑩ Save the data for your playlists to a USB flash drive.

4 Select the item you want to use.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Attention - 2

You may need to login to set options on the Epson Web Control screen. When the login screen is displayed, enter your user name and password.

(The user name is EPSONWEB; the default password is admin.)

- You can change the password in Web Control Password from the Network.

Network - Network Configuration - Basic - Web Control Password p.153

- You can only set the following items from Advanced. - Monitor Password (up to 16 single-byte alphanumeric characters)

- IPv6 Settings (Manual)

- Add HTTP port (for the port number used for Web control, use anything except for 0 (default), 843, 3620, 3621, 3625, 3629, 4352, 4649, 5357, 10000, 10001, 41794)

Remote

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Remote - 1

text_image Home Remote Source Select HDMI HDBaseT DVI-D Computer BNC USB LAN A/V Note Volume - + Overlay Effect Favorite Playlists

① Moves to the Epson Web Control home screen.
② Turns the projector on or off.
③ Selects the input source.
Turns the video and audio on or off temporarily.
⑤ Selects your favorite playlist.
6 Turns Overlay Effect on or off.
⑦ Adjusts the volume for the speakers.

Monitoring and Controlling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 1

Playlists

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Playlists - 1

text_image Home Playlists Add New 1 2 3 4 playlist A 1 ... playlist B 2 ... playlist C 3 ... playlist D 4 ...

① Moves to the Epson Web Control home screen.
② Controls playback of the playlist.
③ Edits the playlist.
4 Creates a new playlist.

USB Memory Device

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - USB Memory Device - 1

text_image Home USB Memory Device Free Space on USB Memory Device Upload Data Delete Data Uploaded Data

① Moves to the Epson Web Control home screen.
② Saves photos and videos you want to add to your playlists to the USB flash drive.
③ Deletes photos and videos from the USB flash drive.

Time Table

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Time Table - 1

text_image Home Time Table Time Table Time Table (20:18:00:19) 07:00-12:00 1 playtot A 12:00-18:00 2 playtot B 18:00-21:30 3 playtot C playtot B

1 Moves to the Epson Web Control home screen.
② Turns the timetable on or off.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Time Table - 2

The timetable feature in Epson Projector Content Manager to specify when the playlist will be played.

See the "Epson Projector Content Manager Operation Guide" for details.

OSD Control Pad

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - OSD Control Pad - 1

text_image 1 2 Name GSD Control Pad 3 BSS 6 5 4 Default

① Moves to the Epson Web Control home screen.
② Displays the Configuration menu.
③ Operate the menus using your finger or mouse.
4 Enabled when Default: Reset is displayed on the menu guide. The settings being adjusted are returned to their default values.
⑤ Returns to the previous menu.

Displays the help topics.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - OSD Control Pad - 2

See the following for items in the Configuration menu that cannot be set in Epson Web Control.

"OSD Control Pad Screen" p.217

Using the Mail Notification Function to Report Problems

When you set Mail Notification, notification messages are sent to the preset email addresses when a problem or warning occurs with a projector. This will enable the operator to be notified of problems with projectors even at locations away from the projectors.

Network - Notifications - Mail Notification p.158

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Using the Mail Notification Function to Report Problems - 1

  • Up to a maximum of three notification destinations (addresses) can be registered, and notification messages can be sent to all three destinations at once.
  • If a projector develops a critical problem and suddenly stops working, it may not be able to send a message notifying an operator of the problem.
  • If you set Standby Mode to Communication On, you can control the projector even if it is in standby mode (when the power is off).

Extended - Standby Mode p.146

Reading error notification mail

When the Mail Notification function is set to On and a problem or warning occurs in the projector, the following email will be sent.

Sender: The email address set in From

Subject: EPSON Projector

Line 1: The projector name where the problem has occurred

Line 2: The IP address set for the projector where the problem has occurred.

Line 3 and on: Details of the problem

The details of the problem are listed line by line. The main message contents are listed below.

  • Clean Air Filter
  • Constant brightness expired (Constant Bright. End)
  • Internal error
  • Fan related error
  • Sensor error
  • Laser error (Laser Error/Laser Does Not Turn On)
  • Laser warning
    •Retardation Plate Error
  • Internal temperature error
    •High-speed cooling in progress
  • Low Air Flow
  • Low Air Flow Error
  • No-signal

No Signal is input to the projector. Check the connection status or check that the power for the signal source is turned on.

- Lens shift error

- No lens

See the following to deal with problems or warnings.

"Reading the Indicators" p.175

Management Using SNMP

By setting SNMP to On in the Configuration menu, notification messages are sent to the specified computer when a problem or warning occurs. This allows you to check for problems with projectors even at locations away from the projectors.

Network Notifications SNMP p.158

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Management Using SNMP - 1

•SNMP should be managed by a network administrator or someone who is familiar with the network.

•To use the SNMP function to monitor the projector, you need to install the SNMP manager program on your computer.

•The SNMP Agent for this projector complies with version 1 (SNMPv1).

•The managing function using SNMP cannot be used over wireless LAN in Quick connection mode.

•Up to two destination IP addresses can be saved.

ESC/VP21 Commands

You can control the projector from an external device using ESC/VP21.

Command list

When the power ON command is transmitted to the projector, the power turns on and it enters warm-up mode. When the projector's power has turned on, a colon ":" (3Ah) is returned.

When a command is input, the projector executes the command and returns a ":", and then accepts the next command.

If the command being processed terminates abnormally, an error message is output and a ":" is returned.

The main contents are listed below.

Item Command
Power ON/OFFOn PWR ON
Off PWR OFF
Signal selectionComputer Auto SOURCERCE 1F
RGB SOURCE 11
Component SOURCE 14
BNC Auto SOURCEBF
RGB SOURCE B1
Component SOURCE B4
HDMI SOURCE 30
USBSOURCE 52
LANSOURCE 53
DVI-DSOURCE A0
IIDBaseTSOURCE 80
A/V Mute On/OffOn MUTE ON
Off MUTE OFF

Add a Carriage Return (CR) code (0Dh) to the end of each command and transmit.

For more details, contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.

Epson Projector Contact List

Cable layouts

Serial connection

- Connector shape: D-Sub 9-pin (male)

-Projector input port name: RS-232C

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Cable layouts - 1

text_image RS-232C IOIOI

(PC serial cable)

GND55GND
TD33TD
RD22RD
Signal Name Function
GNDSignal wire ground
TDTransmit data
RDReceive data

Communications protocol

  • Default baud rate setting: 9600 bps
    •Data length: 8 bit
  • Parity: None
    -Stop-bit: 1 bit
  • Flow control: None

PJLink was established by the JBMIA (Japan Business Machine and Information System Industries Association) as a standard protocol for controlling network-compatible projector's as part of their efforts to standardize projector control protocols.

The projector complies with the PJLink Class2 standard established by the JBMLA.

The port number used by the PJLink search function is 4352 (UDP).

You need to make network settings before you can use PJLink. See the following for more information on network settings.

"Network Menu" p.151

It complies with all commands except for the following commands defined by PJLink Class2, and agreement was confirmed by the PJLink standard adaptability verification.

URL: http://pjlink.jbmia.or.jp/english/

•Non-compatible commands

Function PJLink Command
Mute settings Imagemuting set AVMT 11
Audio muting set AVMT 21

- Input ports and corresponding input source number

Input Port Name Input Source Number
Computer 11
BNC 13
DVI-D31
HDMI32
USB 41
LAN 52
HDBaseT 56
  • Manufacturer name displayed for "Manufacture name information query" EPSON
  • Model name displayed for "Product name information query" EPSON L1075U/L1070U

EPSON L1065U/L1060U

EPSON L1050U

EPSON L1070W

EPSON L1060W

EPSON L1070

About Crestron Connected®

Crestron Connected ^® is an integrated control system provided by Crestron ^® . It can be used to monitor and control multiple devices connected on a network.

The projector supports the control protocol, and can therefore be used in a system built with Crestron Connected

Visit the Crestron® Web site for details on Crestron Connected. (Only English-language displays are supported.)

https://www.crestron.com/products/line/crestron-connected

The following provides an overview of Crestron Connected

- Remote operation using a Web browser

You can operate a projector from your computer just like using a remote control.

•Monitoring and control with application software

You can use Crestron RoomView® Express/Crestron Fusion® provided by Crestron® to monitor devices in the system, to communicate with the help desk, and to send emergency messages.

This manual describes how to perform operations on your computer using a Web browser.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - About Crestron Connected® - 1

  • You can only enter single-byte alphanumeric characters and symbols.
  • The Message Broadcasting feature for Epson Projector Management is unavailable while using Crestron Connected
  • If you set Standby Mode to Communication On, you can control the projector even if it is in standby mode (when the power is off).
    Extended - Standby Mode p.146

Operating a projector from your computer

Displaying the operation window

Check the following before carrying out any operations.

  • Make sure the computer and projector are connected to the network.
  • Set Crestron Connected to On from the Network menu.

Network - Others - Crestron Connected p.159

1 Start the Web browser on the computer.

Monitoring and Controlling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 1

229

2 Enter the IP address of the projector in the address field of the Web browser, and press the Enter key on the keyboard. The Epson Web Control home screen is displayed.
3 Press Crestron Connected. The operation window is displayed.

Using the operation window

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 2

text_image EPSON (a) (b) (c) (d) Sources List Computer1 Computer2 SBC Video2 SMTM Menu Esc Go Add Delete Expenses Options

① You can perform the following operations when you click the buttons.

Button Function
Power Turns the projectorpower on or off.
Vol-/Vol+ Adjusts the volume.
Button Function
A/V Mute Turns the videoand audio on or off. "Hiding the Image and Sound Temporarily (A/V Mute)" p.102

② Switch to the image from the selected input source. To display input sources that are not shown in Source List, click (a) or (b) to scroll up or down. The current video signal input source is displayed in blue. You can change the source name if necessary.
3 You can perform the following operations when you click the buttons. To display buttons that are not shown in Source List, click (c) or (d) to scroll left or right.

Button Function
Freeze Images are paused or unpaused."Freezing the Image (Freeze)" p.103
Contrast Adjusts the difference between light and shade in the images.
Brightness Adjusts the image brightness.
Color Adjusts the color saturation for the images.
Sharpness Adjusts the image sharpness.
ZoomClick the [∅] button to enlarge the image without changing the projection size. Click the [∅] button to reduce the image that was enlarged with the [∅] button. Click the [▲] [▼] [▼buttons to change the position of an enlarged image. "Enlarging Part of the Image (E-Zoom)" p.104

④ The [▲] [▼] [◀] [▶] buttons perform the same operations as the [▲] [▼] [◀] [▶] buttons on the remote control. You can perform the following operations when you click the other buttons.

Monitoring and Controlling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 1

Button Function
OKPerforms the same operation as the [ ↙] button on the remote control.⇨ "Remote Control" p.20
Menu Displays and closes the Configuration menu.
AutoIf clicked while projecting analog RGB signals from the Computer port, you can automatically optimize Tracking, Sync., and Position.
Search Changes to the next input source that is sending an image.⇨ "Automatically Detecting Input Signals and Changing the Projected Image (Source Search)" p.61
Esc Performs the same operation as the [Esc] button on the remote control.⇨ "Remote Control" p.20

5 You can perform the following operations when you click the tabs.

Tab Function
Help Displays the Help Deskwindow. Used to send messages to, and receive messages from, the administrator using Crestron Connected®.
Info Displays informationon the projector that is currently connected.
Tools Changes settings inthe projector that is currently connected. See the next section.

Using the tools window

The following window is displayed when you click the Tools tab on the operation window. You can use this window to change settings in the projector that is currently connected.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 2

text_image EPSON Creation Control Projector User Password P Address: 182.1664.0 Projector Name: E80001.54 Location: EPSON Added To: 2008 Add To: New Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Users\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password C:\Items\Password D:\Users\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password D:\Items\Password E36

1 Crestron Control

Make settings for Crestron ^® central controllers.

② Projector

The following items can be set.

Item Function
Projector NameEnter a name to differentiate the projector that is currently connected from other projectors on the network. (The name can contain up to 15 single-byte alphanumeric characters.)
Location Enter an installation location name for the projector that is currently connected on the network. (The name can contain up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters and symbols.)
Assigned ToEnter a user name for the projector. (The name can contain up to 32 single-byte alphanumeric characters and symbols.)

Monitoring and Controlling

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Monitoring and Controlling - 1

231

Item Function
DHCP Select the Enabledcheck box to use DHCP. You cannot enter an IP address if DHCP is enabled.
IP AddressEnter the IP address to assign to the currently connected projector.
Subnet Mask Enter a subnetmask for the currently connected projector.
Default Gateway Enter the gateway address for the currently connected projector.
Scnd Click this button to confirm the changes made to the Projector.

3 Admin Password

Select the Enabled check box to require a password to open the Tools window. The following items can be set.

Item Function
New Password Enter the new password when changing the password to open the Tools window. (The name can contain up to 26 single-byte alphanumeric characters.)
ConfirmEnter the same password as you entered in New Password. If the passwords are not the same, an error is displayed.
Scnd Click this button to confirm the changes made to the Admin Password.

4 User Password

Select the Enabled check box to require a password to open the operation window on the computer. The following items can be set.

Item Function
New Password Enter the new password when changing the password to open the operation window. (The name can contain up to 26 single-byte alphanumeric characters.)
Confirm Enter the same password as you entered in New Password. If the passwords are not the same, an error is displayed.
Send Click this button to confirm the changes made to the User Password.

About Web API

You can use Web API to operate the projector when Content Playback mode is enabled.

You can enable Web API from a Web browser.

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - About Web API - 1

You can apply API authentication (Digest authentication) to Web API communications.

The user name for API authentication is EPSONWEB; the password is the Web Control Password.

1 Open the Epson Web Control home screen in your Web browser.
2 Press Developer's Menu.
3 Set Enable API to On.

"Changing Settings Using a Web Browser (Epson Web Control)" p.215

The following Web API commands are supported by the projector.

URL Supported methods Explanation
http://api/v01/contentmgr/remote/power/onGET/POST/PUTTurns on the projector.It takes a while for the Web API to respond.
http://api/v01/contentmgr/remote/power/offGET/POST/PUTTurns off the projector.
http://api/v01/contentmgr/playlist/play/:idGET/POST/PUTPlays the playlist with the specified ID.Enter the playlist ID in :id. You can check the playlist ID from the Developer's Menu on the home screen.
http://api/v01/contentmgr/playlist/stopGET/POST/PUTStops the playlist.

Enter the projector's IP address in .

For example, the following URL commands the projector with the IP address 192.168.0.2 to play the playlist with the ID 3.

http://192.168.0.2/api/v01/contentmgr/playlist/play/3

If secure HTTP is enabled, change the http in the URL to https.

Optional Accessories and Consumables

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Optional Accessories and Consumables - 1

The following optional accessories and consumables are available. Please purchase these products as and when needed. The following list of optional accessories and consumables is current as of: June 2019. Details of accessories are subject to change without notice and availability may vary depending on the country of purchase.

Optional Accessories

Lens unitELPLX01, ELPLX01W, ELPLU03, ELPLU04, ELPLW05, ELPLW06, ELPLW08, ELPLM08, ELPLM10, ELPLM11, ELPLM15, ELPLL08See the following for more information on the projection distance lens."Screen Size and Projection Distance" p.234
Computer cable ELPKC02(1.8 m - for mini D-Sub15-pin/mini D-Sub 15pin)
Computer cable ELPKC09(3 m - for mini D-Sub15-pin/mini D-Sub 15pin)Computer cable ELPKC10(20 m - for mini D-Sub15-pin/mini D-Sub 15pin)
Remote control cable set ELPKC28(10 m 2 piece set)Use this to guarantee operation from the remote control from a distance.
HDBaseT Transmitter ELPHD01This transmitter performs long distance transmissions for HDMI signals an control signals for one LAN cable. Based on the HDBaseT standard. (HDCP 2.2 is not supported.)
Wireless LAN unit ELPAP10Use when connecting the projector to a computer wirelessly and projecting (Frequency band: 2.4 GHz)

Polarizer ELPPL01

Use this when stacking two projectors and projecting 3D images.

Passive 3D Glasses (standard five piece set) ELPGS02A

Passive 3D Glasses (five piece set for children) ELPGS02B

Passive polarized 3D glasses. Use these when viewing 3D images with two projectors.

Document Camera ELPDC13, ELPDC21

Use when projecting images such as books, OHP documents, or slides.

Pipe 450 (450 mm) ^* ELPFP13

Pipe 700 (700 mm) ^* ELPFP14

Use when installing the projector on a high ceiling.

Ceiling mount\* ELPMB22

Low ceiling mount* ELPMB47

High ceiling mount* ELPMB48

Use when installing the projector on a ceiling. Do not use for any other purpose.

* Special techniques are required to suspend the projector from a ceiling. Contact your local dealer or the nearest address provided in the Epson Projector Contact List.

Epson Projector Contact List

Consumables

Air filters ELPAF46

Use as a replacement for used air filters.

Projection Distances for EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U/EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Air filters ELPAF46 - 1

text_image Diagram illustrating a geometric or optical setup with labeled components and measurement lines

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Air filters ELPAF46 - 2

text_image Diagram showing a geometric setup with labeled components and shaded triangular region, likely illustrating a perspective or projection system.

① Projection distance
② is the distance from the center of the lens to the base of the screen. This changes depending on the setting for vertical lens shift.
③ Center of lens

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Air filters ELPAF46 - 3

If the screen is larger than 300 inches, fine text and images may not be displayed clearly.

ELPLM08

This section shows the projection distances for models equipped with standard lenses.

Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45" 100x75 156 to 253 -81 to +12
50" 102x76 174 to 281 -90 to +13
60" 122x91 210 to 338 -108 to +16
80" 163x122 281 to 453 -143 to +22
100" 203x152 353 to 567 -179 to +27
120" 244x183 424 to 681 -215 to +32
150" 305x229 532 to 853 -269 to +40
200" 406x305 711 to 1139 -359 to +54
250" 508x381 890 to 1424 -448 to +67
300" 610x457 1069 to 1710 -538 to +81
500" 1016x7621785 to 2853-896 to +134
800"1626x12192858 to 4568-1434 to +215
1000"2032x15243574 to 5711-1793 to +269

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61154 to 250 -76to +15
50" 111x62157 to 255 -78to +16
60" 133x75190 to 307 -94to +19

Screen Size and Projection Distance

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Screen Size and Projection Distance - 1

235

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
80" 177x100 255 to 411 -125 to +25
100" 221x125 320 to 514 -156 to +31
120" 266x149 385 to 618 -187 to +38
150" 332x187 482 to 774 -234 to +47
200" 413x249 645 to 1033 -312 to +63
250" 553x311 807 to 1293 -390 to +78
300" 664x374 970 to 1552 -468 to +94
500" 1107x623 1620 to 2590 -779 to +157
800" 177x996 2595 to 4147 -1247 to +251
1000" 221x1245 3244 to 5185 -1559 to +313

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50"108x67153 to 248-79 to +12
60"130x81185 to 298-95 to +14
80" 172x108 248 to 399 -127 to +19
100" 215x135 311 to 500 -158 to +24
120" 258x162 374 to 601 -190 to +29
150" 323x202 469 to 753 -238 to +36
200" 431x269 627 to 1005 -317 to +48
250" 538x337 785 to 1258 -396 to +59
300" 646x404 943 to 1510 -475 to +71
500" 1077x673 1576 to 2520 -792 to +119
16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
800"1723x1077 2524 to 4035 -1267 to +190
1000" 2154x1346 3157 to 5044 -1584 to +238

ELPLX01/ELPLX01W

Zoom is not supported.

Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Vertical lens shiftBottom to Top
89" 181x136740 to +24
100" 203x152840 to +27
120" 244x183 1020 to +32
150" 305x229 1290 to +40
200" 406x305 1730 to +54
250" 508x381 2180 to +67
300" 610x457 2620 to +81
350" 711x533 3070 to +94
500" 1016x762 4400 to +134
800"1626x12197080 to +205

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Vertical lens shiftBottom to Top
98" 217x12274+7 to +31
16:9 Screen Size12
Vertical lens shiftBottom to Top
100" 221x125 76 +7 to +31
120" 266x149 92 +8 to +38
150" 332x187 116 +10 to +47
200" 443x249 157 +14 to +63
250" 553x311 197 +17 to +78
300" 664x374 238 +21 to +94
350" 775x436 278 +24 to +110
500" 1107x623 399 +35 to +157
800" 1771x996 642 +55 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Vertical lens shiftBottom to Top
100" 215x135 74 0 to +24
120" 258x162 89 0 to +29
150" 323x202 113 0 to +36
200" 431x269 152 0 to +48
250" 538x337 192 0 to +59
300" 646x404 231 0 to +71
350" 754x471 270 0 to +83
400" 862x538 310 0 to +95
500" 1077x673 388 0 to +119
800" 1723x1077 625 0 to +190
1000"2154x1346 782 0 to +238

ELPLU03
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
71"144x108112 to 135 -127 to +19
80"163x122126 to 152 -143 to +22
100" 203x152159 to 191 -179 to +27
120" 244x183191 to 230 -215 to +32
150" 305x229240 to 289 -269 to +40
200" 406x305321 to 386 -359 to +54
250" 508x381403 to 483 -448 to +67
300" 610x457484 to 581 -538 to +81
500" 1016x762809 to 971 -896 to +134
800" 1626x12191297 to 1555-1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
78"173x97111 to 134 -122 to +24
80"177x100114 to 138 -125 to +25
100" 221x125144 to 173 -156 to +31
120" 266x149173 to 209 -187 to +38
150" 332x187218 to 262 -234 to +47
200" 443x249291 to 350 -312 to +63
250" 553x311365 to 439 -390 to +78
300" 664x374439 to 527 -468 to +94
500" 1107x623 734 to 881-779 to +157
800° 1771x996 1177 to 1412-1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
80" 172x108 111 to 134 -127 to +19
100" 215x135 140 to 168 -158 to +24
120" 258x162 169 to 203 -190 to +29
150" 323x202 212 to 255 -238 to +36
200" 431x269 283 to 341 -317 to +48
250" 538x337 355 to 427 -396 to +59
300" 646x404 427 to 513 -475 to +71
500" 1077x673 714 to 857 -792 to +119
800" 1723x1077 1145 to 1373 -1267 to +190
1000" 2154x1346 1432 to 1717 -1584 to +238

ELPLU04/ELPLU02
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45"100x7593 to 113-81 to +12
50"102x76104 to 126-90 to +13
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
60"122x91126 to 153 -108 to +16
80" 163x122 170 to 205 -143 to +22
100" 203x152 214 to 258 -179 to +27
120" 244x183 258 to 311 -215 to +32
150" 305x229 324 to 390 -269 to +40
200" 406x305 434 to 522 -359 to +54
250" 508x381 543 to 654 -448 to +67
300" 610x457 653 to 786 -538 to +81
500" 1016x762 1092 to 1313-896 to +134
800" 1626x1219 1751 to 2105 -1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49"108x6192 to 112-76 to +15
50"111x6294 to 114-78 to +16
60"133x75114 to 138-94 to +19
80" 177x100 154 to 186 -125 to +25
100" 221x125 194 to 234 -156 to +31
120" 266x149 234 to 282 -187 to +38
150" 332x187 293 to 354 -234 to +47
200" 443x249 393 to 473 -312 to +63
250" 553x311 493 to 593 -390 to +78
300" 664x374 592 to 713 -468 to +94
500" 1107x623 991 to 1192-779 to +157
800" 1771x996 1589 to 1910-1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x57 91 to 111 -79 to +12
60" 130x81 111 to 134 -95 to +14
80" 172x108 149 to 181-127 to +19
100"215x135 188 to 227-158to +24
120"258x162 227 to 274-190to +29
150"323x202 285 to 344-238to +36
200"431x269 382 to 460-317to +48
250"538x337 479 to 577-396to +59
300"646x404 576 to 693-475to +71
500" 1077x673 964 to 1159-792 to +119
800"1723x10771546 to 1858-1267 to +190
1000"2154x13461934 to 2324-1584 to +238

ELPLW05
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45" 100x75 111 to 158 -81 to +12
50" 102x76 124 to 176 -90 to +13
60" 122x91 150 to 212-108 to +16
80" 163x122 203 to 285-143 to +22
100"203x152 255 to 357-179 to +27
120"244x183 308 to 430-215 to +32
150"305x229 387 to 539-269 to +40
200"406x305 519 to 720-359 to +54
250"508x381 650 to 902-448 to +67
300"610x457782 to 1083-538 to +81
500" 1016x762 1308 to 1809-896 to +134
800"1626x12192097 to 2898 -1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61109 to 156 -76to +15
50" 111x62112 to 159 -78to +16
60" 133x75136 to 192 -94to +19
80" 177x100183 to 258-125 to +25
100"221x125 231to 324-156 to +31
120"266x149 279to 390-187 to +38
150" 332x187 351 to 489 -234 to +47
200" 443x249 470 to 653 -312 to +63
250" 553x311 590 to 818 -390 to +78
300" 664x374 709 to 983 -468 to +94
500" 1107x623 1187 to 164-779 to +157
800" 1771x996 1903 to 263-1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x67 109 to 155 -79 to +12
60" 130x81 132 to 187 -95 to +14
80" 172x108 178 to 251 -127 to +19
100" 215x135 225 to 315 -158 to +24
120" 258x162 271 to 379 -190 to +29
150" 323x202 341 to 475 -238 to +36
200" 431x269 457 to 636 -317 to +48
250" 538x337 573 to 796 -396 to +59
300" 646x404 690 to 956 -475 to +71
500" 1077x673 1154 to 1597 -792 to +119
800" 1723x10771852 to 2559 -1267 to +190
1000"2154x13462317 to 3201 -1584 to +238

ELPLW06/ELPLW04
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45"97x61175 to 240 -81 to +12
50" 102x76 195 to 267 -90 to +13
60" 122x91 236 to 322 -108 to +16
80" 163x122 317 to 432 -143 to +22
100" 203x152 398 to 543 -179 to +27
120" 244x183 479 to 653 -215 to +32
150" 305x229 600 to 818 -269 to +40
200" 406x305 803 to 1094-359 to +54
250" 508x381 1005 to 1369-448 to +67
300" 610x457 1207 to 1645-538 to +81
500" 1016x762 2017 to 2747 -896 to +134
800" 1626x1219 3232 to 4400 -1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61173 to 237 -76 to +15
50" 111x62176 to 242 -78 to +16
60" 133x75213 to 292 -94 to +19
80" 177x100287 to 392 -125 to +25
100" 221x125360 to 492 -156 to +31
120" 266x149434 to 592 -187 to +38
150" 332x187 544 to 742 -234 to +47
200" 443x249 728 to 992 -312 to +63
250" 553x311 912 to 1242 -390 to +78
300" 664x374 1096 to 1492-468 to +94
500" 1107x623 1831 to 2493-779 to +157
800" 1771x996 2934 to 3994-1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x67172 to 235-79 to +12
60" 130x81207 to 284-95 to +14
80"172x108 279 to 381 -127 to +19
100" 215x135 350 to 478 -158 to +24
120" 258x162 422 to 576 -190 to +29
150" 323x202 529 to 722 -238 to +36
200" 431x269 708 to 965 -317 to +48
250" 538x337 887 to 1208 -396 to +59
300" 646x404 1066 to 1452 -475 to +71
500" 1077x673 1781 to 2425 -792 to +119
800"1723x10772854 to 3885 -1267 to +190
1000"2154x13463569 to 4859 -1584 to +238

ELPLW08
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45" 100x75127 to 179-81 to +12
60" 122x91171 to 240 -108 to +16
80"163x122 229 to 322 -143 to +22
100" 203x152 288 to 404 -179 to +27
120" 244x183 346 to 486 -215 to +32
150" 305x229 434 to 609 -269 to +40
200" 406x305 580 to 813 -359 to +54
250" 508x381 726 to 1018 -448 to +67
300" 610x457 872 to 1223 -538 to +81
500" 1016x762 1457 to 2042 -896 to +134
800"1626x12192334 to 3270 -1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61125 to 177-76 to +15
60" 133x75154 to 218-94 to +19
80"177x100 208 to 292 -125 to +25
100" 221x125 261 to 366 -156 to +31
120" 266x149 314 to 441 -187 to +38
150" 332x187 393 to 552 -234 to +47
200" 443x249 526 to 738 -312 to +63
250" 553x311 659 to 924 -390 to +78
300" 664x374 792 to 1110 -468 to +94
500" 1107x623 1323 to 1853 --779 to +157
800" 1771x996 2119 to 2969 --1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x67 124 to 175 -79to +12
60" 130x81 150 to 212 -95to +14
80"172x108 202to 284 -127 to +19
100" 215x135 253 to 356 -158 to +24
120" 258x162 305 to 429 -190 to +29
150" 323x202 383 to 537 -238 to +36
200" 431x269 512 to 718 -317 to +48
250" 538x337 641 to 899 -396 to +59
300" 646x404 770 to 1080 -475 to +71
500" 1077x673 1287 to 1803-792 to +119
800"1723x10772061 to 2888 -1267 to +190
1000"2154x13462578 to 3611 -1584 to +238

ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45" 100x75 233 to 379 -81 to +12
50" 102x76 260 to 422 -90 to +13
60" 122x91 313 to 508 -108 to +16
80"163x122 420 to 679 -143 to +22
100" 203x152 527 to 851 -179 to +27
120" 244x183 635 to 1023 -215 to +32
150" 305x229 795 to 1281 -269 to +40
200" 406x3051063 to 1711-359 to +54
250" 508x3811331 to 2140-448 to +67
300" 610x4571598 to 2570-538 to +81
500" 1016x762 2669 to 4288 -896 to +134
800"1626x12194276 to 6866 -1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61 230 to 374 -76 to +15
50" 111x62 235 to 382 -78 to +16
60" 133x75 284 to 460 -94 to +19
80"177x100 381 to 616 -125 to +25
100" 221x125 478 to 772 -156 to +31
120" 266x149 575 to 928 -187 to +38
150" 332x187 721 to 1162-234 to +47
200" 443x249 964 to 1552-312 to +63
250" 553x311 1207 to 1942-390 to +78
300" 664x374 1450 to 2332-468 to +94
500" 1107x623 2423 to 3893-779 to +157
800" 1771x996 3881 to 6233-1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x67 229 to 372 -79 to +12
60" 130x81 276 to 447 -95 to +14
80"172x108370 to 599-127 to +19
100" 215x135465 to 751-158 to +24
120" 258x162560 to 903-190 to +29
150" 323x202 702 to 1131-238 to +36
200" 431x269 938 to 1510-317 to +48
250" 538x337 1175 to 1890-396 to +59
300" 646x404 1411 to 2269-475 to +71
500" 1077x673 2357 to 3787-792 to +119
800"1723x10773776 to 6064 -1267 to +190
1000"2154x13464722 to 7582 -1584 to +238

ELPLM10/ELPLM06
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45" 100x75 359 to 549 -81 to +12
50" 102x76 400 to 611 -90 to +13
60" 122x91 483 to 736-108 to +16
80"163x122648 to 986-143 to +22
100" 203x152 813 to 1236 -179 to +27
120" 244x183 979 to 1485 -215 to +32
150" 305x229 1227 to 1860 -269 to +40
200" 406x305 1640 to 2484 -359 to +54
250" 508x381 2053 to 3109 -448 to +67
300" 610x457 2466 to 3733 -538 to +81
500" 1016x762 4119 to 6230 -896 to +134
800"1626x12196598 to 9976 -1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61355 to 542 -76 to +15
50" 111x62362 to 554 -78 to +16
60" 133x75437 to 667 -94 to +19
80"177x100587 to 894-125 to +25
100" 221x125737 to 1121 -156 to +31
120" 266x149887 to 1347 -187 to +38
150" 332x187 1112 to 1687-234 to +47
200" 443x249 1488 to 2254-312 to +63
250" 553x311 1863 to 2821-390 to +78
300" 664x374 2238 to 3388-468 to +94
500" 1107x623 3738 to 565-779 to +157
800" 1771x996 5989 to 905-1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x67 352 to 538 -79 to +12
60" 130x81 425 to 649 -95 to +14
80" 172x108 571 to 869-127 to +19
100" 215x135 717 to 1090-158 to +24
120" 258x162 863 to 1311-190 to +29
150" 323x202 1082 to 1641 -238 to +36
200" 431x269 1447 to 2193 -317 to +48
250" 538x337 1812 to 2744 -396 to +59
300" 646x404 2177 to 3296 -475 to +71
500" 1077x673 3637 to 5502 -792 to +119
800"1723x10775827 to 8811 -1267 to +190
1000"2154x13467287 to 11017-1584 to +238

ELPLM11/ELPLM07
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45" 100x75 521 to 799 -81 to +12
50" 102x76 582 to 890 -90 to +13
60" 122x91 703 to 1073-108 to +16
80" 163x122 945 to 1438-143 to +22
100" 203x152 1188 to 1804-179 to +27
120" 244x183 1430 to 2169-215 to +32
150" 305x229 1793 to 2717-269 to +40
200" 406x305 2399 to 3631-359 to +54
250" 508x381 3005 to 4544-448 to +67
300" 610x457 3610 to 5458-538 to +81
500" 1016x762 6033 to 9112-896 to +134
800"1626x12199667 to 14594-1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61515 to 789 -76to +15
50" 111x62526 to 806 -78to +16
60" 133x75636 to 972 -94to +19
80" 177x100856 to 1304-125 to +25
100" 221x1251076 to 1635-156 to +31
120" 266x1491296 to 1967-187 to +38
150" 332x187 1626 to 2465-234 to +47
200" 443x249 2176 to 3294-312 to +63
250" 553x311 2726 to 4124-390 to +78
300" 664x374 3276 to 4953-468 to +94
500" 1107x623 5475 to 827-779 to +157
800" 1771x996 8774 to 13248 -1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x67 511 to 784 -79 to +12
60" 130x81 618 to 945 -95 to +14
80" 172x108 832 to 1268-127 to +19
100" 215x135 1046 to 1591-158 to +24
120" 258x162 1260 to 1913-190 to +29
150" 323x202 1581 to 2398-238 to +36
200" 431x269 2116 to 3205-317 to +48
250" 538x337 2651 to 4012-396 to +59
300" 646x404 3186 to 4819-475 to +71
500" 1077x673 5326 to 8047-792 to +119
800"1723x10778536 to 12889 -1267 to +190
1000"2154x134610676 to 16117-1584 to +238

ELPLL08/ELPLL07
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
45" 100x75776 to 1095-81 to +12
50" 102x76866 to 1220-90 to +13
60" 122x911046 to 1470 -108 to +16
80" 163x122 1405 to 1971-143 to +22
100" 203x152 1764 to 2472-179 to +27
120" 244x183 2124 to 2972-215 to +32
150" 305x229 2662 to 3724-269 to +40
200" 406x305 3561 to 4975-359 to +54
250" 508x381 4459 to 6227-448 to +67
300" 610x457 5357 to 7479-538 to +81
500" 1016x762 8949 to 12485-896 to +134
800"1626x121914338 to 19996-1434 to +215

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
49" 108x61767 to 1082-76 to +15
50" 111x62784 to 1105-78 to +16
60" 133x75947 to 1332-94 to +19
80" 177x100125 to +25
100" 221x1251599 to 2241-156 to +31
120" 266x1491925 to 2696-187 to +38
150" 332x187 2414 to 3378-234 to +47
200" 443x249 3230 to 4514-312 to +63
250" 553x311 4045 to 5650-390 to +78
300" 664x374 4860 to 6787-468 to +94
500" 1107x623 8122 to 11333 -779 to +157
800" 1771x996 13014 to 18151 -1247 to +251

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 108x67 761 to 1074 -79 to +12
60" 130x81 920 to 1295 -95 to +14
80" 172x108 1237 to 1737 -127 to +19
100" 215x135 1555 to 2180 -158 to +24
120" 258x162 1872 to 2622 -190 to +29
150" 323x202 2348 to 3285 -238 to +36
200" 431x269 3141 to 4391 -317 to +48
250" 538x337 3935 to 5497 -396 to +59
300" 646x404 4728 to 6602 -475 to +71
500" 1077x673 7901 to 110 25 -792 to +119
800"1723x107712661 to 17659 -1267 to +190
1000"2154x134615834 to 22082 -1584 to +238

ELPLR04

Zoom and lens shift are not supported.

Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
45"91x69102-34
50"102x76114-38
60"122x91138-46
80"163x122186-61
100"203x152234-76
120"244x183282-91
150"305x229354-114
200"406x305473-152
250"508x381593-191
300"610x457713-229
500"1016x7621193-381
800"1626x12191912-610

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
49"108x61101-30
50"111x62103-31
60"133x75124-37
80"177x100168-50
100"221x125212-62
120"266x149255-75
150"332x187320-93
200"443x249429-125
250" 553x311 538 -156
300" 664x374 647 -187
500" 1107x623 1082 -311
800" 1771x996 1735 -498

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
50" 108x67 100 -34
60" 130x81 121 -40
80" 172x108 163 -54
100" 215x135 206 -67
120" 258x162 248 -81
150" 323x202 312 -101
200" 431x269 417 -135
250" 538x337 523 -168
300" 646x404 629 -202
500" 1077x673 1053 -337
800" 1723x1077 1688 -538
1000" 2154x1346 2112 -673

Projection Distances for EB-L1070
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - ELPLR04 - 1

text_image ① ② ③

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - ELPLR04 - 2

text_image Diagram showing a geometric setup with labeled components and shaded triangular region, likely illustrating a physics or engineering concept.

1 Projection distance
② is the distance from the center of the lens to the base of the screen. This changes depending on the setting for vertical lens shift.
③ Center of lens

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - ELPLR04 - 3
If the screen is larger than 300 inches, fine text and images may not be displayed clearly.

ELPLM08

This section shows the projection distances for models equipped with standard lenses.

Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 147 to 239 -82 to +6
60" 122x91 178 to 288 -98 to +7
80" 163x122 239 to 385 -131 to +9
100" 203x152 299 to 482 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 360 to 580 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 452 to 726 -246 to +17
200" 406x305 604 to 969 -328 to +23
250" 508x381 756 to 1213 -410 to +29
300" 610x457 908 to 1456 -492 to +35
500" 1016x7621517 to 2430-820 to +58
800"1626x12192431 to 3891-1312 to +93
1000"2032x15243040 to 4865-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 148 to 240 -73 to +15
50" 111x62 161 to 261 -79 to +17
60" 133x75 194 to 314 -95 to +20
80" 177x100 260 to 420 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 327 to 526 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 393 to 632 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 493 to 791 -237 to +50
16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
200" 443x249 658 to 1057-316 to +67
250" 553x311 824 to 1322-395 to +83
300" 664x374 990 to 1587-474 to +100
500" 1107x623 1654 to 2648-789 to +167
800" 1771x996 2649 to 4240-1263 to +267
1000" 2214x1245 3312 to 5301-1579 to +334

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 150 to 243-77 to +12
50" 108x67 156 to 254-80 to +13
60" 130x81 189 to 305-96 to +15
80"172x108253 to 408-128 to +21
100" 215x135318 to 512-160 to +26
120" 258x162382 to 615-192 to +31
150" 323x202479 to 770-241 to +39
200" 431x269 640 to 1028321 to +51
250" 538x337 802 to 1286401 to +64
300" 646x404 963 to 1544481 to +77
500" 1077x673 1609 to 2576-802 to +129
800"1723x1077 2577to 4125 -1283 to +206
1000" 215x1x1346 3223 to 5157 -1603 to +257

ELPLX01/ELPLX01W

Zoom is not supported.

4:3 Screen Size12
Vertical lens shiftBottom to Top
100" 203x152710 to +12
120" 244x183860 to +14
150" 305x2291090 to +17
200" 406x3051470 to +23
250" 508x3811850 to +29
300" 610x4572230 to +35
350" 711x5332610 to +40
400" 813x6102990 to +46
500" 1016x762 3750 to +58
800"1626x1219 6030 to +93
1000" 203x1524 7550 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Vertical lens shiftBottom to Top
92"204x11571+19 to +31
100" 221x12577+21 to +33
120" 266x14994+25 to +40
150" 332x187119+31 to +50
200" 443x249160+42 to +67
250" 553x311202+52 to +83
300" 664x374243+62 to +100
350" 775x436 285 +73 to +117
500" 1107x623 409 +104 to +167
800" 1771x996 657 +166 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Vertical lens shiftBottom to Top
95" 205x128 71 +13 to +24
100" 215x135 75 +13 to +26
120" 258x162 91 +16 to +31
150" 323x202 116 +20 to +39
200" 431x269 156 +27 to +51
250" 538x337 196 +34 to +64
300" 646x404 236 +40 to +77
350" 754x471 277 +47 to +90
500" 1077x673 398 +67 to +129
800" 1723x1077 639 +108 to +206

ELPLU03
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
80" 163x122 107 to 129 -131 to +9
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
100" 203x152 134 to 162 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 162 to 196 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 204 to 245 -246 to +17
200" 406x305 273 to 328 -328 to +23
250" 508x381 342 to 411 -410 to +29
300" 610x457 411 to 494 -492 to +35
500" 1016x762687 to 826 -820 to +58
800" 1626x12191101 to 1323-1312 to +93
1000"2032x15241377 to 1655-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
74"164x92108 to 130 -117 to +25
80" 177x100 117 to 141 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 147 to 177 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 177 to 213 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 222 to 268 -237 to +50
200" 443x249 297 to 358 -316 to +67
250" 553x311 373 to 448 -395 to +83
300" 664x374 448 to 539 -474 to +100
500" 1107x623749 to 900 -789 to +167
800" 1771x9961200 to 1442-1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
76" 164x102 108 to 130 -122 to +20
80" 172x108 113 to 137 -128 to +21
100" 215x135 143 to 172 -160 to +26
120" 258x162 172 to 208 -192 to +31
150" 323x202 216 to 260 -241 to +39
200" 431x269 289 to 348 -321 to +51
250" 538x337 362 to 436 -401 to +64
300" 646x404 436 to 524 -481 to +77
500" 1077x673 728 to 876802 to +129
800" 1723x1077 1168 to 1403 -1283 to +206

ELPLU04/ELPLU02
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 88 to 107 -82 to +6
60" 122x91 107 to 129-98 to +7
80" 163x122 144 to 174-131 to +9
100" 203x152 181 to 219 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 219 to 264 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 275 to 332 -246 to +17
200" 406x305 368 to 444 -328 to +23
250" 508x381 462 to 557 -410 to +29
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
300" 610x457 555 to 669 -492 to +35
500" 1016x762929 to 1119 -820 to +58
800" 1626x1219 1490 to 1794-1312 to +93
1000"2032x1524 1864 to 2244 -1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 88 to 107-73 to +15
50" 111x62 96 to 117-79 to +17
60" 133x75117 to 141-95 to +20
80" 177x100 157 to 191 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 198 to 240 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 239 to 289 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 300 to 362 -237 to +50
200" 443x249 402 to 485 -316 to +67
250" 553x311 504 to 607 -395 to +83
300" 664x374 606 to 730 -474 to +100
500" 1107x6231013 to 1220-789 to +167
800" 1771x9961624 to 1955 -1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 90 to 109 -77 to +12
50" 108x67 93 to 114 -80 to +13
60" 130x81 113 to 138 -96 to +15
80" 172x108 153 to 185 -128 to +21
100" 215x135 193 to 233 -160 to +26
120" 258x162 232 to 281 -192 to +31
150" 323x202 292 to 352 -241 to +39
200" 431x269 391 to 471 -321 to +51
250" 538x337 490 to 591 -401 to +64
300" 646x404 589 to 710 -481 to +77
500" 1077x673 985 to 1187 -802 to +129
800" 1723x1077 1580 to 1902 -1283 to +206

ELPLW05
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 104 to 149 -82 to +6
60" 122x91 127 to 180 -98 to +7
80" 163x122 171 to 242 -131 to +9
100" 203x152 216 to 303 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 261 to 365 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 328 to 458 -246 to +17
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
200" 406x305 440 to 612 -328 to +23
250" 508x381 552 to 767 -410 to +29
300" 610x457 664 to 922 -492 to +35
500" 1016x762112 to 1540 -820 to +58
800" 1626x12191784 to 2467-1312 to +93
1000"2032x15242232 to 3086-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 104 to 149 -73 to +15
50" 111x62 114 to 163 -79 to +17
60" 133x75 139 to 196 -95 to +20
80" 177x100 187 to 264 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 236 to 331 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 285 to 398 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 358 to 499 -237 to +50
200" 443x249 480 to 668 -316 to +67
250" 553x311 602 to 836 -395 to +83
300" 664x374724 to 1005 -474 to +100
500" 1107x6231212 to 1678-789 to +167
800" 1771x9961944 to 2689-1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 106 to 151 -77to +12
50" 108x67 111 to 158 -80to +13
60" 130x81 135 to 191 -96to +15
80" 172x108 182 to 256 -128to +21
100" 215x135 230 to 322 -160to +26
120" 258x162 277 to 387 -192to +31
150" 323x202 348 to 486 -241to +39
200" 431x269 467 to 650 -321to +51
250" 538x337 586 to 813 -401to +64
300" 646x404 704 to 977 -481to +77
500" 1077x673 1179 to 1633-802 to +129
800" 1723x1077 1891 to 2616-1283 to +206

ELPLW06/ELPLW04
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 165 to 227-82 to +6
60" 122x91 199 to 274-98 to +7
80" 163x122 268 to 368 -131 to +9
100" 203x152 337 to 461 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 406 to 555 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 509 to 696 -246 to +17
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
200" 406x305 682 to 930 -328 to +23
250" 508x381854 to 1164-410 to +29
300" 610x4571026 to 1398-492 to +35
500" 1016x762 1715 to 2336-820 to +58
800" 1626x1219 2749 to 3741 -1312 to +93
1000"2032x1524 3438 to 4678 -1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 165 to 228 -73 to +15
50" 111x62 180 to 248 -79 to +17
60" 133x75 218 to 299 -95 to +20
80" 177x100 293 to 401 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 368 to 503 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 443 to 605 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 556 to 759 -237 to +50
200" 443x249743 to 1014-316 to +67
250" 553x311931 to 1269-395 to +83
300" 664x3741119 to 1524 -474 to +100
500" 1107x623 1869 to 2545 -789 to +167
800" 1771x996 2995 to 4076 -1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 98x73168 to 231 -77 to +12
50" 108x67175 to 241 -80 to +13
60" 130x81212 to 291 -96 to +15
80" 172x108285 to 390 -128 to +21
100" 215x135358 to 489 -160 to +26
120" 258x162431 to 589 -192 to +31
150" 323x202540 to 738 -241 to +39
200" 431x269723 to 986 -321 to +51
250" 538x337906 to 1234 -401 to +64
300" 646x4041088 to 1483 -481 to +77
500"1077x6731818 to 2476-802 to +129
800"1723x10772914 to 3966-1283 to +206

ELPLW08
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 120 to 169-82 to +6
60" 122x91 145 to 204-98 to +7
80" 163x122 194 to 273 -131 to +9
100" 203x152 244 to 343 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 294 to 413 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 368 to 517 -246 to +17
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
200" 406x305 493 to 692 -328 to +23
250" 508x381 617 to 866 -410 to +29
300" 610x457 741 to 1040 -492 to +35
500"1016x7621238 to 1737 -820 to +58
800"1626x12191984 to 2782-1312 to +93
1000"2032x15242481 to 3479-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 120 to 169 -73 to +15
60" 133x75 158 to 222 -95 to +20
80" 177x100 212 to 298 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 266 to 374 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 320 to 450 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 402 to 564 -237 to +50
200" 443x249 537 to 754 -316 to +67
250" 553x311 672 to 944 -395 to +83
300" 664x374 808 to 1134 -474 to +100
500"1107x6231349 to 1893-789 to +167
800"1771x9962162 to 3032-1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 122 to 172 -77to +12
60" 130x81 154 to 216 -96to +15
80" 172x108 206 to 290 -128 to +21
100" 215x135 259 to 364 -160 to +26
120" 258x162 312 to 438 -192 to +31
150" 323x202 391 to 549 -241 to +39
200" 431x269 522 to 733 -321 to +51
250" 538x337 654 to 918 -401 to +64
300" 646x404 786 to 1103481 to +77
500" 1077x673 1313 to 184-802 to +129
800" 1723x10772103 to 2950-1283 to +206

ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 219 to 358-82 to +6
60" 122x91 265 to 431-98 to +7
80" 163x122 356 to 578 -131 to +9
100" 203x152 447 to 724 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 538 to 870 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 674 to 1090 -246 to +17
200" 406x305 902 to 1456 -328 to +23
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
250" 508x381129 to 1822410 to +29
300" 610x4571357 to 2188492 to +35
500" 1016x762 2267 to 3652-820 to +58
800" 1626x12193632 to 5848 -1312 to +93
1000"2032x15244542 to 7312-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 220 to 359 -73 to +15
50" 111x62 240 to 391 -79 to +17
60" 133x75 289 to 471 -95 to +20
80" 177x100 389 to 630 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 488 to 790 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 587 to 949 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 736 to 1188 -237 to +50
200" 443x249 983 to 1587 -316 to +67
250" 553x311 1231 to 1986 -395 to +83
300" 664x374 1479 to 2385 -474 to +100
500" 1107x623 2471 to 3980 -789 to +167
800" 1771x996 3958 to 6372 -1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 223 to 364 -77to +12
50" 108x67 233 to 380 -80to +13
60" 130x81 281 to 458 -96to +15
80" 172x108 378 to 613 -128to +21
100" 215x135 474 to 768 -160to +26
120" 258x162 571 to 923 -192to +31
150" 323x202 715 to 1156 -241to +39
200" 431x269 957 to 1544 -321to +51
250" 538x337 1198 to 1932 -401to +64
300" 646x404 1439 to 2320 -481to +77
500" 1077x673 2403 to 3872-802 to +129
800"1723x10773850 to 6199-1283 to +206

ELPLM10/ELPLM06
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 338 to 519-82 to +6
60" 122x91 409 to 625-98 to +7
80" 163x122 549 to 838 -131 to +9
100" 203x152 690 to 1051 -164 to +12
120" 244x183 831 to 1264 -197 to +14
150" 305x229 1041 to 1583 -246 to +17
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
200" 406x305 1393 to 2115-328 to +23
250" 508x381 1744 to 2647-410 to +29
300" 610x457 2096 to 3179-492 to +35
500" 1016x762 3502 to 5307-820 to +58
800"1626x12195611 to 8499-1312 to +93
1000"2032x15247017 to 10627-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 339 to 520 -73 to +15
50" 111x62 370 to 567 -79 to +17
60" 133x75 446 to 682 -95 to +20
80" 177x100 600 to 914 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 753 to 1146 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 906 to 1378 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 1136 to 1726 -237 to +50
200" 443x249 1519 to 2305 -316 to +67
250" 553x311 1902 to 2885 -395 to +83
300" 664x374 2285 to 3465-474 to +100
500" 1107x623 3816 to 5783-789 to +167
800" 1771x996 6114 to 9261-1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 345 to 528 -77to +12
50" 108x67 360 to 551 -80to +13
60" 130x81 434 to 664 -96to +15
80" 172x108 583 to 889 -128to +21
100" 215x135 732 to 1115-160 to +26
120" 258x162 881 to 1340-192 to +31
150" 323x202 1105 to 1679-241 to +39
200" 431x269 1477 to 2243-321 to +51
250" 538x337 1850 to 2807-401 to +64
300" 646x404 2222 to 3370-481 to +77
500" 1077x673 3713 to 5626-802 to +129
800"1723x10775948 to 9010-1283 to +206

ELPLM11/ELPLM07
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76 492 to 755-82 to +6
60" 122x91 595 to 910-98 to +7
80" 163x122 801 to 1221-131 to +9
100" 203x152 1007 to 1533-164 to +12
120" 244x183 1213 to 1844-197 to +14
150" 305x229 1523 to 2311-246 to +17
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
200" 406x305 2038 to 3089-328 to +23
250" 508x381 2554 to 3867-410 to +29
300" 610x457 3069 to 4645-492 to +35
500" 1016x762 5131 to 7757-820 to +58
800"1626x12198224 to 12425-1312 to +93
1000"2032x152410286 to 15537-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57 493 to 756 -73 to +15
50" 111x62 538 to 824 -79 to +17
60" 133x75 650 to 994 -95 to +20
80" 177x100 875 to 1333 -126 to +27
100" 221x125 1100 to 1672 -158 to +33
120" 266x149 1324 to 2011 -189 to +40
150" 332x187 1661 to 2519 -237 to +50
200" 443x249 2223 to 3367 -316 to +67
250" 553x311 2784 to 4215 -395 to +83
300" 664x374 3346 to 5062 -474 to +100
500" 1107x623 5592 to 8453 -789 to +167
800" 1771x996 8962 to 13538 -1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 501 to 768 -77to +12
50" 108x67 523 to 801 -80to +13
60" 130x81 632 to 966 -96to +15
80" 172x108 851 to 1296 -128 to +21
100" 215x135 1069 to 1626-160 to +26
120" 258x162 1288 to 1956-192 to +31
150" 323x202 1616 to 2451-241 to +39
200" 431x269 2162 to 3275-321 to +51
250" 538x337 2708 to 4100-401 to +64
300" 646x404 3255 to 4925-481 to +77
500" 1077x673 5441 to 822-802 to +129
800" 1723x10778719 to 13171-1283 to +206

ELPLL08/ELPLL07
Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
50" 102x76732 to 1034 -82 to +6
60" 122x91885 to 1247 -98 to +7
80" 163x1221191 to 1674 -131 to +9
100" 203x1521497 to 2100 -164 to +12
120" 244x1831802 to 2527 -197 to +14
150" 305x2292261 to 3166 -246 to +17
4:3 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
200" 406x305 3025 to 4232-328 to +23
250" 508x381 3790 to 5298-410 to +29
300" 610x457 4554 to 6364-492 to +35
500" 1016x7627611 to 10627 -820 to +58
800" 1626x121912197 to 17023-1312 to +93
1000"2032x152415255 to 21287-1640 to +116

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
46" 102x57734 to 1037-73 to +15
50" 111x62801 to 1130-79 to +17
60" 133x75967 to 1362-95 to +20
80" 177x1001300 to 1826-126 to +27
100" 221x1251633 to 2291-158 to +33
120" 266x1491967 to 2755-189 to +40
150" 332x1872466 to 3452-237 to +50
200" 443x2493299 to 4613-316 to +67
250" 553x3114132 to 5775-395 to +83
300" 664x3744964 to 6939-474 to +100
500" 1107x6238295 to 11581-789 to +167
800" 1771x99613292 to 18549-1263 to +267

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
Minimum (Wide) to Maximum (Tele)Vertical lens shift Bottom to Top
48" 103x65 746 to 1053 -77 to +12
50" 108x67 778 to 1098 -80 to +13
60" 130x81 940 to 1324 -96 to +15
80" 172x108 1264 to 1776 -128 to +21
100" 215x135 1588 to 2228 -160 to +26
120" 258x162 1913 to 2680 -192 to +31
150" 323x202 2399 to 3358 -241 to +39
200" 431x269 3209 to 4488 -321 to +51
250" 538x337 4019 to 5618 -401 to +64
300" 646x404 4829 to 6748 -481 to +77
500" 1077x673 8070 to 11267 -802 to +129
800" 1723x1077 12931 to 18046 -1283 to +206

ELPLR04

Zoom and lens shift are not supported.

Unit: cm

4:3 Screen Size12
50"102x7696-38
60"122x91116-46
80"163x122157-61
100"203x152198-76
120"244x183239-91
150"305x229300-114
4:3 Screen Size12
200"406x305402-152
250"508x381504-191
300"610x457606-229
500"1016x7621015-381
800"1626x12191627-610
1000"2032x15242035-762

Unit: cm

16:9 Screen Size12
46"102x5796-29
50"111x62105-31
60"133x75127-37
80"177x100172-50
100"221x125216-62
120"266x149261-75
150"332x187327-93
200"443x249439-125
250"553x311550-156
300"664x374661-187
500"1107x6231106-311
800"1771x9961773-498

Unit: cm

16:10 Screen Size12
48"103x6598-32
50"108x67102-34
60"130x81124-40
16:10 Screen Size12
80" 172x108 167 -54
100" 215x135 210 -67
120" 258x162 254 -81
150" 323x202 318 -101
200" 431x269 427 -135
250" 538x337 535 -168
300" 646x404 643 -202
500" 1077x673 1076 -337
800" 1723x1077 1725 -538

Polarizer (ELPPL01) Installation Distance

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Polarizer (ELPPL01) Installation Distance - 1

text_image ① ② ③ ④

① Possible installation range of the polarizer
② Shortest distance from the projection lens to the polarizer
③ Longest distance from the projection lens to the polarizer
4 Polarizer (EI.PPI.01)

EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U
Units: mm

Lens type1
23
ELPLM08 140 170
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 120 170
ELPLW08 100 130
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04180 240
ELPLM10/ELPLM06260 340

EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W
Units: mm

Lens type1
23
ELPLM08 150 170
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 120 170
ELPLW08 100 130
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04200 240
ELPLM10/ELPLM06300 340

EB-L1070
Units: mm

Lens type1
23
ELPLM08 130 170
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 120 170

Screen Size and Projection Distance

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Screen Size and Projection Distance - 1

260

Lens type1
23
ELPLW08 100 130
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04170 240
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 230340

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

H/V-Keystone

"H/V-Keystone" p.65

Lens type Vertical Horizontal
ELPLM08 -45° to 45° -30° to 30°
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W -16° to 16° -16° to 16°
ELPLU03 -28° to 28° -28° to 28°
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 -35° to 35° -30° to 30°
ELPLR04 -34° to 34° -30° to 30°
ELPLW05 -40° to 40° -30° to 30°
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 -45° to 45° -30° to 30°
ELPLW08 -40° to 40° -30° to 30°
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS04-45° to 45° -30° to 30°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 -45° to 45° -30° to 30°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 -45° to 45° -30° to 30°
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 -45° to 45° -30° to 30°

Curved Surface

"Curved Surface" p.67

The values in the table are the minimum values for R/L in the illustration. (Approximate value when projecting at maximum zoom. ELPLR04 does not support lens shift.)

EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U/EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W

Horizontally curved surface (concave)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Curved Surface - 1

1 Screen

② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

L Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Top view

Lens type Vertical lens shift: EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Curved Surface - 2 Side viewVertical lens shift: Top EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Curved Surface - 3 Side view
ELPLM080.290.30
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W -2.74
ELPLU030.450.56
ELPLU04/ELPLU020.390.40
ELPLR040.37-
ELPLW050.350.37
ELPLW06/ELPLW040.260.27
ELPLW080.330.34
ELPI.M15/ELPI.M09/ ELPLS040.210.22
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.150.15

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

262

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 2Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 3Side view
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 0.11 0.11
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 0.08 0.08

Horizontally curved surface (convex)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 4

Screen
② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

I. Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Top view

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 5Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 6Side view
ELPLM08 0.58 0.62
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - 3.52
ELPLU03 2.13 2.31
ELPLU04/ELPLU021.27 1.37
ELPLR041.10 -
ELPLW050.95 1.01
ELPLW06/ELPLW040.49 0.52
ELPLW080.79 0.84
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS040.33 0.35
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.20 0.20
ELPLM11/ELPLM070.13 0.13
ELPLL08/ELPLL070.09 0.09

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

Vertically curved surface (concave)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 2

1 Screen
② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

I. Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Side view

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 3Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 4Side view
ELPLL08/ELPLL070.06 0.06
Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 5Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 6Side view
ELPLM08 0.21 0.25
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - 1.98
ELPLU03 0.37 0.67
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 0.31 0.43
ELPLR04 0.29
ELPLW05 0.27 0.35
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 0.19 0.22
ELPLW08 0.25 0.31
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS040.15 0.17
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.11 0.11
ELPLM11/ELPLM070.08 0.08

Vertically curved surface (convex)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 7

① Screen
② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

I. Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Side view

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 8Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 9Side view
ELPLL08/ELPLL070.06 0.06
Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 10Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 11Side view
ELPLM08 0.31 0.37
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - 3.52
ELPLU03 1.07 1.29
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 0.65 0.79
ELPLR04 0.57
ELPLW05 0.49 0.59
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 0.26 0.32
ELPLW08 0.42 0.50
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS040.18 0.22
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.12 0.13
ELPLM11/ELPLM070.08 0.09

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

EB-L1070

Horizontally curved surface (concave)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 1

① Screen
② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

L Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Top view

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 2Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 3Side view
ELPLM08 0.27 0.27
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - 1.66
ELPLU03 0.44 0.60
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 0.37 0.40
ELPLR04 0.35 -
ELPLW05 0.33 0.34
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 0.25 0.25
ELPLW08 0.31 0.32
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS040.20 0.20
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.14 0.14
ELPLM11/ELPLM070.11 0.11

Horizontally curved surface (convex)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 4
Top view

1 Screen
② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

I. Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Vertically curved surface (concave)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 5
Side view

Screen
② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

I. Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 6Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 7Side view
ELPLM08 0.52 0.54
FLPLX01/ELPLX01W - 3.52
ELPLU03 1.81 1.88
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 1.10 1.14
ELPLR04 0.95 -
ELPLW05 0.83 0.86
FLPLW06/ELPLW04 0.44 0.45
ELPLW08 0.70 0.72
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/FLPLS040.31 0.31
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.19 0.19
ELPLM11/ELPLM070.13 0.13
ELPLL08/ELPLL070.09 0.09
Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 8Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 9Side view
ELPLM08 0.22 0.28
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - 1.73
ELPLU03 0.37 0.65
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 0.320.46
ELPLR04-0.30
ELPLW05 0.280.38
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 0.200.25
ELPLW08 0.260.34
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS040.160.19
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.110.13
ELPLM11/ELPLM070.080.09

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 2Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 3Side view
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 0.06 0.07

Vertically curved surface (convex)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 4

Screen
② Center of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

I. Projection distance

R Radius of the circle of which the curved surface is an arc

Side view

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 5Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 6Side view
ELPLM08 0.34 0.44
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - 3.52
ELPLU03 1.08 1.57
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 0.66 0.94
ELPLR04 0.57 -
ELPLW05 0.50 0.71
ELPLW06/ELPLW040.29 0.37
ELPLW08 0.43 0.59
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS040.21 0.26
ELPLM10/ELPLM060.14 0.15
ELPLM11/ELPLM070.10 0.10

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

268

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 2Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 3Side view
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 0.07 0.07

Corner Wall

"Corner Wall" p.71

The in the figure is the maximum angle in which the projector can move. See the table below for detailed values. (Approximate value when projecting at maximum zoom. ELPLR04 does not support lens shift.)

EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U/EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W

Concave horizontal corner correction (correction to bilateral symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Corner Wall - 1

1 Screen

a Angle of possible projector motion

Top view

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Vertical lens shift: Top
Hom EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Corner Wall - 2 Side viewEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Corner Wall - 3 Side view
ELPLM08 31° 23°
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - -
ELPLU03 29° 9"
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 31° 14"
ELPLR0432°-
ELPLW0533° 18°
ELPLW06/ELPLW0431° 25°
ELPLW0832° 20°
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ ELPLS0430° 29°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 29° 29°

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 2Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 3Side view
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 29° 28°
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 28° 28°

Convex horizontal corner correction (correction to bilateral symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 4
Top view

① Screen

α Angle of possible projector motion

Lens type Vertical lensshift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 5Side viewVertical lens shift: Top EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 6Side view
ELPLM08 14' 13'
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W --
ELPLU03 0° *
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 6' 4'
Lens type Vertical lensshift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 7Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 8Side view
ELPLR04
ELPLW059° 8°
ELPLW06/ELPLW0416° 15°
ELPLW0811° 10°
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS0418° 18°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 22° 21°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 23° 23°
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 24°24°

*Cannot be corrected accurately. Move the lens position to the home position.

Concave vertical corner correction (correction to horizontal symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 9

1 Screen

a Angle of possible projector motion

Side view

Lens type Vertical lensshift: Hom EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 10 Side viewVertical lens shift: Top EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 11 Side view
ELPLM08 30° 12'
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - -
ELPLU03 33° *
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 31° 6'
ELPLR04 31° -
ELPLW0531° 10°
ELPLW06/ELPLW0428° 13°
ELPLW0831° 11°
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ ELPLS0426°14°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 24'16°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 23°18°
ELPLL08/ELPLL0723° 19°

^* Cannot be corrected accurately. Move the lens position to the home position.

Convex vertical corner correction (correction to horizontal symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 12

① Screen

α Angle of possible projector motion

Side view

Lens type Vertical lensshift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 13Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 14Side view
ELPLM08 19° 5°
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - -
ELPLU03*
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 14° *
ELPLR04 15° -
ELPLW0516° *
ELPLW06/ELPLW0420° 7°
ELPLW0817° 1°
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS0422°12°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 22°15°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 22°17°
ELPLL08/ELPLL0722°18°

*Cannot be corrected accurately. Move the lens position to the home position.

EB-L1070

Concave horizontal corner correction (correction to bilateral symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 1

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 2

Screen

α Angle of possible projector motion

Top view

Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 3Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 4Side view
ELPLM08 31° 21'
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - -
ELPLU03 26° 7'
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 29° 13'
ELPLR04 30° -
ELPLW05 31° 16'
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 31° 23"
ELPLW08 32° 18'
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS0430°27°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 29'29°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 29'29°
Lens type Vertical lens shift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 5Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 6Side view
ELPLL08/ELPLL0728'

Convex horizontal corner correction (correction to bilateral symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 7

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 8

Screen

a Angle of possible projector motion

Top view

Lens typeVertical lens shift: Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 9Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - EB-L1070 - 10Side view
ELPLM08 14°14"
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W --
ELPLU03*
ELPLU04/ELPLU02
ELPLR04-

Adjustment Range for Projected Images

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 1

Lens type Vertical lensshift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 2Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 3Side view
ELPLW05 10° 7°
ELPLW06/ELPLW04 16° 16°
ELPLW08 12° 10°
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS0419° 18°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 22° 21°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 23° 23°
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 24° 24°

*Cannot be corrected accurately. Move the lens position to the home position.

Concave vertical corner correction (correction to horizontal symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 4
Side view

① Screen

α Angle of possible projector motion

Lens type Vertical lensshift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 5Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 6Side view
ELPLM08 31° 14°
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W --
ELPLU0333°*
ELPLU04/ELPLU0232° 7°
ELPLR0432°-
ELPI.W05 31° 10°
ELPLW06/ELPLW0430° 16°
ELPI.W08 31° 12°
ELPI.M15/ELPI.M09/ELPLS0429° 17°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 27° 19°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 26° 21°
ELPLL08/ELPLL07 26° 22°

*Cannot be corrected accurately. Move the lens position to the home position.

Convex vertical corner correction (correction to horizontal symmetry by using corners as the center line)

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 7

1 Screen

a Angle of possible projector motion

Side view

Lens type Vertical lensshift:Home positionEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 8Side viewVertical lens shift: TopEPSON EB-L1065UNL - Adjustment Range for Projected Images - 9Side view
ELPLM08 18° 4°
ELPLX01/ELPLX01W - -
ELPLU03 6° *
ELPLU04/ELPLU02 12° *
ELPLR04 13° -
ELPLW0514° *
ELPLW06/ELPLW0419° 6°
ELPLW0816° 0°
ELPLM15/ELPLM09/ELPLS0421°11°
ELPLM10/ELPLM06 23°16°
ELPLM11/ELPLM07 24°19°
ELPLL08/ELPLL0725°21"

*Cannot be corrected accurately. Move the lens position to the home position.

Supported Monitor Displays

When the resolution of the input signals is larger than the projector's panel resolution, the image quality may decline. Signals with a check mark are supported.

PC

Signal FormatResolution (Dot)V Sync (Hz)Computer/BNC HDMI/HDBaseT DVI-D
RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr
4:4:4 4:2:2 4:2:0 4:4:4 4:2:2
81012810128101281012888
VGA64048060
72
75
85
SVGA80060060
72
75
85
XGA102476860
70
75
85
WXGA128076860
128080060
75
85
136676860
Signal FormatResolution (Dot)V Sync (Hz)Computer/BNC HDMI/HDBaseT DVI-D
RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr
4:4:4 4:2:2 4:2:0 4:4:4 4:2:2
8101281012810
WXGA+144090060
75
85
WXGA++160090060
SXGA115286470
75
85
128096060
75
85
1280102460
75
85
SXGA+1400105060
75
WSXGA+1680105060✓ *2, 3✓ *3✓ *3
UXGA1600120060
1920x10801920108050
60
WUXGA RB*11920120060✓ *4
QXGA2048153660✓ *4
WQIID2560144060✓ *4

Supported Monitor Displays

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Supported Monitor Displays - 1

276

Signal FormatResolution (Dot)V Sync (Hz)Computer/BNC HDMI/HDBaseT DVI-D
RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr
4:4:4 4:2:2 4:2:0 4:4:4 4:2:2
8101281012810
WQXGA RB*12560160060 ^4

*1 Based on VESA CVT-RB (Reduced Blanking)

*2 Only when Wide is selected in Resolution from the Signal menu

*3 EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U/EB-L1070W/EB-L1060W only

*4 EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only

SD

Signal FormatResolution (Dot)V Sync (Hz)Computer/BNC HDMI/HDBaseT DVI-D
RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr
4:4:4 4:2:2 4:2:0 4:4:4 4:2:2
8101281012810
SDTV (480i)72048059.94
SDTV (576i)72057650
SDTV (480p)72048059.94
SDTV (576p)72057650

HD

Signal FormatResolution (Dot)V Sync (Hz)Computer/BNC HDMI/HDBaseT DVI-D
RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr
4:4:4 4:2:2 4:2:0 4:4:4 4:2:2
8101281012810
HDTV (720p)128072050
Signal FormatResolution (Dot)V Sync (Hz)Computer/BNC HDMI/HDBaseT DVI-D
RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr
4:4:4 4:2:2 4:2:0 4:4:4 4:2:2
8101281012810
59.94
60
HDTV (1080i)1920108050
59.94
60
HDTV (1080p)1920108023.98
24
25
29.97
30
50
59.94
60

4K (EB-L1075U/EB-L1070U/EB-L1065U/EB-L1060U/EB-L1050U only)

Signal FormatResolution (Dot)V Sync (Hz)Computer/BNC HDMI/HDBaseT DVI-D
RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr RGB YCbCr
4:4:4 4:2:2 4:2:0 4:4:4 4:2:2
810128101281012
3840x21603840216023.98
24
25
29.97
30
50
59.94
60
4096x2160 SMPTE4096216023.98
24
25
29.97
30
50
59.94
60

Projector General Specifications

Product nameEB-L1075UEB-L1070UEB-L1065UEB-L1060UEB-L1050UEB-L1060U070W EB-L1060W EB-L1070
Dimensions545 (W) x 164 (H) x 436 (D) mm (not including raised section)
LCD panel size0.76" Wide 0.79"
Display methodPolysilicon TFT active matrix
Resolution2,304,000WUXGA (1920 (W) x 1200 (II) dots) x 31,024,000WXGA (1280 (W) x 800 (II) dots) x786,4323XGA (1024 (W) x 768 (II) dots) x 3
Focus adjustmentAutomatic
Zoom adjustment*1Automatic (1-1.6)
Lens shift *2Automatic (Maximum vertical direction of approx. 67%, Maximum horizontal direction of approx. 30%)*3Automatic (Maxi-mum vertical direc-tion of approx. 57%, Maximum horizontal direction of approx. 30%)*4
Light sourceLaser diode
Light source output power125W 104.5W104.5W 125W 104.5W125W
Wavelength449 - 461 nm
Light source life expectancy *5Approximately 20,000 hours (Light Source Mode: Normal, Medium, Quiet)Approximately 30,000 hours (Light Source Mode: Extended)
Power supply100-240V AC±10%50/60Hz 4.4-2.0A100-240V AC±10%50/60Hz 3.7-1.7A100-240V AC±10%50/60Hz 3.7-1.7A100-240V AC±10%50/60Hz 4.4-2.0A100-240V AC±10%50/60Hz 3.7-1.7A100-240V AC±10%50/60Hz 4.4-2.0A
Power consumption100 to 120 V areaRated power consumption: 439 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 361 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 361 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 439 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 361 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 439 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 W
220 to 240 V areaRated power consumption: 416 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 345 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 345 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 416 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 345 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 WRated power consumption: 416 WStandby power consumption (Communication On): 2.0 WStandby power consumption (Communication Off): 0.5 W
Operating altitudeAltitude 0 to 3,048 m
Operating temperature range0 to +45°C (Altitude of 0 to 2,286 m, no condensation)0 to +40°C (Altitude of 2,287 to 3,048 m, no condensation)
Storage temperature-10 to +60°C (No condensation)
Mass*1Approx. 16.9kg

*1 The specifications are when ELPLM08 is attached.
*2 ELPLR04 does not support lens shift.
*3 ELPLX01/ELPLX01W has a maximum vertical direction of approx. 17% and a maximum horizontal direction of approx. 10%.
*4 ELPLX01/ELPLX01W has a maximum vertical direction of approx. 7% and a maximum horizontal direction of approx. 8%.
*5 Approximate time until light source brightness is reduced by half.
(Assuming the projector is being used in an environment containing airborne particles of 0.04 to 0.2mg / m^3 . This is an approximate guide only and may change depending on the projector's usage and surroundings.)
*6 If the surrounding temperature gets too high, the brightness is automatically dimmed.
(Aproximately 40^ C at an altitude of 0 to 2,286 m, and approximately 35^ C at an altitude of 2,287 to 3,048 m; however, this may vary depending on the surroundings and so on.)

Specifications

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Specifications - 1

281

Product nameEB-L1075UEB-L1070UEB-L1065UEB-L1060UEB-L1050UEB-L1070W EB-L1060W EB-L1070
ConnectorsComputer Port 1Mini D-Sub15-pin (female) blue
Audio1 port 1Stereo mini jack (3.5Φ)
BNC port 15BNC (female)
Audio2 port 1Stereo mini jack (3.5Φ)
DVI-D port 1DVI-D 24pin Single link HDCP compatible
HDMI port 1HDMI HDCP2.2 supported (Audio is only supported by PCM)HDMI HDCP supported (Audio is only supported by PCM)
Audio3 port 1Stereo mini jack (3.5Φ)
Audio Out port1Stereo mini jack (3.5Φ)
Monitor Out port1Mini D-Sub15-pin (female) black
HDBaseT port1RJ-45 (HDCP2.2 supported)RJ-45 (HDCP supported)
LAN port1RJ-45
Service port*1USB connector (Type B)
RS-232C port1Mini D-Sub 9-pin (male)
Remote port1Stereo mini jack (3.5Φ)
USB port*1USB connector (Type A)

* Supports USB 2.0. However, USB ports are not guaranteed to operate all devices that support USB.

Specifications

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Specifications - 1

282

This product is also designed for IT power distribution system with phase-to-phase voltage 230V.

Supplier's DECLARATION of CONFORMITY

According to 47CFR, Part 2 and 15

Class B Personal Computers and Peripherals; and/or

CPU Boards and Power Supplies used with Class B Personal Computers

We: Epson America, Inc.

Located at: 3840 Kilroy Airport Way

Long Beach, CA 90806

Tel: 562-981-3840

Declare under sole responsibility that the product identified herein, complies with 47CFR Part 2 and 15 of the FCC rules as a Class B digital device. Each product marketed, is identical to the representative unit tested and found to be compliant with the standards. Records maintained continue to reflect the equipment being produced can be expected to be within the variation accepted, due to quantity production and testing on a statistical basis as required by 47CFR 2.906. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Trade Name: EPSON

Type of Product: LCD Projector

Model: H940C/H941C/H957C

Options: Product Name: Remote Controller

Model: 2173310 xx (x=0-9)

FCC Compliance Statement

For United States Users

This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures.

•Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
- Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
- Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
- Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.

WARNING

The connection of a non-shielded equipment interface cable to this equipment will invalidate the FCC Certification or Declaration of this device and may cause interference levels which exceed the limits established by the FCC for this equipment. It is the responsibility of the user to obtain and use a shielded equipment interface cable with this device. If this equipment has more than one interface connector, do not leave cables connected to unused interfaces. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

Appearance

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Appearance - 1

284

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Appearance - 2

text_image 189 272.5 545 89 ①

① Center of lens
② Distance from center of lens to suspension bracket fixing point

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Appearance - 3

text_image 494 348 322 4-M4x8 484 436 309 180 166 190 176 4-M6x14 458

Units: mm

General Notes

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - General Notes - 1

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Seiko Epson Corporation. No patent liability is assumed with respect to the use of the information contained herein. Neither is any liability assumed for damages resulting from the use of the information contained herein.

Neither Seiko Epson Corporation nor its affiliates shall be liable to the purchaser of this product or third parties for damages, losses, costs, or expenses incurred by the purchaser or third parties as a result of: accident, misuse, or abuse of this product or unauthorized modifications, repairs, or alterations to this product, or (excluding the U.S.) failure to strictly comply with Seiko Epson Corporation's operating and maintenance instructions.

Seiko Epson Corporation shall not be liable against any damages or problems arising from the use of any options or any consumable products other than those designated as Original Epson Products or Epson Approved Products by Seiko Epson Corporation.

The contents of this guide may be changed or updated without further notice.

Illustrations in this guide and the actual projector may differ.

Restriction of Use

When this product is used for applications requiring high reliability/safety such as transportation devices related to aviation, rail, marine, automotive etc.; disaster prevention devices; various safety devices etc; or functional/precision devices etc, you should use this product only after giving consideration to including fail-safes and redundancies into your design to maintain safety and total system reliability. Because this product was not intended for use in applications requiring extremely high reliability/safety such as aerospace equipment, main communication equipment, nuclear power control equipment, or medical equipment related to direct medical care etc, please make your own judgment on this product's suitability after a full evaluation.

About Notations

Microsoft® Windows Vista® operating system

Microsoft® Windows® 7 operating system

Microsoft® Windows® 8 operating system

Microsoft® Windows® 8.1 operating system

Microsoft® Windows® 10 operating system

In this guide, the operating systems above are referred to as "Windows Vista", "Windows 7", "Windows 8", "Windows 8.1", and "Windows 10". Furthermore, these may be referred to as the collective term Windows, and multiple versions of Windows may be referred to as, for example, Windows Vista/7/8/8.1/10, with the Windows notation omitted.

OS X 10.7.x

OS X 10.8.x

OS X 10.9.x

OS X 10.10.x

OS X 10.11.x

macOS 10.12.x

In this guide, the operating systems above are referred to as "OS X 10.7.x", "OS X 10.8.x", "OS X 10.9.x", "OS X 10.10.x", "OS X 10.11.x", and "macOS 10.12.x". Furthermore, the collective term "Mac" is used to refer to them all.

Trademarks and Copyrights

"EPSON" is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. "EXCEED YOUR VISION" is a trademark or registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation.

General Notes

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - General Notes - 1

Mac, Mac OS, OS X, and iOS are trademarks of Apple Inc.

Microsoft, Windows, Windows Vista, Microsoft Edge, Windows Media, PowerPoint, and the Windows logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.

App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc.

Android, Chrome, Chromebook, and Google Play are trademarks of Google LLC.

HDMI, the HDMI Logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing Administrator, Inc. HDMI

PJLink trademark is a trademark applied for registration or is already registered in Japan, the United States of America and other countries and areas.

WPA ^TM and WPA2 ^TM are registered trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance.

"QR Code" is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED.

Crestron, Crestron Connected, Crestron RoomView, and Crestron Fusion are registered trademarks of Crestron Electronics, Inc.

Extron® and XTP® are registered trademarks of Extron Electronics.

HDBaseT ^™ and the HDBaseT Alliance logo are trademarks of the HDBaseT Alliance.

Other product names used herein are also for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their respective owners. Epson disclaims any and all rights in those marks.

©SEIKO EPSON CORPORATION 2019. All rights reserved.

Indication of the manufacturer and the importer in accordance with requirements of directive 2011/65/EU (RoHS)

Manufacturer: SEIKO EPSON CORPORATION

Address: 3-5, Owa 3-chome, Suwa-shi, Nagano-ken 392-8502 Japan

Telephone: 81-266-52-3131

https://epson.com/

Importer: EPSON EUROPE B.V.

Address: Atlas Arena, Asia Building, Hoogoorddreef 5, 1101 BA Amsterdam Zuidoost The Netherlands

Telephone: 31-20-314-5000

https://www.epson.eu/

List of Safety Symbols

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 1

287

The following table lists the meaning of the safety symbols labeled on the equipment.

No.Symbol mark ApprovedstandardsMeaning
1IEC60417No. 5007"ON" (power)To indicate connection to the mains.
2EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 2IEC60417No. 5008"OFF" (power)To indicate disconnection from the mains.
3EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 3IEC60417No. 5009Stand-byTo identify the switch or switch position by means of which part of the equipment is switched on in order to bring it into the stand-by condition.
4EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 4ISO7000No.0434BIEC3864-B3.1CautionTo identify general caution when using the product.
5EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 5IEC60417No. 5041Caution, hot surfaceTo indicate that the marked item can be hot and should not be touched without taking care.
6EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 6IEC60417No.6042ISO3864-B3.6Caution, risk of electric shockTo identify equipment that has risk of electric shock.
7[BHKG]IEC60417No. 5957For indoor use onlyTo identify electrical equipment designed primarily for indoor use.
8EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 7IEC60417No. 5926Polarity of d.c. power connectorTo identify the positive and negative connections (the polarity) on a piece of equipment to which a d.c. power supply may be connected.
9EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 8-Th e
No.Symbol mark ApprovedstandardsMeaning
10IEC60417No. 5001BBattery, generalOn battery powered equipment. To identify a device for instance a cover for the battery compartment, or the connector terminals.
11IEC60417No. 5002Positioning of cellTo identify the battery holder itself and to identify the positioning of the cell(s) inside the battery holder.
12- The same as No. 11
13IEC60417No. 5019Protective earthTo identify any terminal which is intended for connection to an external conductor for protection against electric shock in case of a fault, or the terminal of a protective earth electrode.
14IEC60417No. 5017EarthTo identify an earth (ground) terminal in cases where symbol No. 13 is not explicitly required.
15IEC60417No. 5032Alternating currentTo indicate on the rating plate that the equipment is suitable for alternating current only; to identify relevant terminals.
16IEC60417No. 5031Direct currentTo indicate on the rating plate that the equipment is suitable for direct current only; to identify relevant terminals.
17sIEC60417No. 5172mClass II equipmentTo identify equipment meeting the safety requirements specified for Class II equipment according to IEC 61140.
No.Symbol mark ApprovedMeaning
standards
18EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 9ISO 3864 General prohibitionTo identify actions or operations that are prohibited.
19EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 10ISO 3864 Contact prohibitionTo indicate injury that could occur due to touching a specific part of the equipment.
20EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 11--- Never look into the projection lens while the projector is on.
21EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 12--- To indicate that the marked item don't place anything on projector.
22EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 13ISO3864IEC60825-1Caution, laser radiationTo indicate the equipment has a laser radiation part.
23EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 14ISO 3864 Disassembly prohibitionTo indicate a risk of injury, such as electric shock, if the equipment is disassembled.
24EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 15IEC60417No. 5266Standby, partial standbyTo indicate that part of the equipment is in the ready status.
25EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 16ISO3864IEC60417No.5057Caution, movable partsTo indicate that you must keep away from movable parts according to protection standards.
26EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 17IEC60417-6056Caution (Moving Fan Blades)As a safety precaution, stay away from the moving fan blades.
27EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 18IEC60417-6043Caution (Sharp Corners)To indicate sharp corners that should not be touched.
28EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 19-- To indicate that looking into the lens while projecting is prohibited.
No.Symbol mark ApprovedstandardsMeaning
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 20ISO7010No. W027ISO 3864Warning, light emission (UV, visible light, IR, etc.)When you are close to the light emissions, be careful not to injure your eyes or skin.
EPSON EB-L1065UNL - List of Safety Symbols - 21IEC60417No. 5109Usage prohibition in residential areasTo indicate that this is an electrical device or a device that is not suitable for use in residential areas.

A

A/V Mute 19,102

A/V settings 149

Air exhaust vent 16

Air filter notice 147

Air filter replacement period 208

AMX Device Discovery 159

Aspect 80,142

Audio Out port 17

Audiol port 17

Audio2 port 17

Audio3 port 17

Auto setup 142

B

Basic menu 153

Batch setup function 164

Beep 148

Black level 150

BNC port 17

Brightness 140

BT.709 76

C

Ceiling mount 147

Ceiling mount fixing points 18

Cinema 76

Cleaning 204

Cleaning the air filter and air intake vent 204

Cleaning the projector 204

Color adjustment 141

Color Mode 76,140

Color saturation 140

Color Uniformity 147

Computer port 17

Configuration menu 136

Consumables 233

Contrast 140

Control panel 18

Corner wall 71

Crestron Connected 159, 228

Cross 104

D

Date & Time 148

DHCP 155, 157

DICOM SIM 76

Direct Power On 148

Display 147

Display background 147

Document camera 233

DVI-D port 17

Dynamic 76

E

Epson Projector Management 215

Epson Web Control 215

Esc 19

ESC/VP21 226

Event ID 161

Extended menu 146

Extron XTP 149

E-Zoom 104

F

Filter indicator 175

Focus 38

Freeze 103

Front 147

Front feet 18

Full lock 117

G

Gateway Address 155, 157

Geometry correction 144

H

HDBaseT 149

HDBaseT port 17

HDBaseT signal quality 161

HDMI port 17

Help function 173

High altitude mode 148

Home Screen 59

I

Image adjustment menu 140

Indicator 175

Info menu 161

Input signal 161

Installation requirements 31

Installation settings 31

IP address 155, 157

Index

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Index - 1

290

K

Keystone distortion 144

L

Language 150

Lens operation lock 118

Lens replacement cover 27

Lens Shift 34

Light Source Calibration 7,112

M

Mail notification 158, 225

Memory 145

Menu 18,136

Message broadcasting 160

Messages 147

Monitor Out port 17

Multi-Projection 76,150

Multi-Projection function 90

N

Natural 76

Network configuration 152

Network information 151

Network menu 151

Notification email address 1/2/3 ...... 159

O

Operating temperature 280

Operation 148

Optional accessories 233

Overheating 177

Overscan 142

P

Panel alignment 147

Part names and functions ...... 15

Password protect 115

PJLink 227

PJLink password 153

Port number 158

Position 142

Power inlet 16

Power on protection 115

Presentation 76

Priority gateway 159

Projection 147

Projection distance 234

Projection lens 27

Projector 58,60

Projector ID 42

Projector Keyword 153

Projector name 153

Q

Quick Corner 144

R

Reading mail 225

Rear 147

Rear feet 18

Refresh Rate 161

Remote control 20

Remote control button lock 118

Remote control ID 43

Remote port 17

Remote receiver 15

Replacing batteries 23

Replacing the air filter 208

Reset all config 163

Reset memory 162

Reset menu 162

Resolution 142, 161

Resolutions 274

RS-232C port 17

s

Scale 143, 150

Schedule 112

Schedule settings 150

Screen settings 32,147

Screen Size 101,234

Search access point 156

Serial number 161

Settings menu 143

Sharpness 140

Signal menu 142

SMTP server 158

SNMP 226

Soft keyboard 152

Source 100, 161

Source Search 18,61

Specifications 279

Split screen 144

Split Screen Setup 100

Standby mode 149

Startup screen 147

Status 161

Index

EPSON EB-L1065UNL - Index - 1

Status indicators 15

Storage temperature 280

Subnet mask 155, 157

Supported resolutions 274

Swap screens 101

Sync info 161

Sync. 142

T

Test Pattern 33,145

Tint 140

Tracking 142

Trap IP address 1/2 159

U

User Button 145

User's Logo 104

User's logo protection 115

V

Volume 144

W

WEB API 232

Web browser 215

Web control password 153

White Balance 140

Wired LAN menu 157

Wireless LAN menu 154

Table of contents Click a title to access it
Manual assistant
Powered by Anthropic
Waiting for your message
Product information

Brand : EPSON

Model : EB-L1065UNL

Category : Video projector